idu hardware description(v100r002c00_03).pdf

496
8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 1/496 OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System V100R002C00 IDU Hardware Description Issue 03 Date 2010-01-30 HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

Upload: josesgabo

Post on 02-Jun-2018

218 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 1/496

OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System

V100R002C00

IDU Hardware Description

Issue 03

Date 2010-01-30

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

Page 2: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 2/496

Page 3: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 3/496

 

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2010. All rights reserved.

No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written

consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

 

Trademarks and Permissions

 and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

 All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.

 

Notice

The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the

customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the

purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information,and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations

of any kind, either express or implied.

The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the

preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and

recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or implied.

 

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

 Address: Huawei Industrial Base

Bantian, Longgang

Shenzhen 518129

People's Republic of China

Website: http://www.huawei.com

Email: [email protected]

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

i

Page 4: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 4/496

Page 5: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 5/496

About This Document

Related Versions

The following table lists the product versions related to this document.

Product Name Version

OptiX RTN 950 V100R002C00

iManager U2000 V100R001C00

 

Intended Audience

This document is intended for:

l  Network planning engineer 

l Hardware installation engineer 

l Installation and commissioning engineer 

l Field maintenance engineer 

l Data configuration engineer 

l System maintenance engineer 

Before reading this document, you need to be familiar with the following:

l Basics of digital microwave communication

l Basics of the OptiX RTN 950

Symbol Conventions

The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Symbol Description

 

Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk,

which if not avoided, will result in death or 

serious injury.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description About This Document

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iii

Page 6: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 6/496

Symbol Description

 

Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level

of risk, which if not avoided, could result in

minor or moderate injury.

 

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation,

which if not avoided, could result in

equipment damage, data loss, performance

degradation, or unexpected results.

  Indicates a tip that may help you solve a

 problem or save time.

 Provides additional information to emphasize

or supplement important points of the main

text.

 

GUI Conventions

The GUI conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows.

Convention Description

Boldface Buttons, menus, parameters, tabs, window, and dialog titles

are in boldface. For example, click OK .

> Multi-level menus are in boldface and separated by the ">"

signs. For example, choose File > Create > Folder.

 

Update History

Updates between document issues are cumulative. Thus, the latest document issue contains all

updates made in previous issues.

Updates in Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Based on Product Version V100R002C00

This document is the third release of the V100R002C00 version.

The updated contents are as follows.

Section Description

3.3.5 DIP Switches and CF Card Modifies the sequence of high-order bits and

lower-order bits of DIP switches.

3.5.2 Functions and Features Deletes specifications for VC-4 loopbacks on

the IF1 board.

GUI Conventions

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

iv Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 7: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 7/496

Section Description

5.6.1 E1 Cable to the External Equipment Adds descriptions of requirements for the

diameter of a 75-ohm E1 cable, types of 

coaxial connectors, and crimp pliers.

- Fixes known bugs.

 

Updates in Issue 02 (2009-10-30) Based on Product Version V100R002C00

This document is the second release of the V100R002C00 version.

The updated contents are as follows.

Section Description

D Glossary Adds certain terms.

E Acronyms and Abbreviations Adds certain abbreviations and acronyms.

 

Updates in Issue 01 (2009-06-30) Based on Product Version V100R002C00

This document is the first release of the V100R002C00 version.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Update History

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

v

Page 8: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 8/496

Page 9: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 9/496

Contents

About This Document...................................................................................................................iii

1 Introduction.................................................................................................................................1-1

1.1 Network Application.......................................................................................................................................1-2

1.2 Components.....................................................................................................................................................1-31.3 Radio Link Forms............................................................................................................................................1-6

2 Chassis..........................................................................................................................................2-1

2.1 Chassis Structure.............................................................................................................................................2-2

2.2 Installation Mode.............................................................................................................................................2-2

2.3 IDU Labels......................................................................................................................................................2-2

3 Boards...........................................................................................................................................3-1

3.1 Board Appear ance...........................................................................................................................................3-3

3.2 Board List........................................................................................................................................................3-4

3.3 CST..................................................................................................................................................................3-6

3.3.1 Version Description................................................................................................................................3-7

3.3.2 Functions and Features...........................................................................................................................3-7

3.3.3 Wor king Principle..................................................................................................................................3-8

3.3.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-11

3.3.5 DIP Switches and CF Card...................................................................................................................3-17

3.3.6 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-20

3.3.7 Boar d Parameter Settings.....................................................................................................................3-21

3.3.8 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-21

3.4 CSH...............................................................................................................................................................3-223.4.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-23

3.4.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-23

3.4.3 Working Principle................................................................................................................................3-25

3.4.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-28

3.4.5 DIP Switches and CF Card...................................................................................................................3-35

3.4.6 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-37

3.4.7 Board Parameter Settings.....................................................................................................................3-38

3.4.8 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-38

3.5 IF1.................................................................................................................................................................3-40

3.5.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-40

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Contents

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

vii

Page 10: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 10/496

3.5.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-40

3.5.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow.....................................................................................................3-42

3.5.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-47

3.5.5 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-49

3.5.6 Board Parameter Settings.....................................................................................................................3-50

3.5.7 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-50

3.6 IFU2..............................................................................................................................................................3-52

3.6.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-52

3.6.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-52

3.6.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow.....................................................................................................3-54

3.6.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-57

3.6.5 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-60

3.6.6 Parameter Settings................................................................................................................................3-61

3.6.7 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-61

3.7 IFX2..............................................................................................................................................................3-62

3.7.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-63

3.7.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-63

3.7.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow.....................................................................................................3-64

3.7.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-68

3.7.5 Valid Slot..............................................................................................................................................3-71

3.7.6 Parameter Settings................................................................................................................................3-72

3.7.7 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-72

3.8 EM6T/EM6F.................................................................................................................................................3-733.8.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-74

3.8.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-74

3.8.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow.....................................................................................................3-76

3.8.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-79

3.8.5 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-83

3.8.6 Board Feature Code..............................................................................................................................3-84

3.8.7 Board Parameter Settings.....................................................................................................................3-84

3.8.8 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-84

3.9 SL1D.............................................................................................................................................................3-86

3.9.1 Version Description..............................................................................................................................3-87

3.9.2 Functions and Features.........................................................................................................................3-87

3.9.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow.....................................................................................................3-88

3.9.4 Front Panel...........................................................................................................................................3-91

3.9.5 Valid Slots............................................................................................................................................3-93

3.9.6 Board Feature Code..............................................................................................................................3-94

3.9.7 Parameter Settings................................................................................................................................3-94

3.9.8 Technical Specifications......................................................................................................................3-94

3.10 SP3S/SP3D..................................................................................................................................................3-95

3.10.1 Version Description............................................................................................................................3-96

Contents

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

viii Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 11: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 11/496

3.10.2 Functions and Features.......................................................................................................................3-96

3.10.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow...................................................................................................3-97

3.10.4 Front Panel.........................................................................................................................................3-99

3.10.5 Valid Slots........................................................................................................................................3-103

3.10.6 Board Feature Code..........................................................................................................................3-104

3.10.7 Board Parameter Settings.................................................................................................................3-104

3.10.8 Technical Specifications..................................................................................................................3-104

3.11 AUX..........................................................................................................................................................3-105

3.11.1 Version Description..........................................................................................................................3-105

3.11.2 Functions and Features.....................................................................................................................3-106

3.11.3 Working Principle............................................................................................................................3-106

3.11.4 Front Panel.......................................................................................................................................3-107

3.11.5 Valid Slots........................................................................................................................................3-110

3.11.6 Technical Specifications..................................................................................................................3-1113.12 PIU............................................................................................................................................................3-112

3.12.1 Version Description..........................................................................................................................3-112

3.12.2 Functions and Features.....................................................................................................................3-113

3.12.3 Working Principle............................................................................................................................3-113

3.12.4 Front Panel.......................................................................................................................................3-114

3.12.5 Valid Slots........................................................................................................................................3-115

3.12.6 Technical Specifications..................................................................................................................3-116

3.13 FAN...........................................................................................................................................................3-116

3.13.1 Version Description..........................................................................................................................3-117

3.13.2 Functions and Features.....................................................................................................................3-117

3.13.3 Working Principle............................................................................................................................3-117

3.13.4 Front Panel.......................................................................................................................................3-118

3.13.5 Valid Slots........................................................................................................................................3-120

3.13.6 Technical Specifications..................................................................................................................3-120

4 Accessories...................................................................................................................................4-1

4.1 E1 Panel...........................................................................................................................................................4-2

4.2 PDU.................................................................................................................................................................4-4

4.2.1 Front Panel............................................................................................................................................. 4-4

4.2.2 Functions and Working Principle...........................................................................................................4-5

4.2.3 Power Distribution Mode.......................................................................................................................4-6

5 Cables...........................................................................................................................................5-1

5.1 Power Cable.................................................................................................................................................... 5-3

5.2 PGND Cable....................................................................................................................................................5-3

5.2.1 IDU PG ND Cable...................................................................................................................................5-4

5.2.2 E1 Panel PGND Cable........................................................................................................................... 5-4

5.3 IF Jumper .........................................................................................................................................................5-5

5.4 XPIC Cable..................................................................................................................................................... 5-6

5.5 Fiber Jumper....................................................................................................................................................5-7

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Contents

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

ix

Page 12: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 12/496

5.6 E1 Cables.........................................................................................................................................................5-9

5.6.1 E1 Cable to the External Equipment ...................................................................................................5-10

5.6.2 E1 Cable to the E1 Panel......................................................................................................................5-13

5.6.3 E1 Transit Cable...................................................................................................................................5-15

5.7 Orderwire Cable............................................................................................................................................5-17

5.8 Network Cable...............................................................................................................................................5-18

A Parameters Description...........................................................................................................A-1

A.1 Parameters for NE Management....................................................................................................................A-3

A.1.1 Parameter Description: NE Searching..................................................................................................A-3

A.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation....................................................................................................A-7

A.1.3 Parameter Description: Object Attribute_Changing NE IDs.............................................................A-10

A.1.4 Parameter Description: NE Time Synchronization............................................................................A-11

A.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE Time..................................................A-13

A.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management..................................................................A-14

A.1.7 Parameter Description: Automatic Disabling of the Functions of NEs..............................................A-16

A.2 Parameters for Cable Management..............................................................................................................A-17

A.2.1 Parameter Description: Fiber Search..................................................................................................A-17

A.2.2 Parameter Description: Fiber Creation...............................................................................................A-19

A.2.3 Parameter Description: Radio Link Creation.....................................................................................A-20

A.3 Parameters for Communications Management............................................................................................A-22

A.3.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting.........................................................A-23

A.3.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration..............................................A-24

A.3.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Transparent Transmission Management.............A-25

A.3.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet Port Extended ECC........................................A-27

A.3.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link Management..........................................................................A-28

A.3.6 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management..............................A-30

A.3.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management Creation................A-31

A.3.8 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_OSPF Parameter Settings..........................A-32

A.3.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARP......................................................................A-34

A.3.10 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network Layer Parameter............................................A-35

A.3.11 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Routing Table...............................................................A-36

A.3.12 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel...................................................................A-37A.3.13 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Bandwidth Management............................................A-41

A.3.14 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting.................................................................A-42

A.3.15 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Protocol Setting..........................................................A-43

A.3.16 Parameter Description: Access Control............................................................................................A-44

A.3.17 Parameter Description: LCT Access Control...................................................................................A-45

A.4 Radio Link Parameters................................................................................................................................A-46

A.4.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC Workgroup_Creation.........................................A-47

A.4.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC............................................................................A-51

A.4.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create.................................................................................A-58

A.4.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection..............................................................................................A-59

Contents

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

x Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 13: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 13/496

A.4.5 Parameter: IF 1+1 Protection_Create.................................................................................................A-60

A.4.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection..........................................................................................A-62

A.4.7 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration....................................................................A-65

A.5 Multiplex Section Protection Parameters....................................................................................................A-76

A.5.1 Parameter Description: Linear MSP_Creation...................................................................................A-76

A.5.2 Parameter Description: Linear MSP...................................................................................................A-79

A.6 SDH/PDH Service Parameters....................................................................................................................A-82

A.6.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Creation..........................................................A-83

A.6.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCP Service Creation..................................A-85

A.6.3 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Converting Normal Services Into SNCP Services

......................................................................................................................................................................A-88

A.6.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration..........................................................................A-91

A.6.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control..................................................................................A-93

A.7 Clock Parameters.........................................................................................................................................A-96A.7.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table.........................................................................A-97

A.7.2 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet............................................................A-99

A.7.3 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Quality..........................................................A-102

A.7.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM Output Control...............................................A-105

A.7.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock ID Enabling Status........................................A-106

A.7.6 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Restoration Parameters...............A-107

A.7.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching....................................A-109

A.7.8 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of the External Clock Source......................A-110

A.7.9 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status.....................................................................A-113

A.8 Parameters for Ethernet Services...............................................................................................................A-114

A.8.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation............................................................................A-115

A.8.2 Parameter Description: E-Line Service............................................................................................A-121

A.8.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding Table Item_Creation...................................................A-126

A.8.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation...........................................................................A-126

A.8.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service...........................................................................................A-132

A.8.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation...................................................................................A-144

A.9 Ethernet Protocol Parameters....................................................................................................................A-144

A.9.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation.....................................................................A-145

A.9.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management.....................................................................................A-147A.9.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Creation................................................A-153

A.9.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Configuration.......................................A-155

A.9.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ Bridge Parameters..................................................A-155

A.9.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CIST Parameters.....................................................A-161

A.9.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About the CIST....................A-163

A.9.8 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Protocol Configuration...........................A-171

A.9.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Adding Port to Be Quickly Deleted........A-174

A.9.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Management...............................A-175

A.9.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuraiton_Static Router Port Creation...................A-176

A.9.12 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Member Port Management.........A-176

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Contents

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xi

Page 14: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 14/496

A.9.13 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Static Multicast Group Member Creation

....................................................................................................................................................................A-178

A.9.14 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Data Statistics.......................................A-178

A.9.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation Management_LAG Creation........................A-180

A.9.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Port Priority.................................................A-185

A.9.17 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation.....................................................................A-186

A.9.18 Parameter Description: Port Mirroring_Creation...........................................................................A-187

A.10 Parameters f or the Ethernet OAM...........................................................................................................A-188

A.10.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Domain Creation....A-188

A.10.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Association Creation

....................................................................................................................................................................A-189

A.10.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MEP Creation..............................A-190

A.10.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Remote MEP Creation.................A-191

A.10.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MIP Creation................................A-192

A.10.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LB Enabling.................................A-193

A.10.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LT Enabling.................................A-194

A.10.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter................................A-196

A.10.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Error Frame Monitoring..........A-199

A.11 QoS Parameters.......................................................................................................................................A-200

A.11.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management.................................................................A-201

A.11.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Management_Create....................................................A-206

A.11.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Applied Port_Modification..........................................A-211

A.11.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management..................................................................................A-213

A.11.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy................................................................................................A-218

A.11.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic Classification Configuration.....................................A-223

A.11.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_Creation........................................................A-232

A.12 RMON Parameters..................................................................................................................................A-233

A.12.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_Statistics Group.....................................................A-234

A.12.2 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Group........................................................A-235

A.12.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Control Group..........................................A-236

A.12.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting......................................................A-237

A.13 Parameters f or the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces...........................................................................A-239

A.13.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General...................................................................................A-239A.13.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Advanced................................................................................A-241

A.13.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port...........................................................................A-242

A.13.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port................................................................A-242

A.13.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface...........................................................A-243

A.14 Parameters f or Board Interfaces..............................................................................................................A-246

A.14.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute..........................................................................A-247

A.14.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute....................................................................A-249

A.14.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid/AM Configuration........................................................................A-251

A.14.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records......................................................................A-253

A.14.5 Parameter Description: PRBS Test................................................................................................A-254

Contents

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

xii Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 15: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 15/496

A.14.6 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio Frequency Attribute.............................................A-255

A.14.7 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes.............................................................A-256

A.14.8 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Equipment Information...................................................A-261

A.14.9 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes.......................................................A-262

A.14.10 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces.......................................................................................A-263

A.14.11 Parameter Description: Automatic Laser Shutdown....................................................................A-265

A.14.12 Parameter Description: PDH Interfaces.......................................................................................A-266

A.14.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes........................................................A-268

A.14.14 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control............................................................A-271

A.14.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes....................................................A-272

A.14.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes................................................A-276

A.14.17 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes...................................................A-278

A.14.18 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes...............................................A-279

A.14.19 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes............................................A-281

A.15 Parameters for Overhead.........................................................................................................................A-283

A.15.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead.................................................................A-284

A.15.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs...............................................................................................A-284

A.15.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs.............................................................................................A-286

B Board Loopback Types............................................................................................................B-1

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards..................................................C-1

D Glossary.....................................................................................................................................D-1

E Acronyms and Abbreviations.................................................................................................E-1

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Contents

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xiii

Page 16: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 16/496

Page 17: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 17/496

Figures

Figure 1-1 TDM microwave transmission solution provided by the OptiX RTN 950........................................1-2

Figure 1-2 Hybrid microwave transmission solution provided by the OptiX RTN 950......................................1-3

Figure 1-3 IDU 950..............................................................................................................................................1-4

Figure 1-4 Direct mounting..................................................................................................................................1-6

Figure 1-5 Se parate mounting..............................................................................................................................1-6

Figure 2-1 Chassis structure of the IDU 950........................................................................................................2-2

Figure 2-2 Positions of the IDU 950 labels..........................................................................................................2-4

Figure 3-1 Board appearance (IFU2)...................................................................................................................3-3

Figure 3-2 Bar code..............................................................................................................................................3-3

Figure 3-3 IDU slot layout...................................................................................................................................3-4

Figure 3-4 Functional block diagram of the CST.................................................................................................3-9

Figure 3-5 Functional block diagram of the cross-connect unit.........................................................................3-10

Figure 3-6 Fr ont panel of the CST.....................................................................................................................3-11

Figure 3-7 Fr ont view of the RJ-45 connector...................................................................................................3-13Figure 3-8 Incorrect connections between the NMS/COM interface and the NE interface...............................3-15

Figure 3-9 Positions of the DIP switches and CF card ......................................................................................3-18

Figure 3-10 Slot for the CST in the IDU chassis...............................................................................................3-20

Figure 3-11 Logical slot for the logical board of the CST.................................................................................3-20

Figure 3-12 Functional block diagram of the CSH............................................................................................3-26

Figure 3-13 Functional block diagram of the cross-connect unit.......................................................................3-28

Figure 3-14 Front panel of the CSH...................................................................................................................3-29

Figure 3-15 Front view of the RJ-45 connector.................................................................................................3-31

Figure 3-16 Incorrect connections between the NMS/COM interface and the NE interface.............................3-32

Figure 3-17 Positions of the DIP switches and CF card ....................................................................................3-35

Figure 3-18 Slot for the CSH in the IDU chassis...............................................................................................3-37

Figure 3-19 Logical slot for the logical board of the CSH.................................................................................3-38

Figure 3-20 Functional block diagram of the IF1..............................................................................................3-42

Figure 3-21 Front panel of the IF1.....................................................................................................................3-47

Figure 3-22 Slots for the IF1 in the IDU chassis................................................................................................3-49

Figure 3-23 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IF1................................................................................3-50

Figure 3-24 Functional block diagram of the IFU2...........................................................................................3-54

Figure 3-25 Front panel of the IFU2..................................................................................................................3-57

Figure 3-26 Slots for the IFU2 in the IDU chassis.............................................................................................3-60

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Figures

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xv

Page 18: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 18/496

Figure 3-27 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IFU2.............................................................................3-60

Figure 3-28 Functional block diagram of the IFX2........................................................................................... 3-65

Figure 3-29 Front panel of the IFX2..................................................................................................................3-68

Figure 3-30 Slots for the IFX2 in the IDU chassis.............................................................................................3-71

Figure 3-31 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IFX2.............................................................................3-71

Figure 3-32 Functional block diagram...............................................................................................................3-77

Figure 3-33 Front panel of the EM6T................................................................................................................3-79

Figure 3-34 Front panel of the EM6F................................................................................................................ 3-79

Figure 3-35 Front view of the RJ-45 connector.................................................................................................3-81

Figure 3-36 Slots for the EM6T/EM6F in the IDU chassis............................................................................... 3-83

Figure 3-37 Logical slots for the logical boards of the EM6T/EM6F................................................................3-83

Figure 3-38 Functional block diagram of the SL1D.......................................................................................... 3-89

Figure 3-39 Front panel of the SL1D.................................................................................................................3-91

Figure 3-40 Slots for the SL1D in the IDU chassis............................................................................................3-93

Figure 3-41 Logical slots for the logical boards of the SL1D............................................................................3-93

Figure 3-42 Functional block diagram of the SP3S/SP3D.................................................................................3-97

Figure 3-43 Front panel of the SP3S..................................................................................................................3-99

Figure 3-44 Front panel of the SP3D...............................................................................................................3-100

Figure 3-45 Pin assignment of the Anea 96 interface......................................................................................3-101

Figure 3-46 Slots for the SP3S/SP3D in the IDU 950 chassis.........................................................................3-103

Figure 3-47 Logical slots for the logical boards of the SP3S/SP3D................................................................3-103

Figure 3-48 Functional block diagram of the AUX.........................................................................................3-106

Figure 3-49 Front panel of the AUX................................................................................................................3-107Figure 3-50 Front view of the RJ-45 connector...............................................................................................3-108

Figure 3-51 Slots for the AUX in the IDU chassis...........................................................................................3-110

Figure 3-52 Logical slots for the logical boards of the AUX...........................................................................3-110

Figure 3-53 Functional block diagram of the PIU...........................................................................................3-113

Figure 3-54 Front panel of the PIU..................................................................................................................3-114

Figure 3-55 Slots for the PIU in the IDU chassis.............................................................................................3-115

Figure 3-56 Logical slots for the logical boards of the PIU.............................................................................3-116

Figure 3-57 Functional block diagram of the FAN..........................................................................................3-117

Figure 3-58 Front Panel Diagram.....................................................................................................................3-119

Figure 3-59 Slot for the FAN in the IDU chassis.............................................................................................3-120

Figure 3-60 Logical slot for the logical board of the FAN...............................................................................3-120

Figure 4-1 Fr ont panel of an E1 panel..................................................................................................................4-2

Figure 4-2 Pin assignments of an E1 port (E1 panel)...........................................................................................4-3

Figure 4-3 Fr ont panel of the PDU.......................................................................................................................4-4

Figure 4-4 Functional block diagram of the PDU................................................................................................4-6

Figure 4-5 Internal structure of the PDU in DC-C mode ....................................................................................4-7

Figure 4-6 Internal structure of the PDU in DC-I mode .....................................................................................4-7

Figure 5-1 Power cable.........................................................................................................................................5-3

Figure 5-2 IDU PGND cable................................................................................................................................5-4

Figures

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

xvi Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 19: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 19/496

Figure 5-3 E1 panel PGND cable.........................................................................................................................5-5

Figure 5-4 IF jumper............................................................................................................................................5-6

Figure 5-5 View of the XPIC cable......................................................................................................................5-7

Figure 5-6 LC/PC connector................................................................................................................................5-8

Figure 5-7 SC/PC connector.................................................................................................................................5-9

Figure 5-8 FC/PC connector.................................................................................................................................5-9

Figure 5-9 E1 cable............................................................................................................................................5-10

Figure 5-10 E1 cable that connects the IDU to an E1 panel..............................................................................5-14

Figure 5-11 E1 transit cable terminated with the Anea 96 and DB44 connectors.............................................5-15

Figure 5-12 Orderwire cable..............................................................................................................................5-17

Figure 5-13 Network cable.................................................................................................................................5-19

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Figures

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xvii

Page 20: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 20/496

Page 21: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 21/496

Tables

Table 1-1 Intr oduction of the IDU 950.................................................................................................................1-3

Table 1-2 RT N 600 ODUs supported by the OptiX RTN 950.............................................................................1-4

Table 1-3 RT N XMC ODUs supported by the OptiX RTN 950..........................................................................1-5

Table 1-4 Radio link forms of the OptiX RTN 950.............................................................................................1-7

Table 2-1 Description of the IDU labels..............................................................................................................2-3

Table 3-1 List of IDUs..........................................................................................................................................3-4

Table 3-2 Description of the indicators on the CST...........................................................................................3-11

Table 3-3 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the CSH...............................3-12

Table 3-4 Pin assignment of the NMS/COM interface...................................................................................... 3-13

Table 3-5 Pin assignment of the EXT interface................................................................................................. 3-14

Table 3-6 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector..................................................................3-14

Table 3-7 Pin assignment of the CLK/TOD1 interface......................................................................................3-15

Table 3-8 Pin assignment of the TOD2 interface...............................................................................................3-16

Table 3-9 Setting the DIP switches.................................................................................................................... 3-18Table 3-10 Slot allocation ..................................................................................................................................3-20

Table 3-11 Clock timing and synchronization performance.............................................................................. 3-21

Table 3-12 Wayside service interface performance........................................................................................... 3-22

Table 3-13 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-22

Table 3-14 Description of the indicators on the CSH........................................................................................ 3-29

Table 3-15 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the CSH.............................3-30

Table 3-16 Pin assignment of the NMS/COM interface.................................................................................... 3-31

Table 3-17 Pin assignment of the EXT interface............................................................................................... 3-31

Table 3-18 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector................................................................3-32

Table 3-19 Pin assignment of the CLK/TOD1 interface....................................................................................3-33

Table 3-20 Pin assignment of the TOD2 interface.............................................................................................3-34

Table 3-21 Setting the DIP switches.................................................................................................................. 3-36

Table 3-22 Slot allocation ..................................................................................................................................3-38

Table 3-23 Clock timing and synchronization performance.............................................................................. 3-39

Table 3-24 Wayside service interface performance........................................................................................... 3-39

Table 3-25 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-39

Table 3-26 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IF1...............................................................3-43

Table 3-27 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IF1.............................................................3-46

Table 3-28 Description of the indicators on the IF1...........................................................................................3-47

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Tables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xix

Page 22: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 22/496

Table 3-29 Description of the Interfaces ...........................................................................................................3-48

Table 3-30 Slot allocation ..................................................................................................................................3-50

Table 3-31 IF performance.................................................................................................................................3-51

Table 3-32 Baseband signal processing performance of the modem.................................................................3-51

Table 3-33 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-51

Table 3-34 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IFU2............................................................3-55

Table 3-35 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IFU2..........................................................3-56

Table 3-36 Description of the indicators on the IFU2........................................................................................3-58

Table 3-37 Description of the Interfaces ...........................................................................................................3-59

Table 3-38 Slot allocation ..................................................................................................................................3-60

Table 3-39 IF performance.................................................................................................................................3-61

Table 3-40 Baseband signal processing performance of the modem.................................................................3-62

Table 3-41 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-62

Table 3-42 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IFX2............................................................3-65

Table 3-43 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IFX2..........................................................3-67

Table 3-44 Description of the indicators on the IFX2........................................................................................3-69

Table 3-45 Description of the interfaces............................................................................................................3-70

Table 3-46 Slot allocation ..................................................................................................................................3-72

Table 3-47 IF performance.................................................................................................................................3-72

Table 3-48 Baseband signal processing performance of the modem.................................................................3-73

Table 3-49 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-73

Table 3-50 Signal processing flow in the receive direction...............................................................................3-77

Table 3-51 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction..............................................................................3-78Table 3-52 Description of the indicators on the EM6T/EM6F..........................................................................3-79

Table 3-53 Description of the interfaces on the EM6T/EM6F...........................................................................3-81

Table 3-54 Pin assignment of the RJ-45 connector in MDI mode.....................................................................3-81

Table 3-55 Pin assignment of the RJ-45 connector in MDI-X mode.................................................................3-82

Table 3-56 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector................................................................3-83

Table 3-57 Slot configuration for the EM6T/EM6F..........................................................................................3-84

Table 3-58 Board feature code of the EM6F......................................................................................................3-84

Table 3-59 Performance of the GE optical interface .........................................................................................3-85

Table 3-60 GE electric interface performance....................................................................................................3-85

Table 3-61 FE electric interface performance....................................................................................................3-86

Table 3-62 Mechanical behavior .......................................................................................................................3-86

Table 3-63 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the SL1D...........................................................3-89

Table 3-64 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the SL1D.........................................................3-90

Table 3-65 Description of the indicators on the SL1D.......................................................................................3-91

Table 3-66 Description of the interfaces ...........................................................................................................3-92

Table 3-67 Slot allocation for the SL1D............................................................................................................3-93

Table 3-68 Board feature code of the SL1D.......................................................................................................3-94

Table 3-69 STM-1 optical interface performance..............................................................................................3-94

Table 3-70 Mechanical behavior........................................................................................................................3-95

Tables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

xx Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 23: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 23/496

Table 3-71 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the SP3S/SP3D.................................................3-98

Table 3-72 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the SP3S/SP3D............................................... 3-98

Table 3-73 Description of the indicators on the SP3S/SP3D...........................................................................3-100

Table 3-74 Description of the interface on the SP3S.......................................................................................3-100

Table 3-75 Description of the interfaces on the SP3D.....................................................................................3-101

Table 3-76 Pin assignment of the Anea 96 interface........................................................................................3-101

Table 3-77 Slot configuration for the SP3S/SP3D...........................................................................................3-104

Table 3-78 Board feature code of the SP3S/SP3D...........................................................................................3-104

Table 3-79 E1 interface performance...............................................................................................................3-104

Table 3-80 Mechanical behavior .....................................................................................................................3-105

Table 3-81 Description of the indicators on the AUX......................................................................................3-108

Table 3-82 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces..............................................3-108

Table 3-83 Pin assignment of the F1/S1 interface............................................................................................3-109

Table 3-84 Pin assignment of the ALMI interface...........................................................................................3-109

Table 3-85 Pin assignment of the ALMO interface.........................................................................................3-109

Table 3-86 Slot configuration for the AUX......................................................................................................3-110

Table 3-87 Orderwire interface performance...................................................................................................3-111

Table 3-88 Synchronous data interface performance.......................................................................................3-111

Table 3-89 Asynchronous data interface performance.....................................................................................3-111

Table 3-90 Mechanical behavior .....................................................................................................................3-112

Table 3-91 Description of the power status indicators ....................................................................................3-115

Table 3-92 Description of the interfaces on the PIU........................................................................................3-115

Table 3-93 Technical specifications.................................................................................................................3-116Table 3-94 Adjustment of the fan rotating speed.............................................................................................3-118

Table 3-95 Description of the fan status indicators..........................................................................................3-119

Table 3-96 Technical specifications for the FAN.............................................................................................3-120

Table 4-1 Interface description of an E1 panel.....................................................................................................4-2

Table 4-2 Pin assignments of an E1 port (E1 panel)............................................................................................4-3

Table 4-3 Interfaces on the PDU..........................................................................................................................4-5

Table 5-1 Specifications of the power cable.........................................................................................................5-3

Table 5-2 Ty pes of fiber jumpers................................................................................................ .........................5-7

Table 5-3 Pin assignment of the 75-ohm E1 cable.............................................................................................5-11

Table 5-4 Pin assignment of the 120-ohm E1 cable...........................................................................................5-12

Table 5-5 Connection table of the E1 cable that connects a PO1/PH1 board to an E1 panel............................ 5-14

Table 5-6 Connection table of the E1 transit cable terminated with the Anea 96 and DB44 connectors.......... 5-16

Table 5-7 Pin assignment of the orderwire cable...............................................................................................5-17

Table 5-8 Pin assignment of the MDI interface................................................................................................. 5-18

Table 5-9 Pin assignment of the MDI-X interface.............................................................................................5-18

Table 5-10 Pin assignment of the straight through cable................................................................................... 5-20

Table 5-11 Pin assignment of the crossover cable............................................................................................. 5-20

Table A-1 Methods used by Ethernet interfaces to process data frames.........................................................A-275

Table A-2 Data frame processing....................................................................................................................A-280

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description Tables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xxi

Page 24: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 24/496

Table B-1 Loopback types supported by different service interface boards........................................................B-1

Table C-1 Description of the indicators on the CST...........................................................................................C-1

Table C-2 Description of the indicators on the CSH...........................................................................................C-2

Table C-3 Description of the indicators on the IF1.............................................................................................C-3

Table C-4 Description of the indicators on the IFU2..........................................................................................C-5

Table C-5 Description of the indicators on the EM6T/EM6F.............................................................................C-6

Table C-6 Description of the indicators on the SL1D.........................................................................................C-7

Table C-7 Description of the indicators on the SP3S/SP3D................................................................................C-8

Table C-8 Description of the indicators on the AUX..........................................................................................C-9

Table C-9 Description of the power status indicators ........................................................................................C-9

Table C-10 Description of the fan status indicators............................................................................................C-9

Table C-11 Weight and power consumption of boards.....................................................................................C-10

Tables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

xxii Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 25: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 25/496

1 Introduction

About This Chapter

The OptiX RTN 950 is one of the series products of the OptiX RTN 900 radio transmission

system.

1.1 Network Application

The OptiX RTN 900 is a new generation split microwave transmission system developed by

Huawei. It can provide a seamless microwave transmission solution for a mobile communication

network or pr ivate network.

1.2 Components

The OptiX RTN 950 adopts a split structure. The system consists of the IDU 950, the ODU, and

the antenna system. An ODU is connected to an IDU through an IF cable.

1.3 Radio Link Forms

The OptiX RTN 950 provides the radio links of different forms by flexibly configuring different

IF boards and ODUs to meet the requirements of different microwave application scenarios.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 1 Introduction

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-1

Page 26: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 26/496

1.1 Network Application

The OptiX RTN 900 is a new generation split microwave transmission system developed by

Huawei. It can provide a seamless microwave transmission solution for a mobile communication

network or private network.

The OptiX RTN 900 products are available in two types: OptiX RTN 910 and OptiX RTN 950.

The IDU of the OptiX RTN 910 is 1U high and supports one or two IF boards. The IDU of the

OptiX RTN 950 is 2U high and supports one to six IF boards. The users can choose an appropriate

type based on the actual requirements.

The OptiX RTN 950 provides several types of service interfaces and facilitates installation and

flexible configuration. It can provide a solution that is integrated with the TDM microwave,

Hybrid microwave, and Packet microwave based on the network requirements. It supports the

smooth upgrade from the TDM microwave to the Hybrid microwave, and from the Hybrid

microwave to the Packet microwave. The solution can evolve based on the service changes thatoccur due to radio mobile network evolution. Thus, this solution can meet the transmission

requirements of not only 2G and 3G networks, but also future LTE and 4G networks.

Figure 1-1 and Figure 1-2 show the TDM microwave transmission solution and the Hybrid

microwave transmission solution respectively that are provided by the OptiX RTN 950 for the

mobile communication network.

Figure 1-1 TDM microwave transmission solution provided by the OptiX RTN 950

OptiX RTN 950 BTS BSC

E1

E1

E1

STM-1/E1 E1Regional Backhaul

Network

E1 E1

E1

E1

E1

E1

 

1 Introduction

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

1-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 27: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 27/496

Figure 1-2 Hybrid microwave transmission solution provided by the OptiX RTN 950

Regional backhaulnetwork

OptiX RTN 950 BTSNodeB BSCRNC

FE

E1

FE

E1

E1

E1FE

FE/GE

E1

GE

E1

E1

STM-1/E1

FE

 

NOTE

l In the solutions, the local backhaul network is optional. The OptiX RTN 950 can be connected to the RNC

or the BSC directly.

1.2 ComponentsThe OptiX RTN 950 adopts a split structure. The system consists of the IDU 950, the ODU, and

the antenna system. An ODU is connected to an IDU through an IF cable.

IDU 950

The IDU 950 is the indoor unit of an OptiX RTN 950 system. It accesses services, performs

multiplexing/demultiplexing and IF processing of the services, and provides system control and

communication function.

Table 1-1 lists the basic features of the IDU 950.

Table 1-1 Introduction of the IDU 950

Item Performance

Chassis height 2U

Pluggable Supported

 Number of microwave

directions

1-6

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 1 Introduction

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-3

Page 28: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 28/496

Item Performance

RF configuration mode 1+0 non-protection configuration

 N+0 non-protection configuration (N ≤ 5)

1+1 protection configuration

 N+1 protection configuration (N ≤ 4)

XPIC configuration

 

Figure 1-3 IDU 950

 

ODU

The ODU is the outdoor unit of the OptiX RTN 900. It performs frequency conversion and

amplification of signals.

The OptiX RTN 900 series products can uses the RTN 600 ODU and RTN XMC ODU, covering

6 GHz to 38 GHz entire frequency band.

Table 1-2 RTN 600 ODUs supported by the OptiX RTN 950

Item Description

Standard Power ODU High Power ODU

ODU type SP and SPA HP

Frequency band 7/8/11/13/15/18/23/26/38

GHz (SP ODU)

6/7/8/11/13/15/18/23 GHz

(SPA ODU)

7/8/11/13/15/18/23/26/32/38

GHz

1 Introduction

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

1-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 29: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 29/496

Item Description

Standard Power ODU High Power ODU

Microwave modulation

mode

QPSK/16QAM/32QAM/

64QAM/128QAM/256QAM(SP ODU)

QPSK/16QAM/32QAM/

64QAM/128QAM (SPA

ODU)

QPSK/16QAM/32QAM/

64QAM/128QAM/256QAM

Channel spacing 7/14/28 MHz 7/14/28/56 MHz

 

Table 1-3 RTN XMC ODUs supported by the OptiX RTN 950

Item Description

High Power ODU

ODU type XMC-2

Frequency band 15/23 GHz

Microwave modulation mode QPSK/16QAM/32QAM/64QAM/128QAM/

256QAM

Channel spacing 7/14/28/56 MHz

 

Antenna

The OptiX RTN 950 provides an entire frequency band antenna solution, and supports the single-

 polarized antenna and dual-polarized antenna with a diameter of 0.3 m to 3.7 m and the

corresponding feeder system.

There are two methods of mounting the ODU and the antenna: direct mounting and separate

mounting.

l The direct mounting method is normally adopted when a small-diameter and single-

 polarized antenna is used. In this situation, if one ODU is configured for one antenna, theODU is directly mounted at the back of the antenna. If two ODUs are configured for one

antenna, an RF signal combiner/splitter (hereinafter referred to as a hybrid coupler) must

 be mounted to connect the ODUs to the antenna. Figure 1-4 shows the direct mounting

method.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 1 Introduction

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-5

Page 30: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 30/496

Figure 1-4 Direct mounting

l The separate mounting method is adopted when a double-polarized antenna or big-diameter 

and single-polarized antenna is used. Figure 1-5 shows the separate method. In this

situation, a hybrid coupler can be mounted. That is, two ODUs share one feed boom.

Figure 1-5 Separate mounting

 

1.3 Radio Link Forms

The OptiX RTN 950 provides the radio links of different forms by flexibly configuring different

IF boards and ODUs to meet the requirements of different microwave application scenarios.

1 Introduction

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

1-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 31: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 31/496

Table 1-4 Radio link forms of the OptiX RTN 950

Radio Link Form Type of theControl,Switching, and

Timing Board

Type of the IFBoard

Type of the ODU

SDH/PDH radio link CST/CSH IF1 Standard power  

ODU or high power 

ODU

Hybrid radio link CSH IFU2 Standard power  

ODU or high power 

ODU

Hybrid radio link that

supports the XPIC

CSH IFX2 Standard power  

ODU or high power 

ODU

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 1 Introduction

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-7

Page 32: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 32/496

Page 33: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 33/496

2 Chassis

About This Chapter

The IDU of OptiX RTN 950 is a 2U chassis. It supports various installation modes and therefore

can be deployed flexibly.

2.1 Chassis Structure

The dimensions of the IDU 950 are 442 mm (width) x 220 mm (depth) x 88 mm (height). The

IDU 950 has a four-layered structure and supports wind cooling.

2.2 Installation Mode

The IDU 950 chassis supports various installation modes and can be deployed flexibly.

2.3 IDU Labels

There are labels such as the product nameplate label, qualification card label, ESD protection

label, grounding label, laser safety class label, high temperature warning label, and operation

warning label on the IDU chassis and the boards in the IDU chassis. You need to be familiar 

with the meanings of the labels and perform operations based on the indications of the labels,

thus preventing personal injury and damage to the equipment.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 2 Chassis

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-1

Page 34: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 34/496

2.1 Chassis StructureThe dimensions of the IDU 950 are 442 mm (width) x 220 mm (depth) x 88 mm (height). The

IDU 950 has a four-layered structure and supports wind cooling.

Figure 2-1 shows the chassis structure of the IDU 950.

Figure 2-1 Chassis structure of the IDU 950

2.2 Installation ModeThe IDU 950 chassis supports various installation modes and can be deployed flexibly.

The IDU 950 can be installed:

l In a 300 mm ETSI (European Telecommunications Standards Institute) cabinet

l In a 600 mm ETSI cabinet

l In a 450 mm 19-inch cabinet

l In a 600 mm 19-inch cabinet

l In an open rack 

l On a wall

l On a table

2.3 IDU LabelsThere are labels such as the product nameplate label, qualification card label, ESD protection

label, grounding label, laser safety class label, high temperature warning label, and operation

warning label on the IDU chassis and the boards in the IDU chassis. You need to be familiar 

with the meanings of the labels and perform operations based on the indications of the labels,thus preventing personal injury and damage to the equipment.

2 Chassis

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

2-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 35: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 35/496

Label Description

Table 2-1 provides the description of the labels on the IDU chassis and the boards in the IDU

chassis. The actual labels may be different depending on the configurations of the chassis and

 boards.

Table 2-1 Description of the IDU labels

Label Label Name Description

ESD protection

label

Indicates that the

equipment is

sensitive to static

electricity.

Grounding label Indicates the

grounding position

of the IDU chassis.

Fan warning

label

warns you not to

touch the fan leaves

when the fan is

rotating.

High

temperature

warning label

The board surface

temperature may

exceed 70°C when

the ambient

temperature is

higher than 55°C. Inthis case, you need

to wear protective

gloves before

handling the board.

合格证/QUALIFICATION CARD

华为技术有限公司   中国制作MADE INCHINAHUAWEITECHNOLOGIES CO.,LTD.

HUAWEI

Qualification

card label

Indicates that the

equipment is

qualified.

RoHS label Indicates that the

equipmentcomplies with the

related

requirements

specified in the

RoHS directive.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 2 Chassis

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-3

Page 36: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 36/496

Label Label Name Description

Product

nameplate label

Indicates the

 product name and

certification.

PULL

Operation

guidance label

The switch lever 

must be pulled

outwards slightly

 before setting the

switch to the "I" or 

"O" position.

 

Label Position

Figure 2-2 shows the positions of the labels on the chassis of the IDU 950.

Figure 2-2 Positions of the IDU 950 labels

合格证/QUALIFICATIONCARD

华为技术有限公司   中国制作MADE IN CHINAHUAWEITECHNOLOGIES CO.,LTD.

HUAWEI

WARNING

-48V OUTPUTTURNOFF POWERBEFORE

DISCONNECTINGIF CABLE

!

 

ThisdevicecomplieswithPart15oftheFCCRules.Operationissubjecttothefollowingtwoconditions:(1)thisdevicemaynotcauseharmfulinterference,and(2)thisdevicemustacceptanyinterferencereceived,

includinginterferencethatmaycauseundesiredoperation.

OptiXRTN950

POWERRATING: -48 -60V;14.3A

华为技术有限公司 中国制造

电源额定值

H UA WE I T EC HN OL GI ES C O ., LT D. M AD E IN C HI NA

N 14036

Class 1 LaserProduct

 

2 Chassis

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

2-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 37: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 37/496

3 Boards

About This Chapter

The IDU 950 supports the following types of boards: system control, switching, and timing

 board, IF board, Ethernet board, SDH board, PDH board, power supply board, and fan board.

3.1 Board Appearance

The dimensions of the board in the extended slot of the IDU 950 are 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70

mm (depth) x 193.80 mm (width). The dimensions of the system control, cross-connect unit,

and timing board in the IDU 950 are 22.36 mm (height) x 199.60 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width).

3.2 Board ListThe boards ar e inserted in the IDU 950. The IDU 950 realizes different functions when housing

different types of boards.

3.3 CST

The CST is the integrated TDM system control and communication, switching, and clock board.

3.4 CSH

The CSH is an Hybrid system control, cross-connect, and timing board.

3.5 IF1

The IF1 is a medium-capacity SDH IF board and is available in two types, namely, IF1A and

IF1B. In this document, the IF1 is used to stand for both the IF1A and IF1B. The only difference

from the IF1B is that the IF1A is more reliable. The IF1 supports the DC-C power distributionmodes.

3.6 IFU2

The IFU2 is a general IF board, which can support the Hybrid microwave transmission and

Packet microwave transmission at the same time. The IFU2 board supports the DC-I power 

distribution mode.

3.7 IFX2

The IFX2 is a general IF board, which can support the XPIC function of the Hybrid microwave

and Packet microwave. The IFX2 board supports the DC-I power distribution mode.

3.8 EM6T/EM6F

The EM6T/EM6F is an FE/GE interface board, which provides four FE electrical interfaces andtwo GE interfaces. The EM6T has similar functions to the EM6F. The only difference is as

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-1

Page 38: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 38/496

follows: the GE interfaces on the EM6T always function as electrical interfaces whereas the GE

interfaces on the EM6F use the SFP modules and therefore can function as two optical or 

electrical interfaces. The GE electrical interfaces on the EM6F and the EM6T are compatible

with the FE electrical interfaces.

3.9 SL1DThe SL1D is an SDH dual-port STM-1 board.

3.10 SP3S/SP3D

The SP3S is a 16xE1 75-ohm/120-ohm tributary board. The SP3D is a 32xE1 75-ohm/120-ohm

tributary board.

3.11 AUX

The AUX is the auxiliary and management interface board of the OptiX RTN 950. One NE can

house only one AUX.

3.12 PIU

The PIU is the power supply board. The OptiX RTN 950 supports two PIUs, each of which

accesses one -48 V/-60 V DC power supply.

3.13 FAN

The FAN is the fan board that dissipates the heat from the chassis through wind cooling.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 39: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 39/496

3.1 Board Appearance

The dimensions of the board in the extended slot of the IDU 950 are 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70

mm (depth) x 193.80 mm (width). The dimensions of the system control, cross-connect unit,

and timing board in the IDU 950 are 22.36 mm (height) x 199.60 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width).

NOTE

The depth of the board refers to the distance between the front panel and the end of the PCB.

Figure 3-1 shows the appearance of the boards in the IDU 950 chassis.

Figure 3-1 Board appearance (IFU2)

 

The appearance of the IFU2 is provided as an example. The front panel of the IFU2 has two

ejector levers and two captive screws. The ejector levers are used when the IFU2 is inserted or 

removed. The captive screws are used to fasten the IFU2. The bar code of the IFU2 is attached

to one of the two ejector levers. Figure 3-2 shows the bar code of the IFU2.

Figure 3-2 Bar code

Bar code

Internal code

Board version

Board name

Board feature code

0514721055000015-SL91SL1D01

① ② ③   ④

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-3

Page 40: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 40/496

NOTE

The indication of the board feature code is related to the board type. The feature code of an optical interface

 board indicates the type of the optical interface on the board. The feature code of an E1 interface board

indicates the impedance of the E1 interface on the board. For details about the board feature code, see the

description of each board in this document.

3.2 Board List

The boards are inserted in the IDU 950. The IDU 950 realizes different functions when housing

different types of boards.

Figure 3-3 IDU slot layout

Slot9

(PIU)

Slot 7 (CST/CSH)

Slot 1 (EXT)

Slot 5 (EXT)

Slot 3 (EXT)

Slot 2 (EXT)

Slot 4 (EXT)

Slot 6 (EXT)

Slot 8 (CST/CSH)Slot

10

(PIU) Slot

11

(FAN)

NOTE

The EXT represents an extended slot, which can be inserted with various IF boards and interface boards.

 

Table 3-1 List of IDUs

BoardName FullSpelling Valid Slot Description

CST TDM

control,

switching,

and timing

 board

Slot 7 or slot

8

l Provides full timeslot cross-connections

for VC-12/VC-3/VC-4 services equivalent

to 32x32 VC-4s.

l Performs system communication and

control.

l Provides the clock processing function and

supports one external clock input/output

function.

l Provides one Ethernet NM interface, one

 NM serial interface, and one NE cascading

interface.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 41: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 41/496

BoardName

FullSpelling Valid Slot Description

CSH Hybrid

control,

switching,

and timing

 board

Slot 7 or slot

8

l Provides full timeslot cross-connections

for VC-12/VC-3/VC-4 services equivalent

to 32x32 VC-4s.

l Provides the 10 Gbit/s packet switching

capability.

l Performs system communication and

control.

l Provides the clock processing function and

supports one external clock input/output

function.

l Provides one Ethernet NM interface, one

 NM serial interface, and one NE cascading

interface.

IF1 SDH IF

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

l Provides one IF interface.

l Supports the TU-based PDH microwave

solution and the STM-1-based SDH

microwave solution.

IFU2 Universal IF

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

l Provides one IF interface.

l Supports the Hybrid microwave solution.

l Supports AM.

IFX2 Universal

XPIC IF

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

l Provides one IF interface.

l Supports the XPIC function of the Hybrid

microwave.

l Supports the AM of the Hybrid

microwave.

SL1D 2xSTM-1

interface

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

Uses the SFP module to provide two STM-1

optical interfaces.

EM6T 6 Port RJ45

Ethernet/

GigabitEthernet

Interface

Board

Slot 1 to slot

6

l Provides four FE electrical interfaces.

l Provides two GE electrical interfaces that

are compatible with the FE electricalinterface.

EM6F 4 Port RJ45 +

2 Port SFP

Fast

Ethernet/

Gigabit

Ethernet

Interface

Board

l Provides four FE electrical interfaces.

l Uses the SFP module to provide two GE

optical or electrical interfaces. The GE

electrical interfaces are compatible with

the FE electrical interfaces.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-5

Page 42: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 42/496

BoardName

FullSpelling Valid Slot Description

SP3S 16xE1

tributary

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

Provides sixteen 75-ohm or 120-ohm E1

interfaces.

SP3D 32xE1

tributary

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

Provides thirty-two 75-ohm or 120-ohm E1

interfaces.

AUX Auxiliary

interface

 board

Slot 1 to slot

6

Provides one orderwire interface, one

asynchronous data interface, one

synchronous data interface, and four-input

and two-output external alarm interfaces.

TND1PIU Power board Slot 9 or slot

10

Provides one -48 V/-60 V DC power input.

TND1FAN Fan board Slot 11 Cools and ventilates the IDU.

 

3.3 CST

The CST is the integrated TDM system control and communication, switching, and clock board.

3.3.1 Version Description

The functional version of the CST is SL91.

3.3.2 Functions and Features

The CST provides the time division cross-connection, system control and communication, and

clock processing functions. In addition, the CST provides the auxiliary interfaces and

management interfaces.

3.3.3 Working Principle

The CST comprises the system control and communication unit, cross-connect unit, clock unit,

and power supply unit.

3.3.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, auxiliary interfaces, buttons, and labels on the front

 panel.

3.3.5 DIP Switches and CF Card

This board has a set of DIP switches and a pluggable CF card.

3.3.6 Valid Slots

The CST can be inserted in slot 7 or slot 8 in the IDU chassis. The logical slot of the CST on

the NMS should be the same as the physical slot.

3.3.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the CST.

3.3.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the cross-connection performance, clock 

 performance, wayside service interface performance, board mechanical behavior, and board power consumption.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 43: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 43/496

3.3.1 Version Description

The functional version of the CST is SL91.

3.3.2 Functions and Features

The CST provides the time division cross-connection, system control and communication, and

clock processing functions. In addition, the CST provides the auxiliary interfaces and

management interfaces.

Cross-Connection

l Grooms TDM service signals between boards.

l Supports full time division cross-connections at the VC-12, VC-3, or VC-4 level, which

are equivalent to 32x32 VC-4s.

System Control and Communication

l Provides the system control and communication function to manage the other boards and

the ODUs by using the NE software.

l Controls the other boards by using the board software that runs on the system control and

communication unit.

l Monitors and collects performance events and alarms of all the boards.

l Communicates with the NMS and the other NEs and provides up to 14 DCC channels.

l Cross-connects and processes overheads.

Clock Processing 

l Traces the clock source and provides the system clock and the frame headers of service

signals and overhead signals for the other boards.

l Supports one input and one output of the external clock.

l Supports the selection of the external clock source or the service clock source to be the

system clock source. The service clock source can be the SDH line clock, PDH tributary

clock or microwave air interface link clock.

l Supports clock protection based on the clock priority, synchronization status message

(SSM) protocol, or extended SSM protocol.

l Supports the timing loop and switching between the clock of the main system and the clock 

of the standby system. In addition, no bit errors should occur in the services in the case of 

a normal clock switching.

l Supports the detection of the state of the system clock source and the phase-locked loop.

l Supports the trace, holdover, and free-run modes.

Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the board

l Provides one Ethernet NM interface.

l Provides one NM serial interface.

l Provides one NE cascade interface.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-7

Page 44: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 44/496

Protection Processing 

l Supports the 1+1 hot backup for the system control unit, cross-connect unit, and clock unit.

Hence, the system automatically switches over to the standby system control and

communication board when the main system control and communication board is faulty.

l Performs the 1+1 and N+1 protection switching.

l Performs the linear MSP switching.

l Performs the clock protection switching.

l Performs the SNCP switching.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performancethresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the board reset.

l Detects the board temperature, alarm inputs/outputs, and overvoltage/undervoltage of the

-48 V power supply.

l Checks the indicators on all the boards.

l Supports the hot swapping and mis-insertion prevention functions.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

l Supports the local and remote loading of the FPGA and supports the misloading prevention

function.

l Supports the insertion and removal of the CF card and the backup of the configuration data.

The backup configuration data can be used for quick service restoration in the case of an

on-site board replacement.

3.3.3 Working Principle

The CST comprises the system control and communication unit, cross-connect unit, clock unit,

and power supply unit.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-8 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 45: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 45/496

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-4 Functional block diagram of the CST

Backplane

System control

and

communication

unit

Cross-connect

unit

Power

supply

unit

Clock unit

Clock signal required

by other boards

External clock signal

Clock interface

Control bus

TDM service

-48 V1

-48 V2

Supplies power to

the other units on

the board

Clock signal

to other units

on the board

+12 V power supplied

to the fans

+3.3 V power supplied to

other boards

NE cascade

interface

NM interface

NM serial

interface

FE signal System control and

communication unit

Clock unit

Time interface 1

Time

interface 2

Service board

 

System Control and Communication Unit

The system control and communication unit comprises the CPU unit and logic control unit. The

system control and communication unit performs the following functions:

l Controls and manages the other units on the board, and also collects alarms and performance

events through the control bus.

l Controls and manages the other boards in the IDU, and also collects alarms and performance

events through the control bus.

l Controls and manages the ODU by using the ODU control signal transmitted through the

control bus in the backplane and the SMODEM in the IF board.

l Processes the network management messages in the DCCs through the logic control unit.

l The CPU unit communicates with the NMS through the Ethernet NM interface and NE

cascade interface.

l The CPU unit reads the information from the CF card through the bus and loads the

software.

l The logic control unit decodes the address read/write signals from the CPU unit and loads

the FPGA software.

l

The logic control unit cross-connects the overheads of the auxiliary interface unit, CPUunit, and other boards, thus realizing the following functions:

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-9

Page 46: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 46/496

– Adds or drops the DCC information processed by the CPU unit.

– Adds or drops the orderwire, synchronous data and asynchronous data services.

– Realizes the interchange of the orderwire bytes, DCC bytes, and K bytes between

different lines.

l The system control and communication unit on the board communicates with the system

control and communication unit on the paired board by carrying the FE signal over the

communication bus in the backplane. In this manner, the 1+1 hot backup between the paired

 boards is realized.

Cross-Connect Unit

The cross-connect unit grooms services over the entire system through the higher order cross-

connect unit and the lower order cross-connect unit. Figure 3-5 shows the functional block 

diagram of the cross-connect unit.

Figure 3-5 Functional block diagram of the cross-connect unit

Source TDM

service unit

HOXC

LOXC

Sink TDMservice unit

 

The source TDM service unit transmits the VC-4 signals to the higher order cross-connect unit

through the VC-4 buses. If the VC-4 signals are all VC-4 services, the higher order cross-connect

unit processes the VC-4 signals and then transmits the signals to the sink TDM service unit. If the VC-4 signals include any VC-12 or VC-3 services, the higher order cross-connect unit

grooms the VC-12 or VC-3 services to the lower order cross-connect unit. The lower order cross-

connect unit processes the VC-12 or VC-3 services and then transmits the services back to the

higher order cross-connect unit. The higher order cross-connect unit processes the services and

then transmits the services to the sink TDM service unit.

Clock Unit

l The clock unit selects the external clock source or the service clock source from a service

interface according the clock priority. Through the phase-locked loop, the clock unit

 provides the system clock.

l The main and standby boards transmit the clock to each other.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 47: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 47/496

Power Supply Unit

The power supply unit performs the following functions:

l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the power supply required by

the chips of the other units on the system control and communication board.l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the +3.3 V power required

 by the other boards in the IDU.

l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the +12 V power required by

the fan.

3.3.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, auxiliary interfaces, buttons, and labels on the front

 panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-6 Front panel of the CST

    C    S    T

    S    T    A    T

    P    R    O    G

    S    Y    N    C

    A    C    T

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2CF RCV RST    S    R    V

 

Indicator

Table 3-2 Description of the indicators on the CST

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board operates normally.

On (red) The hardware of the board is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

PROG On for 100 ms (green) and

off for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the software is being loaded.

On for 300 ms (green) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the board software is in

BIOS boot state.

On (green) The upper layer software is being

initialized.

On for 100 ms (red) and off 

for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

reset, the BOOTROM self-check fails.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-11

Page 48: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 48/496

Indicator State Meaning  

On (red) When the board is being powered or  

 being reset, the memory self-check fails

or loading upper layer software fails.

When the board is running, the logic file

or upper layer software is lost.

The pluggable storage card is faulty.

Off The software runs normally.

SYNC On (green) The clock is normal.

On (red) The clock source is lost or is switched.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in thesystem.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the

system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system

in the unprotected system.

The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

ACT On (green) The board is in the active state in the 1+1

 protection system.

The board is already activated in the

unprotected system.

Off The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

The board is not activated in the

unprotected system.

 

Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the CST

Table 3-3 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the CSH

Interface Description Connector Type

 NMS/COM NM interface/NM serial interface

RJ-45

EXT NE cascade interface

CLK/TOD1 External clock interface/The first time interface

(2048 kbit/s or 2048 kHz)/The wayside E1

interface

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-12 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 49: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 49/496

Interface Description Connector Type

TOD2 The second time interface

CF RCV CF configuration reset button -

RST Board warm reset button -

 

NOTE

l The external clock interface and wayside E1 interface are combined into one interface. This interface

can transparently transmit the DCC byte, orderwire overhead byte, and synchronous/asynchronous data

service overhead byte. One interface, however, can implement only one of the three functions: external

clock interface, wayside E1 service, and transparent transmission of the overhead byte.

l The 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface can transparently transmit the orderwire byte. One interface,

however, can implement only one of the two functions: 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface andtransparent transmission of the orderwire byte.

The auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces use RJ-45 connectors. The pin assignments

of the interfaces, however, are different. Figure 3-7 shows the front view of the RJ-45 connector.

Figure 3-7 Front view of the RJ-45 connector 

8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

 

Table 3-4 Pin assignment of the NMS/COM interface

Interface Pin Signal

 NMS/COM

1 Transmitting data (+)

2 Transmitting data (-)

3 Receiving data (+)

4 Grounding end of the NM serial

interface

5 Receive end of the NM serial interface

6 Receiving data (-)

7 Not defined

8 Transmit end of the NM serial

interface

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-13

Page 50: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 50/496

Table 3-5 Pin assignment of the EXT interface

Interface Pin Signal

EXT

1 Transmitting data (+)

2 Transmitting data (-)

3 Receiving data (+)

6 Receiving data (-)

4, 5, 7, 8 Not defined

 

NOTE

The EXT interface supports the MDI/MDI-X auto-negotiation. That is, the EXT interface can transmit data

through pins 3 and 6 and can receive data through pins 1 and 2.

The RJ-45 connector has two indicators. For the meanings of the states of the indicators, see

Table 3-6.

Table 3-6 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector 

Indicator State Meaning  

LINK (green) On The link is normal.

Off The link fails.

ACT (yellow) On or blinking The interface is transmitting or  receiving data.

Off The interface is not transmitting or  

receiving data.

 

NOTE

The NMS/COM interface and the EXT interface are equivalent to two ports on a hub. Thus, ensure that no

external Ethernet link is configured between the two interfaces during the networking process. Otherwise,

an Ethernet loop is formed. As a result, a network storm is generated, wherein repeated resets are performed

on the NEs.

Figure 3-8 shows the two common incorrect connections.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-14 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 51: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 51/496

Figure 3-8 Incorrect connections between the NMS/COM interface and the NE interface

    C    S    T

    S    T    A    T

    P    R    O    G

    S    Y    N    C

    S    R    V

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2C F R CV R ST

    C    S    T

    S    T    A    T

    P    R    O    G

    S    Y    N    C

    S    R    V

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2CF RCV RS T

LAN

    A    C    T

    A    C    T

 

NOTE

When the OptiX RTN 950 is configured with two system control boards, the NM interfaces and NE cascade

interfaces of the system control boards are equivalent to four ports on a hub. To avoid network storms, you

need to use the NM interface and NE cascade interface of the working system control board, if possible.

The clock interface (CLK) and the high-precision time interface (TOD) use different pins of the

same RJ-4 connector. The pin assignment information of the CLK/TOD1 and TOD2 interfaces

is provided in Table 3-7 and Table 3-8.

NOTE

Pins 3 and 6-8 of the CLK/TOD1 and TOD2 interfaces are reserved for running the high-precision time

 protocol (IEEE 1588 protocol) and are not used in this product version.

Table 3-7 Pin assignment of the CLK/TOD1 interface

Pin Working Mode

External Clock

ExternalTime Input

(1 PPS +TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

ExternalTime Input

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

1 CLK  

receivin

g (-)

 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

2 CLK  

receivin

g (+)

 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

3 Not

defined

1 PPS signal

input (-)

(RS-422

level)

1 PPS signal

output (-)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal input (-)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal output (-)

(RS-422 level)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-15

Page 52: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 52/496

Pin Working Mode

External Clock

ExternalTime Input

(1 PPS +TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

ExternalTime Input

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

4 CLK  

transmit

ting (-)

Grounding

end

Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

5 CLK  

transmit

ting (+)

Grounding

end

Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

6 Notdefined

1 PPS signalinput (+)

(RS-422

level)

1 PPS signaloutput (+)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS timesignal input (+)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS timesignal output (+)

(RS-422 level)

7 Not

defined

Time

information

input (-)

(RS-422

level)

Time

information

output (-)

(RS-422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

8 Not

defined

Time

information

input (+)

(RS-422

level)

Time

information

output (+)

(RS-422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

 

Table 3-8 Pin assignment of the TOD2 interface

Pin Working  mode

 

External TimeInput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeInput

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

1 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

2 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

3 1 PPS signal

input (-)

(RS422 level)

1 PPS signal

output (-)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

input (-)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

output (-)

(RS422 level)

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-16 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 53: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 53/496

Pin Working  mode

 

External TimeInput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeInput

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

4 Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

5 Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

6 1 PPS signal

input (+)

(RS422 level)

1 PPS signal

output (+)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

input (+)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

output (+)

(RS422 level)

7 Time

informationinput (-)

(RS422 level)

Time information

output (-)

(RS422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

8 Time

information

input (+)

(RS422 level)

Time information

output (+)

(RS422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

 

3.3.5 DIP Switches and CF CardThis board has a set of DIP switches and a pluggable CF card.

The CF card stores the following information:

l All the data of the NE, including the NE ID, NE IP address, and service data

l  NE software and all the board software programs

l All the FPGA files

l License file for microwave link capability

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-17

Page 54: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 54/496

Figure 3-9 Positions of the DIP switches and CF card

ON DIP

1 2 3 4

2

1

 

1. DIP switches 2. CF card

Table 3-9 Setting the DIP switches

Setting the DIP Switchesa

Function

1 2 3 4

0 0 0 0 Normal

operating state

when the

watchdog is

enabled.

0 0 0 1 Reserved.

0 0 1 0 Memory self-

check state.

0 0 1 1 Commissioning

state.

0 1 0 0 Operating state

when the

watchdog is

disabled and the

full memory

check is

 performed.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-18 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 55: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 55/496

Setting the DIP Switchesa Function

1 2 3 4

0 1 0 1 BIOS holdover  

state.

0 1 1 0 BIOS exhibition

state.

0 1 1 1 Reserved (by

default,

operating state

when the

watchdog is

started).

1 0 0 0 Reserved (bydefault,

operating state

when the

watchdog is

started).

1 0 0 1 To recover the

data of the CF

card.

1 0 1 0 To erase the data

in the system

 parameter area.

1 0 1 1 To erase the

databases.

1 1 0 0 To erase the NE

software,

including the

 patches.

1 1 0 1 To erase the

databases and

 NE software

(including the

 patches).

1 1 1 0 To format the

file system, that

is, to erase all

the data in the

file system.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-19

Page 56: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 56/496

Setting the DIP Switchesa Function

1 2 3 4

1 1 1 1 To format the

file system so

that all the data

is erased (file

system +

extended BIOS

+ system

 parameter area).

 

NOTE

a: When a DIP switch is turned to the numeral side, it represents the binary digit 1. When a DIP switch isturned to the letter side, it represents the binary digit 0.

3.3.6 Valid Slots

The CST can be inserted in slot 7 or slot 8 in the IDU chassis. The logical slot of the CST on

the NMS should be the same as the physical slot.

Figure 3-10 Slot for the CST in the IDU chassis

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7 (CST)

Slot 1 (EXT)

Slot 5 (EXT)

Slot 3 (EXT)

Slot 2 (EXT)

Slot 4 (EXT)

Slot 6 (EXT)

Slot 8 (CST)Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11

(FAN)

 

Figure 3-11 Logical slot for the logical board of the CST

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7 (CST)

Slot 1 (EXT)

Slot 5 (EXT)

Slot 3 (EXT)

Slot 2 (EXT)

Slot 4 (EXT)

Slot 6 (EXT)

Slot 8 (CST)Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11

(FAN)

 

Table 3-10 Slot allocation

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slot 7 > Slot 8

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-20 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 57: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 57/496

3.3.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the CST.

Related References

A.3.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting

A.7.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table

A.7.9 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status

A.13.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General

A.13.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port

A.13.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port

A.13.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface

3.3.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the cross-connection performance, clock 

 performance, wayside service interface performance, board mechanical behavior, and board

 power consumption.

Cross-Connection Performance

Supports full time division cross-connections at the VC-12, VC-3, or VC-4 level, which are

equivalent to 32x32 VC-4s.

Clock Timing and Synchronization Performance

The clock timing and synchronization performance meets the relevant standards specified in the

ITU-T Recommendations.

Table 3-11 Clock timing and synchronization performance

Item Performance

External synchronization

source

2048 kbit/s (compliant with ITU-T G.703 §9), or 2048 kHz

(compliant with ITU-T G.703 §13)

Frequency accuracy Compliant with ITU-T G.813

Pull-in, hold-in, and pull-out

ranges

 Noise generation

 Noise tolerance

 Noise transfer 

Transient response and

holdover performance

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-21

Page 58: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 58/496

 Wayside Service Interface Performance

Table 3-12 Wayside service interface performance

Item PerformanceTransmission path Uses the Huawei-defined bytes in the overhead of the

microwave frame.

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 2048

Impedance (ohm) 120

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-13 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 22.36 mm (height) x 199.60 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width)

Weight 0.72 kg

 

Power Consumption

Power consumption: < 20.7W

3.4 CSH

The CSH is an Hybrid system control, cross-connect, and timing board.

3.4.1 Version Description

The functional version of the CSH is SL91.

3.4.2 Functions and Features

The CSH provides the 10 Gbit/s packet switching, full time division cross-connection, systemcontrol and communication, and clock processing functions. In addition, the CSH provides

auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces.

3.4.3 Working Principle

The CSH comprises the system control and communication unit, packet switching unit, cross-

connect unit, clock unit, and power supply unit.

3.4.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, auxiliary interfaces, and buttons on the front panel.

3.4.5 DIP Switches and CF Card

This board has a set of DIP switches and a pluggable CF card.

3.4.6 Valid Slots

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-22 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 59: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 59/496

The CSH can be inserted in slot 7 or slot 8 in the IDU chassis. The logical slot of the CSH on

the NMS should be the same as the physical slot.

3.4.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the CSH.

3.4.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the packet switching performance, cross-

connection performance, clock performance, wayside service interface performance, board

mechanical behavior, and power consumption.

3.4.1 Version Description

The functional version of the CSH is SL91.

3.4.2 Functions and Features

The CSH provides the 10 Gbit/s packet switching, full time division cross-connection, system

control and communication, and clock processing functions. In addition, the CSH provides

auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces.

Packet Switching 

l Supports the E-Line and E-LAN services.

l Supports the addition, deletion, and switching of IEEE 802.1q/p-compliant VLAN tags and

forwards packets based on the VLAN tags.

l Supports the MAC address learning function.

l Supports the MSTP protocol that adopts only the common and internal spanning tree

(CIST).

l Supports the IGMP Snooping protocol.

l Supports the QoS function.

l Supports the ITU-T G.8032-compliant ERPS Ethernet ring protection.

l Supports the disabling of the Ethernet interface connecting to the user equipment when a

fault occurs on the transmission network.

l Supports two aggregation modes (namely, manual aggregation and static aggregation) and

two load sharing types (namely, sharing and non-sharing). The load sharing algorithm is

 based on the hash algorithm of the MAC address or the IP address.

l Supports the Ethernet OAM functions that are compliant with IEEE 802.1ag and IEEE

802.3ah.

l Supports the synchronous Ethernet that is compliant with ITU-T G.8261 and ITU-T G.

8262.

Cross-Connection

l Grooms TDM service signals between boards.

l Supports full time division cross-connections at the VC-12, VC-3, or VC-4 level, which

are equivalent to 32x32 VC-4s.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-23

Page 60: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 60/496

System Control and Communication

l Provides the system control and communication function to manage the other boards and

the ODUs by using the NE software.

l Controls the other boards by using the board software that runs on the system control and

communication unit.

l Monitors and collects performance events and alarms of all the boards.

l Communicates with the NMS and the other NEs and provides up to 14 DCC channels.

l Cross-connects and processes overheads.

Clock Processing 

l Traces the clock source and provides the system clock and the frame headers of service

signals and overhead signals for the other boards.

l Supports one input and one output of the external clock.

l Supports the selection of the external clock source or the service clock source to be the

system clock source. The service clock source can be the SDH line clock, PDH tributary

clock, Ethernet interface line clock, or microwave air interface link clock.

l Supports clock protection based on the clock priority, Synchronization Status Message

(SSM) protocol, or extended SSM protocol.

l Supports the timing loop and switching between the clock of the main system and the clock 

of the standby system. In addition, no bit errors should occur in the services in the case of 

a normal clock switching.

l Supports the detection of the state of the system clock source and the phase-locked loop.

l Supports the trace, holdover, and free-run modes.

Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the board

l Provides one Ethernet NM interface.

l Provides one NM serial interface.

l Provides one NE cascade interface.

Protection Processing 

l Supports the 1+1 hot backup for the system control unit, packet switching unit, cross-

connect unit, and clock unit. Thus, the system automatically switches over to the standby

system control and communication board when the main system control andcommunication board is faulty.

l Performs the 1+1 and N+1 protection switching.

l Performs the linear MSP switching.

l Performs the clock protection switching.

l Performs the SNCP switching.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l

Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function andsetting the BER threshold.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-24 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 61: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 61/496

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the board reset.

l Detects the board temperature, alarm inputs/outputs, and overvoltage/undervoltage of the

-48 V power supply.

l Checks the indicators on all the boards.

l Supports the hot swapping and mis-insertion prevention functions.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

l Supports the local and remote loading of the FPGA and supports the misloading preventionfunction.

l Supports the insertion and removal of the CF card and the backup of the configuration data.

The backup configuration data can be used for quick service restoration in the case of an

on-site board replacement.

3.4.3 Working Principle

The CSH comprises the system control and communication unit, packet switching unit, cross-

connect unit, clock unit, and power supply unit.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-25

Page 62: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 62/496

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-12 Functional block diagram of the CSH

Backplane

System control

and

communication

unit

Cross-connect unit

Power

supplyunit

Clock unit

Clock signal required

by other boards

External clock signal

Clock interface

Control bus

TDM service

-48 V1

-48 V2

Supplies power to

the other units onthe board

Clock signal

provided to other

units on the board

+12 V power supplied to

the fans

+3.3 V power supplied to

other boards

NE cascade

interface

Packet

switching unit

GE bus

NM interfaceNM serial

interface

FE signalSystem control and

communication unit

Clock unit

Time interface 2

Time

interface 1

Service board

Service board

 

System Control and Communication Unit

The system control and communication unit comprises the CPU unit and logic control unit. The

system control and communication unit performs the following functions:

l Controls and manages the other units on the board, and also collects alarms and performance

events through the control bus.

l Controls and manages the other boards in the IDU, and also collects alarms and performance

events through the control bus.

l Controls and manages the ODU by using the ODU control signal transmitted through the

control bus in the backplane and the SMODEM in the IF board.

l The CPU unit drives the packet switching unit to groom Ethernet service packets, through

the control bus.

l

The CPU unit processes the Ethernet protocol packets from the packet switching unit,through the control bus.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-26 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 63: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 63/496

l Processes the network management messages in the DCCs through the logic control unit.

l The CPU unit communicates with the NMS through the Ethernet NM interface and NE

cascade interface.

l The CPU unit reads the information from the CF card through the bus and loads the

software.

l The logic control unit decodes the address read/write signals from the CPU unit and loads

the FPGA software.

l The logic control unit cross-connects the overheads of the auxiliary interface unit, CPU

unit, and other boards, thus realizing the following functions:

– Adds or drops the DCC information processed by the CPU unit.

– Adds or drops the orderwire, synchronous data and asynchronous data services.

– Realizes the interchange of the orderwire bytes, DCC bytes, and K bytes between

different lines.

l The system control and communication unit on the board communicates with the system

control and communication unit on the paired board by carrying the FE signal over the

communication bus in the backplane. In this manner, the 1+1 hot backup between the paired

 boards is realized.

Packet Switching Unit

The main functional unit of the packet switching unit is the Layer 2 switching unit. The Layer 

2 switching unit performs the operations related to the Layer 2 switching and Layer 2 protocol.

l After receiving Ethernet services from the other Ethernet boards, the packet switching unit

grooms the Ethernet services based on the configurations that are issued from the system

control and communication unit.

l After receiving protocol packets from the other Ethernet boards, the packet switching unit

transmits the protocol packets to the system control and communication unit for processing.

The system control and communication unit processes the protocol packets and then sends

the protocol packets back to the packet switching unit. The packet switching unit transmits

the protocol packets to the other Ethernet boards.

Cross-Connect Unit

The cross-connect unit grooms services over the entire system through the higher order cross-

connect unit and the lower order cross-connect unit. Figure 3-13 shows the functional block 

diagram of the cross-connect unit.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-27

Page 64: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 64/496

Figure 3-13 Functional block diagram of the cross-connect unit

Source TDM

service unit

HOXC

LOXC

Sink TDMservice unit

 

The source TDM service unit transmits the VC-4 signals to the higher order cross-connect unit

through the VC-4 buses. If the VC-4 signals are all VC-4 services, the higher order cross-connect

unit processes the VC-4 signals and then transmits the signals to the sink TDM service unit. If 

the VC-4 signals include any VC-12 or VC-3 services, the higher order cross-connect unit

grooms the VC-12 or VC-3 services to the lower order cross-connect unit. The lower order cross-

connect unit processes the VC-12 or VC-3 services and then transmits the services back to the

higher order cross-connect unit. The higher order cross-connect unit processes the services and

then transmits the services to the sink TDM service unit.

Clock Unit

l The clock unit selects the external clock source or the service clock source from a service

interface according the clock priority. Through the phase-locked loop, the clock unit

 provides the system clock.

l The main and standby boards transmit the clock to each other.

Power Supply Unit

The power supply unit performs the following functions:

l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the power supply required by

the chips of the other units on the system control and communication board.

l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the +3.3 V power required

 by the other boards in the IDU.

l Combines and then converts the two -48 V power inputs into the +12 V power required by

the fan.

3.4.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, auxiliary interfaces, and buttons on the front panel.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-28 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 65: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 65/496

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-14 Front panel of the CSH

    C    S    H

    S    T    A    T

    P    R    O    G

    S    Y    N    C    S    R    V

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2CF RCV RST

    A    C    T

 

Indicator

Table 3-14 Description of the indicators on the CSH

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board operates normally.

On (red) The hardware of the board is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

PROG On for 100 ms (green) and

off for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the software is being loaded.

On for 300 ms (green) andoff for 300 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or  being reset, the board software is in

BIOS boot state.

On (green) The upper layer software is being

initialized.

On for 100 ms (red) and off 

for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

reset, the BOOTROM self-check fails.

On (red) When the board is being powered or  

 being reset, the memory self-check fails

or loading upper layer software fails.

When the board is running, the logic file

or upper layer software is lost.

The pluggable storage card is faulty.

Off The software runs normally.

SYNC On (green) The clock is normal.

On (red) The clock source is lost or is switched.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-29

Page 66: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 66/496

Indicator State Meaning  

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the

system.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in thesystem.

Off There is no power supplied to the system

in the unprotected system.

The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

ACT On (green) The board is in the active state in the 1+1

 protection system.

The board is already activated in the

unprotected system.

Off The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

The board is not activated in the

unprotected system.

 

Auxiliary Interfaces and Management Interfaces

Table 3-15 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces on the CSH

Interface Description Connector Type

 NMS/COM NM interface/NM serial interface

RJ-45

EXT NE cascade interface

CLK/TOD1 External clock interface/The first time interface

(2048 kbit/s or 2048 kHz)/The wayside E1

interface

TOD2 The second time interface

CF RCV CF configuration reset button -

RST Board warm reset button -

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-30 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 67: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 67/496

NOTE

l The external clock interface and wayside E1 interface are combined into one interface. This interface

can transparently transmit the DCC byte, orderwire overhead byte, and synchronous/asynchronous data

service overhead byte. One interface, however, can implement only one of the three functions: external

clock interface, wayside E1 service, and transparent transmission of the overhead byte.l The 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface can transparently transmit the orderwire byte. One interface,

however, can implement only one of the two functions: 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface and

transparent transmission of the orderwire byte.

The auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces use RJ-45 connectors. The pin assignments

of the interfaces, however, are different. Figure 3-15 shows the front view of the RJ-45

connector.

Figure 3-15 Front view of the RJ-45 connector 

8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

 

Table 3-16 Pin assignment of the NMS/COM interface

Interface Pin Signal

 NMS/COM

1 Transmitting data (+)

2 Transmitting data (-)

3 Receiving data (+)

4 Grounding end of the NM serial

interface

5 Receive end of the NM serial interface

6 Receiving data (-)

7 Not defined

8 Transmit end of the NM serial

interface

 

Table 3-17 Pin assignment of the EXT interface

Interface Pin Signal

EXT1 Transmitting data (+)

2 Transmitting data (-)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-31

Page 68: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 68/496

Interface Pin Signal

3 Receiving data (+)

6 Receiving data (-)

4, 5, 7, 8 Not defined

 

NOTE

The EXT interface supports the MDI/MDI-X auto-negotiation. That is, the EXT interface can transmit data

through pins 3 and 6 and can receive data through pins 1 and 2.

The RJ-45 connector has two indicators. For the meanings of the states of the indicators, see

Table 3-18.

Table 3-18 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector 

Indicator State Meaning  

LINK (green) On The link is normal.

Off The link fails.

ACT (yellow) On or blinking The interface is transmitting or  

receiving data.

Off The interface is not transmitting or  

receiving data.

 

NOTE

The NMS/COM interface and the EXT interface are equivalent to two ports on a hub. Thus, ensure that no

external Ethernet link is configured between the two interfaces during the networking process. Otherwise,

an Ethernet loop is formed. As a result, a network storm is generated, wherein repeated resets are performed

on the NEs.

Figure 3-16 shows the two common incorrect connections.

Figure 3-16 Incorrect connections between the NMS/COM interface and the NE interface

    C    S    H

    S

    T    A    T

    P

    R    O    G

    S

    Y    N    C

    S    R    V

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2C F R CV R ST

    C    S    H

    S    T    A    T

    P    R    O    G

    S    Y    N    C

    S    R    V

NMS/COM EXT CLK/TOD1 TOD2CF RCV RS T

LAN

    A    C    T

    A    C    T

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-32 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 69: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 69/496

 

NOTE

When the OptiX RTN 950 is configured with two system control boards, the NM interfaces and NE cascade

interfaces of the system control boards are equivalent to four ports on a hub. To avoid network storms, you

need to use the NM interface and NE cascade interface of the working system control board, if possible.

The clock interface (CLK) and the high-precision time interface (TOD) share the same RJ-45

interface (CLK/TOD) but occupy different pins of the RJ-45 interface. The pin assignment

information of the CLK/OD1 and TOD2 interfaces is provided in Table 3-19 and Table 3-20.

NOTE

Pins 3 and 6-8 are reserved for running the high-precision time protocol (IEEE 1588 protocol) and are not

used in this product version.

Table 3-19 Pin assignment of the CLK/TOD1 interface

Pin Working Mode

External Clock

ExternalTime Input

(1 PPS +TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

ExternalTime Input

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

1 CLK  

receivin

g (-)

 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

2 CLK  

receivin

g (+)

 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

3 Not

defined

1 PPS signal

input (-)

(RS-422

level)

1 PPS signal

output (-)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal input (-)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal output (-)

(RS-422 level)

4 CLK  

transmit

ting (-)

Grounding

end

Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

5 CLK  transmit

ting (+)

Groundingend

Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

6 Not

defined

1 PPS signal

input (+)

(RS-422

level)

1 PPS signal

output (+)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal input (+)

(RS-422 level)

DCLS time

signal output (+)

(RS-422 level)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-33

Page 70: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 70/496

Pin Working Mode

External Clock

ExternalTime Input

(1 PPS +TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

ExternalTime Input

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

7 Not

defined

Time

information

input (-)

(RS-422

level)

Time

information

output (-)

(RS-422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

8 Not

defined

Time

informationinput (+)

(RS-422

level)

Time

informationoutput (+)

(RS-422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

 

Table 3-20 Pin assignment of the TOD2 interface

Pin Working  mode

 

External TimeInput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeInput

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

1 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

2 Not defined Not defined Not defined Not defined

3 1 PPS signal

input (-)

(RS422 level)

1 PPS signal

output (-)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

input (-)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

output (-)

(RS422 level)

4 Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

5 Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end Grounding end

6 1 PPS signal

input (+)

(RS422 level)

1 PPS signal

output (+)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

input (+)

(RS422 level)

DCLS time signal

output (+)

(RS422 level)

7 Time

information

input (-)

(RS422 level)

Time information

output (-)

(RS422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-34 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 71: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 71/496

Pin Working  mode

 

External TimeInput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeOutput

(1 PPS + TimeInformation)

External TimeInput

(DCLS)

External TimeOutput

(DCLS)

8 Time

information

input (+)

(RS422 level)

Time information

output (+)

(RS422 level)

 Not defined Not defined

 

3.4.5 DIP Switches and CF CardThis board has a set of DIP switches and a pluggable CF card.

The CF card stores the following information:

l All the data of the NE, including the NE ID, NE IP address, and service data

l  NE software and all the board software programs

l All the FPGA files

l License file for microwave link capability

Figure 3-17 Positions of the DIP switches and CF card

ON DIP

1 2 3 4

2

1

 

1. DIP switches 2. CF card

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-35

Page 72: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 72/496

Table 3-21 Setting the DIP switches

Setting the DIP Switchesa Function

1 2 3 4

0 0 0 0 Normal

operating state

when the

watchdog is

enabled.

0 0 0 1 Reserved.

0 0 1 0 Memory self-

check state.

0 0 1 1 Commissioning

state.

0 1 0 0 Operating state

when the

watchdog is

disabled and the

full memory

check is

 performed.

0 1 0 1 BIOS holdover  

state.

0 1 1 0 BIOS exhibitionstate.

0 1 1 1 Reserved (by

default,

operating state

when the

watchdog is

started).

1 0 0 0 Reserved (by

default,

operating statewhen the

watchdog is

started).

1 0 0 1 To recover the

data of the CF

card.

1 0 1 0 To erase the data

in the system

 parameter area.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-36 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 73: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 73/496

Page 74: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 74/496

Figure 3-19 Logical slot for the logical board of the CSH

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 7 (CSH)

Slot 1 (EXT)

Slot 5 (EXT)

Slot 3 (EXT)

Slot 2 (EXT)

Slot 4 (EXT)

Slot 6 (EXT)

Slot 8 (CSH)Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11

(FAN)

 

Table 3-22 Slot allocation

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slot 7 > Slot 8

 

3.4.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the CSH.

Related References

A.3.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting

A.7.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table

A.7.9 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status

A.13.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General

A.13.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port

A.13.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port

A.13.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface

3.4.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the packet switching performance, cross-

connection performance, clock performance, wayside service interface performance, board

mechanical behavior, and power consumption.

Packet Switching 

Supports the 10Gbit/s packet switching function.

Cross-Connection Performance

Supports full time division cross-connections at the VC-12, VC-3, or VC-4 level, which are

equivalent to 32x32 VC-4s.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-38 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 75: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 75/496

Clock Timing and Synchronization Performance

The clock timing and synchronization performance meets the relevant standards specified in the

ITU-T Recommendations.

Table 3-23 Clock timing and synchronization performance

Item Performance

External synchronization

source

2048 kbit/s (compliant with ITU-T G.703 §9), or 2048 kHz

(compliant with ITU-T G.703 §13)

Frequency accuracy Compliant with ITU-T G.813

Pull-in, hold-in, and pull-out

ranges

 Noise generation

 Noise tolerance

 Noise transfer 

Transient response and

holdover performance

 

 Wayside Service Interface Performance

Table 3-24 Wayside service interface performance

Item Performance

Transmission path Uses the Huawei-defined bytes in the overhead of the

microwave frame.

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 2048

Impedance (ohm) 120

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-25 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 22.36 mm (height) x 199.60 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width)

Weight 0.74 kg

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-39

Page 76: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 76/496

Power Consumption

Power Consumption : < 25.3 W

3.5 IF1The IF1 is a medium-capacity SDH IF board and is available in two types, namely, IF1A and

IF1B. In this document, the IF1 is used to stand for both the IF1A and IF1B. The only difference

from the IF1B is that the IF1A is more reliable. The IF1 supports the DC-C power distribution

modes.

3.5.1 Version Description

The functional version of the IF1 is SL91.

3.5.2 Functions and Features

The IF1 receives and transmits one IF signal and provides the management channel to the ODU

and supplies the required -48 V power to the ODU.

3.5.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one IF signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the IF1.

3.5.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, an IF interface, and an ODU power switch on the front panel.

3.5.5 Valid Slots

The IF1 can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the IF1 on the NMS should be the same

as the physical slots.

3.5.6 Board Parameter SettingsThis topic pr ovides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the IF1.

3.5.7 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including baseband signal processing performance

of the modem, IF performance, board mechanical behavior, and board power consumption.

3.5.1 Version Description

The functional version of the IF1 is SL91.

3.5.2 Functions and FeaturesThe IF1 receives and transmits one IF signal and provides the management channel to the ODU

and supplies the required -48 V power to the ODU.

IF Processing 

l Maps SDH and PDH service signals into microwave frame signals.

l Codes and decodes microwave frame signals.

l Modulates and demodulates microwave frame signals.

l Modulates and demodulates ODU control signals.

l Combines and splits service signals, ODU control signals, and -48 V power supplies.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-40 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 77: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 77/496

Overhead Processing 

l Processes the regenerator section overheads of the SDH microwave signals.

l Processes the multiplex section overheads of the SDH microwave signals.

l Processes the higher order path overheads of the SDH microwave signals.l Processes the overheads of the PDH microwave frame signals.

l Supports the setting and query of the J0, J1, and C2 overhead bytes in the SDH microwave

signals.

l Supports the setting and query of the link ID.

NOTE

Higher order path overheads are processed in two modes, namely, the pass-through mode and termination mode.

In the pass-through mode, the path overheads are detected in the receive direction only and the overhead values

are not changed. In the termination mode, when the path overheads are detected in the receive direction, the

overhead bytes are re-set to the default values in the transmit direction. By default, the board adopts the pass-

through mode.

Pointer Processing 

l Processes the AU pointers in the SDH microwave signals.

l Processes the TU pointers in the PDH microwave signals.

Protection Processing 

l Supports 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection.

l Supports 1+1 FD/SD hitless switching.

l Supports N+1 protection.

l Supports the monitoring and reporting of the status of the working and protection channels

in an SNCP group.

l Supports the setting of SNCP switching conditions.

NOTE

For details on the 1+1 HSB, 1+1 FD, 1+1 SD, N+1 protection, and SNCP, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio

Transmission System Feature Description.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function andsetting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the inloop and outloop over IF interfaces.

l Supports the inloop and outloop at composite ports.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-41

Page 78: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 78/496

l Supports the detection of the board temperature.

l Supports the monitoring of the power supply and the clock.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.

l

Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.l Supports the in-service upgrade of the FPGA.

NOTE

l For details on the loopback function, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance

Guide.

l A warm reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control and communication unit

 but does not affect the services. A cold reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system

control and communication unit, the initiation of the board (if the board has the FPGA, the FPGA is

reloaded), and a service interruption.

3.5.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one IF signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the IF1.

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-20 Functional block diagram of the IF1

Backplane

Cross-connect unitI F I

F

processing

unit

Logicprocessingunit

System control and

communication unit

System control and

communication unit

MUX/DEMUXunit

MODEM

unit

Combiner

interface

unit

Power

supply

unit

SMODEM

unit

Clock

unit

Logic

control unit

System control and

communication unit

ODU control signal

Paired board

Microwave

frame signal

HSM switching signal

Service

bus

Overhead

bus

Control bus

-48 V

+3.3

V+3.3 power supplied

to the monitoring

circuit

-48 V power supplied

to the ODU

+3.3 V power supplied to

other modules on theboard

System clock signalClock signal provided

to the other units on

the board

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-42 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 79: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 79/496

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-26 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IF1

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow1 Combiner interface

unit

Separates the ODU control signal and the microwave

service signal from the IF signal.

2 SMODEM unit   l Demodulates the ODU control signal.

l Transmits the ODU control signal to the serial interface

of the CPU unit in the system control and

communication unit.

3 IF processing unit   l Controls the level of the service signal through the

automatic gain control (AGC) circuit.

l

Filters the signal.l Performs A/D conversion.

4 MODEM unit   l Performs digital demodulation.

l Performs time domain adaptive equalization.

l Performs FEC decoding and generates the

corresponding alarms.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-43

Page 80: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 80/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

5 MUX/DEMUX unit

(for SDH microwave

signal processing)

l Synchronizes the frames and detects the R_LOS and

R_LOF alarms.

l Performs descrambling.l Checks the B1 and B2 bytes and generates the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Checks the link ID and generates the corresponding

alarms.

l Checks bits 6-8 of the K2 byte and the M1 byte, and

generates the corresponding alarms and performance

events.

l Detects the changes in the SSM in the S1 byte and

reports the SSM status to the system control and

communication unit.

l Detects the changes in the ATPC message and the

microwave RDI, and reports the changes to the system

control and communication unit through the control

 bus.

l Extracts the orderwire bytes, auxiliary channel bytes

including the F1 and SERIAL bytes, DCC bytes, and

K bytes to form a 2 Mbit/s overhead signal, and

transmits the 2 Mbit/s overhead signal to the logic

 processing unit.

l Extracts the wayside service bytes to form another 2

Mbit/s overhead signal and transmits the 2 Mbit/s

overhead signal to the logic processing unit.

l Adjusts the AU pointer and generates the

corresponding performance events.

l Checks the higher order path overheads and generates

the corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Transmits the pointer indication signal and VC-4

signal to the logic processing unit.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-44 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 81: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 81/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

MUX/DEMUX unit

(for PDH microwave

signal processing)

l Detects the PDH microwave frame header and

generates the corresponding alarms and performance

events.

l Verifies the check code and generates the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Detects the link ID and generates the corresponding

alarms.

l Detects the changes in the ATPC message and the

microwave RDI, and reports the changes to the system

control and communication unit through the control

 bus.

l Extracts the orderwire bytes, auxiliary channel bytes

including the F1 and SERIAL bytes, and DCC bytes

from the PDH microwave frame to form a 2 Mbit/soverhead signal, and transmits the 2 Mbit/s overhead

signal to the logic processing unit.

l Adjusts the TU pointers.

l Maps the TU-12s of the PDH microwave signals into

the specified position in the VC-4.

6 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Multiplexes the 2 Mbit/s overhead signals into an 8

Mbit/s overhead signal and transmits the 8 Mbit/s

overhead signal to the system control and

communication unit. Each 2 Mbit/s overhead signaloccupies a 2 Mbit/s timeslot in the 8 Mbit/s overhead

 bandwidth.

l Transmits the VC-4 signal and pointer indication

signal to the main and standby cross-connect units.

 

NOTE

In the 1+1 FD/SD mode, the MUX/DEMUX unit transmits the service signals by HSM bus to the MUX/DEMUX

unit of the paired board. The MUX/DEMUX unit of the paired board selects the signal of higher quality for 

subsequent processing.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-45

Page 82: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 82/496

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-27 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IF1

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Demultiplexes the 8 Mbit/s overhead signal into 2

Mbit/s overhead signals.

l Receives the VC-4 signal and pointer indication signal

from the cross-connect unit.

2 MUX/DEMUX unit

(for SDH microwave

signal processing)

l Sets the higher order path overheads.

l Sets the AU pointer.

l Sets the multiplex section overheads.

l Sets the regenerator section overheads.

l Performs scrambling.

MUX/DEMUX unit

(for PDH microwave

signal processing)

l Demaps TU-12s from the VC-4 signal.

l Sets the PDH microwave frame overheads.

3 MODEM unit   l Performs FEC coding.

l Performs digital modulation.

4 IF processing unit   l Performs D/A conversion.

l Performs analog modulation.

5 SMODEM unit Modulates the ODU control signal that is transmitted

from the system control and communication unit.

6 Combiner interface

unit

Combines the ODU control signal, microwave service

signal, and -48 V power supplies, and transmits the

combined signals to the IF cable.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The board is directly controlled by the CPU unit of the system control and communication unit.

The CPU unit issues the configuration data and query commands to the other units of the board

through the control bus. The command responses, alarms, and performance events are also

reported to the CPU unit through the control bus.

The logic control unit decodes the read/write address signals from the CPU unit of the system

control and communication unit.

Power Supply unit

l Receives the -48 V power supply from the power supply bus in the backplane, performs

the start-relay, filtering, and DC-DC conversion operations, and then supplies the -48 V power to the ODU.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-46 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 83: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 83/496

l Receives the +3.3 V power from the power supply bus in the backplane and supplies the

+3.3 V power to the other units on the board.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.5.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, an IF interface, and an ODU power switch on the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-21 Front panel of the IF1

PULL

    I    F    1

IFI O

ODU-PWR

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

    L    I    N    K

    O    D    U

    R    M    T

    A    C    T

WARNING

-48V OUTPUT

TURN OFF POWER BEFOREDISCONNECTING IF CABLE

    I    F    1

 

Indicators

Table 3-28 Description of the indicators on the IF1

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LINK On (green) The space link is normal.

On (red) The space link is faulty.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-47

Page 84: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 84/496

Indicator State Meaning  

ODU On (green) The ODU works normally.

On (red)   l The logical board is not

added on the NMS

l The ODU has critical or 

major alarms.

l  No power is supplied.

On (yellow) The ODU has minor alarms.

On for 300 ms (yellow) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

The antennas are not aligned.

RMT On (yellow) The equipment at the

opposite end reports an RDI.

Off The equipment at the

opposite end does not report

an RDI.

ACT On (green)   l The board is in the active

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is already

activated in the

unprotected system.

Off    l The board is in the standbystate in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is not activated

in the unprotected system.

 

Interfaces

Table 3-29 Description of the Interfaces

Interface Description Connector Type Corresponding  Cable

IF IF interface TNC IF jumper b

ODU-PWR a ODU power switch - -

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-48 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 85: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 85/496

NOTE

a: The ODU-PWR switch is equipped with a lockup device. To turn on or turn off the switch, you need to

first pull the switch lever outwards slightly. When the switch is set to "O", it indicates that the circuit is

open. When the switch is set to "I", it indicates that the circuit is closed.

 b: The 5D IF cable is directly connected to the IF board. Hence, when the 5D IF cable is used, the IF jumper is not required.

Labels

There is a high temperature warning label, an operation warning label, and an operation guidance

label on the front panel.

The high temperature warning label indicates that the board surface temperature may exceed

70°C when the ambient temperature is higher than 55°C. In this case, you need to wear protective

gloves before handling the board.

The operation warning label indicates that you must turn off the ODU-PWR switch before

removing the IF cable.

The operation guidance label indicates that you need to pull the switch outward slightly before

setting the switch to the "I" or "O" position.

3.5.5 Valid Slots

The IF1 can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the IF1 on the NMS should be the same

as the physical slots.

Figure 3-22 Slots for the IF1 in the IDU chassis

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IF1)

Slot 5 (IF1)

Slot 3 (IF1)

Slot 2 (IF1)

Slot 4 (IF1)

Slot 6 (IF1)

Slot 8Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11(FAN)

 

The ODU is not inserted in a physical slot but has a logical slot on the NMS. The logical slot

number of the ODU is the logical slot number of the IF board that is connected to the ODU plus

20.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-49

Page 86: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 86/496

Figure 3-23 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IF1

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IF1)

Slot 5 (IF1)

Slot 3 (IF1)

Slot 2 (IF1)

Slot 4 (IF1)

Slot 6 (IF1)

Slot 8Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11(FAN)

Slot 25 (ODU)

Slot 23 (ODU)

Slot 21 (ODU)

Slot 26 (ODU)

Slot 24 (ODU)

Slot 22 (ODU)

 

Table 3-30 Slot allocation

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 3 and 5 > slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2

 

NOTE

When configured in a 1+1 IF protection group, two IF boards must be configured in a slot pair, namely,

slot 1 and slot 2, slot 3 and slot 5, or slot 4 and slot 6.

3.5.6 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the IF1.

Related References

A.14.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

A.14.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute

A.15.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs

3.5.7 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including baseband signal processing performance

of the modem, IF performance, board mechanical behavior, and board power consumption.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-50 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 87: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 87/496

IF Performance

Table 3-31 IF performance

Item PerformanceIF signal

Transmit frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

350

Receive frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

140

Impedance (ohm) 50

ODU O&M signal

Modulation mode ASK  

Transmit frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

5.5

Receive frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

10

 

Baseband Signal Processing Performance of the Modem

Table 3-32 Baseband signal processing performance of the modem

Item Performance

Encoding mode   l Reed-Solomon (RS) encoding for PDH microwave signals

l Trellis-coded modulation (TCM) and RS two-level encoding for 

SDH microwave signals

Adaptive time-

domain equalizer for 

 baseband signals

Supported

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-33 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width)

Weight 0.72 kg

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-51

Page 88: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 88/496

Power Consumption

Power consumption: < 12 W

3.6 IFU2The IFU2 is a general IF board, which can support the Hybrid microwave transmission and

Packet microwave transmission at the same time. The IFU2 board supports the DC-I power 

distribution mode.

NOTE

In this version, the IFU2 supports only the Hybrid microwave transmission.

3.6.1 Version Description

The functional version of the IFU2 is SL91.

3.6.2 Functions and FeaturesThe IFU2 receives and transmits one Hybrid/Packet IF signal, provides the management channel

to the ODU, and supplies the required -48 V power to the ODU.

3.6.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one Hybrid microwave IF signal as an example to describe

the working principle and signal flow of the IFU2.

3.6.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, an IF interface, labels and an ODU power switch on the front panel.

3.6.5 Valid Slots

The IFU2 can be inserted in slots 1–6. The logical slots of the IFU2 on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

3.6.6 Parameter Settings

This topic pr ovides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the IFU2.

3.6.7 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including IF performance, modem performance,

 board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

3.6.1 Version Description

The functional version of the IFU2 is SL91.

3.6.2 Functions and Features

The IFU2 receives and transmits one Hybrid/Packet IF signal, provides the management channel

to the ODU, and supplies the required -48 V power to the ODU.

IF Processing 

l Supports the Hybrid microwave frames, and supports the pure transmission of E1 or 

Ethernet signals and the hybrid transmission of E1 and Ethernet signals.

l Supports the Packet microwave frames and supports the packet service transmission.

l Supports the adaptive modulation (AM) technology.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-52 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 89: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 89/496

l Maps service signals into microwave frame signals.

l Codes and decodes microwave frame signals.

l Modulates and demodulates microwave frame signals.

l

Modulates and demodulates ODU control signals.l Combines and splits service signals, ODU control signals, and -48 V power supplies.

l Provides a maximum of 56 MHz signal bandwidth and supports the highest modulation

mode of 256QAM.

Overhead Processing 

l Processes the overheads of the Hybrid/Packet microwave signals.

l Supports the setting and query of the link ID.

Protection Processing 

l Supports 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection.

l Supports 1+1 FD/SD hitless switching.

l Supports N+1 protection.

NOTE

For details on the 1+1 HSB, 1+1 FD, 1+1 SD, and N+1 protection, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio

Transmission System Feature Description.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l

Supports the inloop and outloop over IF interfaces.l Supports the inloop and outloop at composite ports.

l Supports the MAC inloop at IFETH ports.

l Supports the PRBS BER test over IF interfaces.

l Supports the detection of the board temperature.

l Supports the monitoring of the power supply and the clock.

l Supports the detection of the board voltage.

l Supports the detection of the board clock.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-53

Page 90: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 90/496

l Supports the in-service upgrade of the FPGA.

NOTE

l For details on the loopback function, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance

Guide.

l A warm reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control and communication unit

 but does not affect the services. A cold reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system

control and communication unit, the initiation of the board (if the board has the FPGA, the FPGA is

reloaded), and a service interruption.

3.6.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one Hybrid microwave IF signal as an example to describe

the working principle and signal flow of the IFU2.

NOTE

The working principle and signal flow of the Packet microwave IF signals are similar to the working

 principle and signal flow of the Hybrid microwave IF signals. The only difference is with regard to theframe structure. In the case of the Packet microwave, the MUX/DEMUX unit only multiplexes/

demultiplexes the packet services and does not transmit the TDM services to the cross-connect unit or 

receive the TDM services from the cross-connect unit.

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-24 Functional block diagram of the IFU2

Backplane

Cross-connect unit

I F IF

processing

unit

Logic

processi

ngunit

System control and

communication unit

System control and

communication unit

MUX/DEMUXunit

MODEM

unit

Combiner

interface

unit

Power

supply

unit

SMODEM

unit

Clock

unit

Logic

control unit

ODU control signal

Paired board

Microwave frame

signal

HSM switching signal

Service bus

Overhead

bus

GE busPacket switching unit

Control bus

-48V2

-48 V power supplied to the ODU

+3.3 V power supplied to

the other units on the board

System clock signalClock signal provided to the

other units on the board

Ethernet

processin

g unit

+3.3

V

-48 V1

+3.3 V power supplied to

the monitoring circuit

System control and

communication unit

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-54 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 91: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 91/496

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-34 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IFU2

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

1 Combiner interface

unit

Separates the ODU control signal and the microwave

service signal from the IF signal.

2 SMODEM unit   l Demodulates the ODU control signal.

l Transmits the ODU control unit to the system control

and communication unit.

3 IF processing unit   l Filters the signal.

l Performs the ADC sampling.

l Performs A/D conversion.

4 MODEM unit   l Performs digital demodulation.

l Performs time domain adaptive equalization.

l Performs FEC decoding and generates the

corresponding alarms.

5 MUX/DEMUX unit   l Detects the Hybrid microwave frame header and

generates the corresponding alarms and performance

events.

l Verifies the check code and generates the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Checks the link ID and generates the corresponding

alarms.

l Detects the changes in the ATPC message and the

microwave RDI, and reports the changes to the system

control and communication unit through the control

 bus.

l Extracts the orderwire bytes, auxiliary channel bytes

including the F1 and SERIAL bytes, DCC bytes, and

SSM bytes to form a 2 Mbit/s overhead signal, and

transmits the 2 Mbit/s overhead signal to the logic

 processing unit.

l Maps the E1 signals in the Hybrid microwave service

signals to the specific positions in the VC-4s and then

transmits the VC-4s to the logic processing unit.

l Transmits the Ethernet signals in the Hybrid

microwave service signals to the ethernet processing

unit.

6 Ethernet processing

unit

l Processes the GE signals received from the MUX/

DEMUX unit.

l Sends the processed signals to the main and standby

 packet switching units.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-55

Page 92: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 92/496

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

7 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Multiplexes the 2 Mbit/s overhead signals into an 8Mbit/s overhead signal and transmits the 8 Mbit/s

overhead signal to the system control and

communication unit. Each 2 Mbit/s overhead signal

occupies a 2 Mbit/s timeslot in the 8 Mbit/s overhead

 bandwidth.

l Transmits the VC-4 signal and pointer indication

signal to the main and standby cross-connect units.

 

NOTE

In the 1+1 FD/SD mode, the MUX/DEMUX unit transmits the service signals by HSM bus to the MUX/DEMUX

unit of the paired board. The MUX/DEMUX unit of the paired board selects the signal of higher quality for 

subsequent processing.

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-35 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IFU2

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

1 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Demultiplexes the 8 Mbit/s overhead signal into 2

Mbit/s overhead signals.

l Receives the VC-4 signal and pointer indication signal

from the cross-connect unit.

2 Ethernet processing

unit

l Receives the GE signal from the packet switching unit.

l Processes the GE signals.

3 MUX/DEMUX unit   l Demaps E1 signals from the VC-4 signal.

l Sets the Hybrid microwave frame overheads.

l Combines the E1 signals, Ethernet signals, and

microwave frame overheads to form microwave

frames.

5 MODEM unit   l Performs FEC coding.

l Performs digital modulation.

6 IF processing unit   l Performs D/A conversion.

l Performs analog modulation.

l Filters the signal.

l Amplifies the signals.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-56 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 93: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 93/496

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

7 SMODEM unit Modulates the ODU control signal that is transmitted

from the system control and communication unit.

8 Combiner interface

unit

Combines the ODU control signal, microwave service

signal, and -48 V power supplies, and transmits the

combined signals to the IF cable.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The board is directly controlled by the CPU unit of the system control and communication unit.

The CPU unit issues the configuration data and query commands to the other units of the board

through the control bus. The command responses, alarms, and performance events are alsoreported to the CPU unit through the control bus.

The logic control unit decodes the read/write address signals from the CPU unit of the system

control and communication unit.

Power Supply Unit

l This unit receives the -48 V power from the power supply bus in the backplane, performs

the start-delay, filtering, and DC-DC conversion, and then supplies the -48 V power to the

ODU.

l This unit receives the -48 V power from the power supply bus in the backplane, performs

the start-delay, filtering, and DC-DC conversion, and then supplies the +3.3 V power tothe other units on the IFU2.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.6.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, an IF interface, labels and an ODU power switch on the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-25 Front panel of the IFU2

    I    F    U    2

PULL

IF I O

ODU-PWR

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

    L    I    N    K

    O    D    U

    R    M    T

    A    C    T

WARNING-48V OUTPUTTURN OFF POWER

BEFOREDISCONNECTING IF CABLE

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-57

Page 94: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 94/496

Indicators

Table 3-36 Description of the indicators on the IFU2

Indicator State Meaning  STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LINK On (green) The space link is normal.

On (red) The space link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU works normally.

On (red)   l The logical board is not

added on the NMS

l The ODU has critical or 

major alarms.

l  No power is supplied.

On (yellow) The ODU has minor alarms.

On for 300 ms (yellow) andoff for 300 ms repeatedly

The antennas are not aligned.

RMT On (yellow) The equipment at the

opposite end reports an RDI.

Off The equipment at the

opposite end does not report

an RDI.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-58 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 95: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 95/496

Indicator State Meaning  

ACT On (green)   l The board is in the active

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is already

activated in the

unprotected system.

Off    l The board is in the standby

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is not activated

in the unprotected system.

 

Interface and Switch

Table 3-37 Description of the Interfaces

Interface Description Connector Type Corresponding  Cable

IF IF interface TNC IF jumper b

ODU-PWR a ODU power switch - -

 

NOTE

a: The ODU-PWR switch is equipped with a lockup device. To turn on or turn off the switch, you need to

first pull the switch lever outwards slightly. When the switch is set to "O", it indicates that the circuit is

open. When the switch is set to "I", it indicates that the circuit is closed.

 b: The 5D IF cable is directly connected to the IF board. Hence, when the 5D IF cable is used, the IF jumper 

is not required.

Labels

There is a high temperature warning label, an operation warning label, and an operation guidance

label on the front panel.

The high temperature warning label indicates that the board surface temperature may exceed

70°C when the ambient temperature is higher than 55°C. In this case, you need to wear protective

gloves before handling the board.

The operation warning label indicates that you must turn off the ODU-PWR switch before

removing the IF cable.

The operation guidance label indicates that you need to pull the switch outward slightly before

setting the switch to the "I" or "O" position.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-59

Page 96: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 96/496

3.6.5 Valid Slots

The IFU2 can be inserted in slots 1–6. The logical slots of the IFU2 on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-26 Slots for the IFU2 in the IDU chassis

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IFU2)

Slot 5 (IFU2)

Slot 3 (IFU2)

Slot 2 (IFU2)

Slot 4 (IFU2)

Slot 6 (IFU2)

Slot 8Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11

(FAN)

 

The ODU is not inserted in a physical slot but has a logical slot on the NMS. The logical slot

number of the ODU is the logical slot number of the IF board that is connected to the ODU plus

20.

Figure 3-27 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IFU2

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IFU2)

Slot 5 (IFU2)

Slot 3 (IFU2)

Slot 2 (IFU2)

Slot 4 (IFU2)

Slot 6 (IFU2)

Slot 8Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 25 (ODU)

Slot 23 (ODU)

Slot 21 (ODU)

Slot 26 (ODU)

Slot 24 (ODU)

Slot 22 (ODU)

 

Table 3-38 Slot allocation

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 3 and 5 > slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2

 

NOTE

When configured in a 1+1 IF protection group, two IF boards must be configured in a slot pair, namely,

slot 1 and slot 2, slot 3 and slot 5, or slot 4 and slot 6.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-60 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 97: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 97/496

3.6.6 Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the IFU2.

Related References

A.14.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

A.14.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute

A.14.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid/AM Configuration

A.15.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs

A.14.17 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes

A.14.18 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

A.14.19 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes

3.6.7 Technical SpecificationsThis topic describes the board specifications, including IF performance, modem performance,

 board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

IF Performance

Table 3-39 IF performance

Item Performance

IF signal

Transmit frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

350

Receive frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

140

Impedance (ohm) 50

ODU O&M signal

Modulation mode ASK  

Transmit frequency of the IF board (MHz)

5.5

Receive frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

10

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-61

Page 98: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 98/496

Page 99: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 99/496

The IFX2 can be inserted in slots 1–6. The logical slots of the IFX2 on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

3.7.6 Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the IFX2.

3.7.7 Technical Specifications

This section describes the board performance, including IF performance, modem performance,

 board mechanical behavior, and power consumption.

3.7.1 Version Description

The functional version of the IFX2 is SL91.

3.7.2 Functions and Features

The IFX2 receives and transmits one Hybrid/Packet IF signal, provides the management channel

to the ODU, and supplies the required -48 V power to the ODU. The IFX2 can cancel the cross-

 polarization interference in the IF signal.

IF Processing 

l Supports the XPIC function, provides the XPIC input and output interfaces, and supports

the manual configuration of the XPIC function.

l Supports the Hybrid microwave frames and supports the pure transmission of E1 or 

Ethernet signals and the hybrid transmission of E1 and Ethernet signals.

l Supports the Packet microwave frames and supports the packet service transmission.

l Supports the adaptive modulation (AM) technology.

l Maps service signals into microwave frame signals.

l Codes and decodes microwave frame signals.

l Modulates and demodulates microwave frame signals.

l Modulates and demodulates ODU control signals.

l Combines and splits service signals, ODU control signals, and -48 V power supplies.

l Provides the maximum signal bandwidth of 56 MHz and supports the highest modulation

mode of 256QAM.

Overhead Processing 

l Processes the overheads of the Hybrid/Packet microwave signals.

l Supports the setting and query of the link ID.

Protection Processing 

l Supports 1+1 HSB/FD/SD protection.

l Supports 1+1 FD/SD hitless switching.

l Supports N+1 protection.

NOTE

For details on the 1+1 HSB, 1+1 FD, N+1 protection, and 1+1 SD, see the OptiX RTN 950 RadioTransmission System Feature Description.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-63

Page 100: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 100/496

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the inloop and outloop over IF interfaces.

l Supports the inloop and outloop at composite ports.

l Supports the MAC inloop at IFETH ports.

l Supports the PRBS BER test over IF interfaces.

l Supports the detection of the board temperature.

l Supports the detection of the board voltage.

l Supports the detection of the board clock.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

l Supports the in-service upgrade of the FPGA.

NOTE

l For details on the loopback function, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance

Guide.

l A warm reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control and communication unit

 but does not affect the services. A cold reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system

control and communication unit, the initiation of the board (if the board has the FPGA, the FPGA is

reloaded), and a service interruption.

3.7.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one Hybrid microwave IF signal as an example to describe

the working principle and signal flow of the IFX2.

NOTE

The working principle and signal flow of the Packet microwave IF signals are similar to the working

 principle and signal flow of the Hybrid microwave IF signals. The only difference is with regard to the

frame structure. In the case of the Packet microwave, the MUX/DEMUX unit only multiplexes/

demultiplexes the packet services and does not transmit the TDM services to the cross-connect unit or 

receive the TDM services from the cross-connect unit.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-64 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 101: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 101/496

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-28 Functional block diagram of the IFX2

Backplane

Cross-connect unit

I IF

processing

unit

Logic

processi

ngunit System control and

communication unit

System control and

communication unit

MUX/DEMUXunit

MODEM

unit

Combiner

interface

unit

Power

supply

unit

Clockunit

Logic

control unit

ODU control signal

Paired

board

Microwave

frame signal

HSM switching

signal

Service busOverhead

bus

GE

bus Packet switching unit

Control

bus

- 48V power supplied to the ODU

+3.3V power supplied to the

other units on the board

 

System clock signalClock signal provided to theother units on the board

Ethernet

processing

unit

+3.3

 V

- 48 V1

+3.3V power supplied to

the monitoring circuit

XPIC signal

F

System control and

communication unitSMODEM

unit

- 48 V2

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-42 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the IFX2

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

1 Combiner interface

unit

Separates the ODU control signal and the microwave

service signal from the IF signal.

2 SMODEM unit   l Demodulates the ODU control signal.

l Transmits the ODU control unit to the system control

and communication unit.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-65

Page 102: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 102/496

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

3 IF processing unit   l Performs the ADC sampling.

l Filters the signal and splits the signal to two channels.– Performs A/D conversion for one filtered signal and

transmits the converted signal to the MODEM unit.

– Outputs the other filtered signal as the XPIC signal.

l Performs A/D conversion for the XPIC signal from the

 paired IFX2 and transmits the converted signal to the

MODEM unit.

4 MODEM unit   l Performs digital demodulation by using the XPIC IF

signal from the paired IFX2 as a reference signal.

l Performs time domain adaptive equalization.

l Performs FEC decoding and generates the

corresponding alarms.

5 MUX/DEMUX unit   l Detects the Hybrid microwave frame header and

generates the corresponding alarms and performance

events.

l Verifies the check code and generates the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Checks the link ID and generates the corresponding

alarms.

l Detects the changes in the ATPC message and the

microwave RDI, and reports the changes to the system

control and communication unit through the control

 bus.

l Extracts the orderwire bytes, auxiliary channel bytes

including the F1 and SERIAL bytes, DCC bytes, and

SSM bytes to form a 2 Mbit/s overhead signal, and

transmits the 2 Mbit/s overhead signal to the logic

 processing unit.

l Maps the E1 signals in the Hybrid microwave service

signals to the specific positions in the VC-4s and then

transmits the VC-4s to the logic processing unit.

l Transmits the Ethernet signals in the Hybrid

microwave service signals to the Ethernet processing

unit.

6 Ethernet processing

unit

l Processes the GE signals received from the MUX/

DEMUX unit.

l Sends the processed signals to the main and standby

 packet switching units.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-66 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 103: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 103/496

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

7 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Multiplexes the 2 Mbit/s overhead signals into an 8Mbit/s overhead signal and transmits the 8 Mbit/s

overhead signal to the system control and

communication unit. Each 2 Mbit/s overhead signal

occupies a 2 Mbit/s timeslot in the 8 Mbit/s overhead

 bandwidth.

l Transmits the VC-4 signal and pointer indication

signal to the main and standby cross-connect units.

 

NOTE

In the 1+1 FD/SD mode, the MUX/DEMUX unit transmits the service signals by HSM bus to the MUX/DEMUX

unit of the paired board. The MUX/DEMUX unit of the paired board selects the signal of higher quality for 

subsequent processing.

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-43 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the IFX2

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

1 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Demultiplexes the 8 Mbit/s overhead signal into 2

Mbit/s overhead signals.

l Receives the VC-4 signal and pointer indication signal

from the cross-connect unit.

2 Ethernet processing

unit

l Receives the GE signal from the packet switching unit.

l Processes the GE signals.

3 MUX/DEMUX unit   l Demaps E1 signals from the VC-4 signal.

l Sets the Hybrid microwave frame overheads.

l Combines the E1 signals, Ethernet signals, and

microwave frame overheads to form microwave

frames.

5 MODEM unit   l Performs FEC coding.

l Performs digital modulation.

6 IF processing unit   l Performs D/A conversion.

l Performs analog modulation.

l Filters the signal.

l Amplifies the signals.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-67

Page 104: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 104/496

Step FunctionalModule

Processing Flow

7 SMODEM unit Modulates the ODU control signal that is transmitted

from the system control and communication unit.

8 Combiner interface

unit

Combines the ODU control signal, microwave service

signal, and -48 V power supplies, and transmits the

combined signals to the IF cable.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The board is directly controlled by the CPU unit of the system control and communication unit.

The CPU unit issues the configuration data and query commands to the other units of the board

through the control bus. The command responses, alarms, and performance events are alsoreported to the CPU unit through the control bus.

The logic control unit decodes the read/write address signals from the CPU unit of the system

control and communication unit.

Power Supply Unit

l This unit receives the -48 V power from the power supply bus in the backplane, performs

the start-delay, filtering, and DC-DC conversion, and then supplies the -48 V power to the

ODU.

l This unit receives the -48 V power from the power supply bus in the backplane, performs

the start-delay, filtering, and DC-DC conversion, and then supplies the +3.3 V power tothe other units on the IFX2.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.7.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, an IF interface, XPIC signal ports, an ODU power switch, and labels on

the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-29 Front panel of the IFX2

    I    F    X    2

IF I O

ODU-PWR

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

    L    I    N    K

    O    D    U

    R    M    T

    A    C    T

WARNING-48V OUTPUT

TURN OFF POWER BEFORE

DISCONNECTING IF CABLE    I    F    X    2

X-IN X-OUTPULL   X    P    I    C

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-68 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 105: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 105/496

Indicators

Table 3-44 Description of the indicators on the IFX2

Indicator State Meaning  XPIC On (green) The XPIC input signal is

normal.

On (red) The XPIC input signal is lost.

Off The XPIC function is

disabled.

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarmoccurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LINK On (green) The space link is normal.

On (red) The space link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU works normally.

On (red)   l The logical board is not

added on the NMSl The ODU has critical or 

major alarms.

l  No power is supplied.

On (yellow) The ODU has minor alarms.

On for 300 ms (yellow) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

The antennas are not aligned.

RMT On (yellow) The equipment at the

opposite end reports an RDI.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-69

Page 106: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 106/496

Indicator State Meaning  

Off The equipment at the

opposite end does not report

an RDI.

ACT On (green)   l The board is in the active

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is already

activated in the

unprotected system.

Off    l The board is in the standby

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l

The board is not activatedin the unprotected system.

 

Interfaces

Table 3-45 Description of the interfaces

Interface Description Connector Type Corresponding  Cable

IF IF interface TNC IF jumper b

ODU-PWR a ODU power switch - -

X-IN XPIC signal input

interface

SMA XPIC cable

X-OUT XPIC signal output

interface

SMA

 

NOTE

a: The ODU-PWR switch is equipped with a lockup device. To turn on or turn off the switch, you need to

first pull the switch lever outwards slightly. When the switch is set to "O", it indicates that the circuit is

open. When the switch is set to "I", it indicates that the circuit is closed.

 b: The 5D IF cable is directly connected to the IF board. Hence, when the 5D IF cable is used, the IF jumper 

is not required.

Labels

There is a high temperature warning label, an operation warning label, and an operation guidance

label on the front panel.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-70 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 107: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 107/496

The high temperature warning label indicates that the board surface temperature may exceed

70°C when the ambient temperature is higher than 55°C. In this case, you need to wear protective

gloves before handling the board.

The operation warning label indicates that you must turn off the ODU-PWR switch before

removing the IF cable.

The operation guidance label indicates that you need to pull the switch outward slightly before

setting the switch to the "I" or "O" position.

3.7.5 Valid Slot

The IFX2 can be inserted in slots 1–6. The logical slots of the IFX2 on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-30 Slots for the IFX2 in the IDU chassis

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IFX2)

Slot 5 (IFX2)

Slot 3 (IFX2)

Slot 2 (IFX2)

Slot 4 (IFX2)

Slot 6 (IFX2)

Slot 8Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11

(FAN)

 

The ODU is not inserted in a physical slot but has a logical slot on the NMS. The logical slot

number of the ODU is the logical slot number of the IF board that is connected to the ODU plus

20.

Figure 3-31 Logical slots for the logical boards of the IFX2

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (IFX2)

Slot 5 (IFX2)

Slot 3 (IFX2)

Slot 2 (IFX2)

Slot 4 (IFX2)

Slot 6 (IFX2)

Slot 8Slot 10

(PIU) Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 25 (ODU)

Slot 23 (ODU)

Slot 21 (ODU)

Slot 26 (ODU)

Slot 24 (ODU)

Slot 22 (ODU)

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-71

Page 108: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 108/496

Page 109: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 109/496

Item Performance

Receive frequency of the IF

 board (MHz)

10

 

Baseband Signal Processing Performance of the Modem

Table 3-48 Baseband signal processing performance of the modem

Item Performance

Encoding mode The LDPC encoding is performed for the Hybrid microwave signals.

Adaptive time-

domain equalizer for 

 baseband signals

Supported

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-49 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm (width)

Weight 0.80 kg

 

Power Consumption

Power consumption: < 33 W

3.8 EM6T/EM6F

The EM6T/EM6F is an FE/GE interface board, which provides four FE electrical interfaces andtwo GE interfaces. The EM6T has similar functions to the EM6F. The only difference is as

follows: the GE interfaces on the EM6T always function as electrical interfaces whereas the GE

interfaces on the EM6F use the SFP modules and therefore can function as two optical or 

electrical interfaces. The GE electrical interfaces on the EM6F and the EM6T are compatible

with the FE electrical interfaces.

3.8.1 Version Description

The functional version of the EM6T/EM6F is SL91.

3.8.2 Functions and Features

The EM6T/EM6F accesses, processes, and aggregates four FE signals and two GE signals.

3.8.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-73

Page 110: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 110/496

This topic considers the processing of one GE signal on the EM6T as an example to describe

the working principle and signal flow of the EM6T/EM6F.

3.8.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, FE interfaces, and GE interfaces on the front panel of the EM6T/EM6F.

The GE electrical interfaces on the front panel of the EM6T are compatible with the FEinterfaces. The GE interfaces on the front panel of the EM6F use pluggable SFP optical modules.

3.8.5 Valid Slots

The EM6T/EM6F can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the EM6T/EM6F on the NMS

should be the same as the physical slots.

3.8.6 Board Feature Code

The type of the SFP module equipped on the EM6F can be identified by the board feature code

that is in the bar code. The board feature code follows the board name that is in the bar code.

3.8.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the EM6T/EM6F.

3.8.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the GE interface performance, FE

interface performance, board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

3.8.1 Version Description

The functional version of the EM6T/EM6F is SL91.

3.8.2 Functions and Features

The EM6T/EM6F accesses, processes, and aggregates four FE signals and two GE signals.

Ethernet Service Signal Processing 

l The EM6T provides two GE electrical interfaces whereas the EM6F uses the SFP optical

modules to provide two GE optical or electrical interfaces. The GE electrical interfaces are

compatible with the FE electrical interfaces.

l Supports the setting and query of the working modes of the Ethernet interfaces. The

supported working modes are as follows:

– The FE interfaces support 10M full duplex, 10M half duplex, 100M full duplex, 100M

half duplex, and auto-negotiation.

– The GE electrical interfaces support 10M full duplex, 10M half duplex, 100M fullduplex, 100M half duplex, 1000M full duplex, and auto-negotiation.

– The GE optical interfaces support 1000M full-duplex and auto-negotiation.

l Supports the addition, deletion, and switching of IEEE 802.1q/802.1p-compliant VLAN

tags, and forwards packets based on the VLAN tags.

l Supports the setting and query of the tag attributes of the Ethernet interfaces. The following

three TAG attributes are available: tag aware, access, and hybrid.

l Accesses Ethernet II and IEEE 802.3 service frames with the maximum frame length

ranging from 1518 to 9600 bytes.

l Supports Jumbo frames with the maximum frame length of 9600 bytes.

l Supports the port-based flow control function that complies with IEEE 802.3x.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-74 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 111: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 111/496

l Supports the link state pass through (LPT) function.

l Supports the link aggregation group (LAG) function.

l Supports the Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS).

NOTE

For details on LAG and Link State Pass Through, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System

 Feature Description.

Layer 2 Switching Processing of Ethernet Services

The Ethernet interface board can realize the following functions when working with the packet

switching board:

l Supports port-based, port+VLAN-based, and port+QinQ E-Line services.

l Supports 802.1d bridge-based, 802.1q bridge-based, and 802.1ad bridge-based E-LAN

services.

QoS Service Processing 

The Ethernet interface board can realize the following QoS functions when working with the

 packet switching board:

l Supports flow classification over Ethernet interfaces based on the port, C-VLAN ID, S-

VLAN ID, priority of the 802.1p packets with C-VLAN or S-VLAN tags, or DSCP in the

IPv6 packets.

l Supports CAR flow monitoring.

l Supports queue scheduling.

– Each Ethernet interface supports scheduling of eight levels of priority queues.– Supports the setting of the queue scheduling mode of each Ethernet interface to SP, SP

+WRR, or WRR.

l Supports traffic shaping for a specific port, priority queue, or traffic flow.

Ethernet OAM Processing 

The Ethernet interface board can realize the following Ethernet OAM functions when working

with the packet switching board:

l Supports the following OAM functions specified in IEEE 802.1ag:

– Management of OAM maintenance points

– Continuity check test

– Loopback test

– Link trace test

l Supports the following OAM functions specified in IEEE 802.3ah:

– OAM automatic discovery

– Link performance monitoring

– Fault detection

– Loopback at the remote end

– Self-loop detection and self-loop port blocking

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-75

Page 112: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 112/496

Clock Processing 

l Supports synchronous Ethernet.

l Supports receiving and transmitting SSM messages through Ethernet interfaces.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the alarm thresholds.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

l Supports RMON performance events.

NOTE

For details on the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the inloop at the PHY layer over Ethernet ports.

l Supports the inloop at the MAC layer over Ethernet ports.

l Supports the mirroring function over Ethernet interfaces.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.

l Supports the detection of the board temperature.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

l Supports the query of the manufacturing information about the SFP module.

3.8.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one GE signal on the EM6T as an example to describe

the working principle and signal flow of the EM6T/EM6F.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-76 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 113: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 113/496

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-32 Functional block diagram

GE signal

access unit

FE signal

access unit

Ethernet

processing

unit

Logic

processing

unit

Logiccontrol unit

Clock unit

Backplane

Control bus of the board

System control andcommunication unit

Packet switching unit

GE signal

FE signal

Ethernet

signal

Ethernet

signal

Control bus

+3.3 V+3.3 V backup power

supplied to the board

System clockClock signal provided to the

other units on the board

Control signal

Control signal

Power

supply unit

-48 V1

-48 V2+3.3 V power supplied to

the board

 

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-50 Signal processing flow in the receive direction

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 GE signal access unit   l Provides access to GE signal.

l Performs reassembling, decoding, and serial/parallel

conversion for the GE signals.

l Performs frame delimitation, preamble stripping, CRC

code processing, and Ethernet performance count for 

the frame signals.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-77

Page 114: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 114/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

2 Ethernet processing

unit

l Adds the tags identifying the ingress ports to the

Ethernet data frames.

l Processes the VLAN tags in the Ethernet data frames.l Performs the QoS processing, such as traffic

classification and CAR traffic monitoring, for the

Ethernet data frames.

l Forwards the Ethernet data frames to the logic

 processing unit.

3 Logic processing

unit

Transmits the Ethernet data frames to the main and

standby packet switching units.

 

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-51 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 Logic processing unit   l Selects the Ethernet data frames from the packet

switching unit.

l Transmits the Ethernet data frames to the Ethernet

 processing unit.

2 Ethernet processing

unit

l Processes the VLAN tags in the Ethernet data frames.

l Performs the QoS processing, such as traffic shaping

and queue scheduling, for the Ethernet data frames.

l Forwards the Ethernet data frames to the

corresponding egress ports based on the egress tags

contained in the Ethernet data frames.

3 GE signal access unit   l Performs frame delimitation, preamble addition, CRC

code computing, and Ethernet performance count.

l Performs parallel/serial conversion and coding for the

Ethernet data frames, and sends out the generated FE/

GE signals through the Ethernet interfaces.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The Ethernet processing unit controls the FE/GE signal access by using the control signal.

The logic control unit controls the Ethernet processing unit and logic processing unit through

the control unit on the board.

The logic control unit communicates with the main and standby system control and

communication units through the system control bus. The configuration data and query

commands from the system control and communication unit are issued to the various units of the board through the logic control unit. The command response reported by each unit on the

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-78 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 115: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 115/496

 board, and the alarms and performance events are reported to the system control and

communication unit through the logic control unit.

Power Supply Unit

This unit receives two -48 V power supplies from the backplane, converts the -48 V power into

the +3.3 V power, and then supplies the +3.3 V power to the other units on the board.

The power supply unit receives a +3.3 V power supply from the backplane, which functions as

a +3.3 V power backup for the other units on the board.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.8.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, FE interfaces, and GE interfaces on the front panel of the EM6T/EM6F.

The GE electrical interfaces on the front panel of the EM6T are compatible with the FE

interfaces. The GE interfaces on the front panel of the EM6F use pluggable SFP optical modules.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-33 Front panel of the EM6T

    E    M    6    T

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

FE1 FE2 FE3 FE4GE2  E

    M    6    T

GE1    P    R    O    G

 

Figure 3-34 Front panel of the EM6F

    E    M    6    F

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

GE2  E

    M    6    F

GE1    L    I    N    K    1

    L    I    N    K    2

CLASS1

LASER

PRODUCT

FE1 FE2 FE3 FE4    P    R    O    G

 

Indicators

Table 3-52 Description of the indicators on the EM6T/EM6F

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-79

Page 116: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 116/496

Page 117: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 117/496

NOTE

a: The LINK1 and LINK2 indicators are available only on the EM6F and indicate the states of the

corresponding GE optical interfaces.

Interfaces

Table 3-53 Description of the interfaces on the EM6T/EM6F

Interfac

e

Description Connector Type Corresponding Cable

FE1 FE interface

RJ-45 5.8 Network Cable

FE2

FE3

FE4

GE1 GE electrical

interfaceGE2

GE1 GE optical

interface (EM6F)

LC (SFP optical module) 5.5 Fiber Jumper

GE2

 

The FE electrical interfaces and GE electrical interfaces support the MDI and MDI-X adaptation

modes. For the front view and pin assignment of the RJ-45 connector, see Figure 3-35 and refer 

to Table 3-54 and Table 3-55.

Figure 3-35 Front view of the RJ-45 connector 

8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

 

Table 3-54 Pin assignment of the RJ-45 connector in MDI mode

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

1 TX+ Transmitting data (+) BIDA+ Bidirectional data wire A

(+)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-81

Page 118: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 118/496

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

2 TX- Transmitting data (-) BIDA- Bidirectional data wire A

(-)

3 RX+ Receiving data (+) BIDB+ Bidirectional data wire B

(+)

4 Reserved - BIDC+ Bidirectional data wire C

(+)

5 Reserved - BIDC- Bidirectional data wire C

(-)

6 RX- Receiving data (-) BIDB- Bidirectional data wire B

(-)

7 Reserved - BIDD+ Bidirectional data wire D

(+)

8 Reserved - BIDD- Bidirectional data wire D

(-)

 

Table 3-55 Pin assignment of the RJ-45 connector in MDI-X mode

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

1 RX+ Receiving data (+) BIDB+ Bidirectional data wire B

(+)

2 RX- Receiving data (-) BIDB- Bidirectional data wire B

(-)

3 TX+ Transmitting data (+) BIDA+ Bidirectional data wire A

(+)

4 Reserved - BIDD+ Bidirectional data wire D

(+)

5 Reserved - BIDD- Bidirectional data wire D

(-)

6 TX- Transmitting data (-) BIDA- Bidirectional data wire A

(-)

7 Reserved - BIDC+ Bidirectional data wire C

(+)

8 Reserved - BIDC- Bidirectional data wire C

(-)

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-82 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 119: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 119/496

The RJ-45 connector has two indicators. For meaning of the indicators, see Table 3-56.

Table 3-56 Description of the two indicators of the RJ-45 connector 

Indicator State Meaning  LINK (green) On The link is normal.

Off The link fails.

ACT (yellow) On or blinking The interface is transmitting or  

receiving data.

Off The interface is not transmitting or  

receiving data.

 

Label

There is a laser safety class label on the front panel of the EM6F.

The laser safety class label indicates that the laser safety class of the optical interface is CLASS

1. That is, the maximum launched optical power of the optical interface is lower than 10 dBm

(10 mW).

3.8.5 Valid Slots

The EM6T/EM6F can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the EM6T/EM6F on the NMS

should be the same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-36 Slots for the EM6T/EM6F in the IDU chassis

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 5 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 3 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 2 (IEM6T/EM6F)

Slot 4 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 6 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 8Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11

(FAN)

 

Figure 3-37 Logical slots for the logical boards of the EM6T/EM6F

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 5 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 3 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 2 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 4 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 6 (EM6T/EM6F)

Slot 8Slot 10

(PIU)Slot 11(FAN)

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-83

Page 120: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 120/496

Table 3-57 Slot configuration for the EM6T/EM6F

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2 > slots 3 and 5

 

3.8.6 Board Feature Code

The type of the SFP module equipped on the EM6F can be identified by the board feature code

that is in the bar code. The board feature code follows the board name that is in the bar code.

Table 3-58 Board feature code of the EM6F

Board Feature Code Module Type BOM Code of the Module

01 1000BASE-SX (Multi-mode, 0.5 km)

34060286

02 1000BASE-LX (Single-

mode, 10 km)

34060473

03 10/100/1000BASE-T(X)

(100m)

34100052

 

3.8.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the EM6T/EM6F.

Related References

A.14.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes

A.14.14 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control

A.14.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

A.14.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes

3.8.8 Technical SpecificationsThis topic describes the board specifications, including the GE interface performance, FE

interface performance, board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

Performance of Optical Interfaces

The optical interfaces on the EM6T/EM6F meet the requirements specified in IEEE 802.3. The

following table lists the main specifications for the optical interfaces.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-84 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 121: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 121/496

Table 3-59 Performance of the GE optical interface

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 1000

Classification code 1000Base-SX 1000Base-LX

Fiber type Multiple-mode optical

fiber 

Single-mode optical

fiber 

Transmission distance (km) 0.5 10

Operating wavelength (nm) 770 to 860 1270 to 1355

Mean launched power (dBm) -9.5 to 0 -9 to -3

Receiver minimum sensitivity (dBm) -17 -19

Minimum overload (dBm) 0 -3

Minimum extinction ratio (dB) 9 9

 

NOTE

The OptiX RTN 950 uses SFP modules for providing GE optical interfaces. You can use different types of SFP

modules to provide GE optical interfaces with different classification codes and transmission distances.

Performance of GE Electrical Interfaces

The GE electrical interfaces on the EM6T/EM6F meet the requirements specified in IEEE 802.3.

The following table lists the main specifications for the GE electrical interfaces.

Table 3-60 GE electric interface performance

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (Mbit/s) 10 (10BASE-T)

100 (100BASE-TX)

1000 (1000BASE-T)

Code pattern Manchester encoding signal (10BASE-T)

MLT-3 encoding signal (100BASE-TX)

4D-PAM5 encoding signal (1000BASE-T)

Interface type RJ-45

 

Performance of FE Electrical Interfaces

The FE electrical interfaces on the EM6T/EM6F meet the requirements specified in IEEE 802.3.

The following table lists the main specifications for the FE electrical interfaces.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-85

Page 122: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 122/496

Table 3-61 FE electric interface performance

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (Mbit/s) 10 (10BASE-T)

100 (100BASE-TX)

Code pattern Manchester encoding signal (10BASE-T)

MLT-3 encoding signal (100BASE-TX)

Interface type RJ-45

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-62 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

EM6T EM6F

Dimensions 19.82mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm (width)

Weight 0.37 kg 0.38 kg

 

Power Consumption

Power consumption of EM6T: < 10.4 W

Power consumption of EM6F: < 11.3 W

3.9 SL1D

The SL1D is an SDH dual-port STM-1 board.

3.9.1 Version Description

The functional version of the SL1D is SL91.

3.9.2 Functions and FeaturesThe SL1D transmits and receives 2xSTM-1 optical signals.

3.9.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one STM-1 signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the SL1D.

3.9.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, STM-1 optical interfaces, and a label on the front panel.

3.9.5 Valid Slots

The SL1D can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the SL1D on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

3.9.6 Board Feature Code

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-86 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 123: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 123/496

The type of the SFP optical module equipped on the SL1D can be identified by the board feature

code of the bar code. In the bar code, the board feature code is the number next to the board

name.

3.9.7 Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the SL1D.

3.9.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including STM-1 optical interface performance,

 board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

3.9.1 Version Description

The functional version of the SL1D is SL91.

3.9.2 Functions and Features

The SL1D transmits and receives 2xSTM-1 optical signals.

Specifications for Optical Interfaces

l Provides Ie-1, S-1.1, L-1.1, or L-1.2 optical interfaces.

l All the optical interfaces comply with ITU-T G.957.

Specifications for Optical Modules

l Adopts the SFP optical module to facilitate the later maintenance of the optical module.

l Supports the detection and query of the information about the optical module.

l Supports the enabling and disabling of the laser.

l Supports the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function.

NOTE

The ALS function is described as follows:

1. After detecting that the R_LOS alarm persists over the receive port for 500 ms, the optical module

automatically shuts down the laser of the transmit port.

2. The laser changes to emit alternative laser pulses. The laser pulses are emitted for 2s after a 60s

interval.

3. After the R_LOS alarm is cleared, the laser is recovered to normal and emits light continuously.

Overhead Processing 

l Processes the regenerator section overheads in STM-1 signals.

l Processes the multiplex section overheads in STM-1 signals.

l Processes the higher order path overheads in STM-1 signals.

l Supports the setting and query of the J0/J1/C2 byte.

NOTE

Higher order path overheads are processed in two modes, namely, the pass-through mode and termination

mode. In the pass-through mode, the path overheads are detected in the receive direction only and the

overhead values are not changed. In the termination mode, when the path overheads are detected in the

receive dir ection, the overhead bytes are re-set to the default values in the transmit direction. By default,the board adopts the pass-through mode.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-87

Page 124: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 124/496

Pointer Processing 

Processes AU pointers.

Protection Processing l Supports the monitoring and reporting of the status of the working and protection channels

in an SNCP group.

l Supports the monitoring and reporting of the status of the working and protection channels

in a linear MSP group.

l Supports the setting of SNCP switching conditions.

l Supports the setting of linear MSP switching conditions.

NOTE

For details on SNCP and linear MSP, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System Feature

 Description.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

Maintenance Features

l Supports the inloop and outloop over optical interfaces.

l Supports the outloop on VC-4 paths.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.

l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

l Supports the in-service upgrade of the FPGA.

NOTE

A warm reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control and communication unit but

does not affect the services. A cold reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control

and communication unit, the initiation of the board (if the board has the FPGA, the FPGA is reloaded), and

service interruption.

3.9.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one STM-1 signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the SL1D.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-88 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 125: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 125/496

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-38 Functional block diagram of the SL1D

Clock signal provided to the

other units on the board

Backplane

Logic

control

unit

STM-1

STM-1

O/E

conversion

unit

Overhead

processing

unit

Logic

processing

unit

System control and

communication unit

Overhead

bus

System control and

communication unit

Cross-connect unit

Clock

unit System clock signal

+3.3 V

Servicebus

Control bus

Supplies power to the

other units on the board

 

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-63 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the SL1D

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 O/E conversion unit   l Regenerates STM-1 optical signals.

l Detects the R_LOS alarm.

l Converts the STM-1 optical signals into electrical

signals.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-89

Page 126: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 126/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

2 Overhead processing

unit

l Restores the clock signal.

l Synchronizes the frames and detects the R_LOS and

R_LOF alarms.l Performs descrambling.

l Checks the B1 and B2 bytes and generates the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Checks bits 6-8 of the K2 byte and the M1 byte, and

generates the corresponding alarms and performance

events.

l Detects the changes in the SSM in the S1 byte and

reports it to the system control and communication

unit.

l

Extracts the orderwire bytes, auxiliary channel bytesincluding the F1 and SERIAL bytes, DCC bytes and K 

 bytes to form a 2M overhead signal and sends it to the

logic processing unit.

l Adjusts the AU pointer and generates the

corresponding performance events.

l Checks the higher order path overheads and generates

the corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Transmits the pointer indication signal and VC-4

signal to the logic processing unit.

3 Logic processingunit

l

Processes the clock signal.l Multiplexes the 2 Mbit/s overhead signals into an 8

Mbit/s overhead signal and transmits the 8 Mbit/s

overhead signal to the system control and

communication unit. Each 2 Mbit/s overhead signal

occupies a 2 Mbit/s timeslot in the 8 Mbit/s overhead

 bandwidth.

l Transmits the VC-4 signal and pointer indication

signal to the main and standby cross-connect unit.

 

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-64 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the SL1D

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Demultiplexes the 8 Mbit/s overhead signal into 2

Mbit/s overhead signals.

l Receives the VC-4 signal and pointer indication signal

from the cross-connect unit.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-90 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 127: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 127/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

2 Overhead processing

unit

l Sets the higher order path overheads.

l Sets the AU pointer.

l Sets the multiplex section overheads.

l Sets the regenerator section overheads.

l Performs scrambling.

3 O/E conversion unit   l Converts the electrical signals into optical signals.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The SL1D is directly controlled by the CPU unit of the system control and communication unit.

The CPU unit issues the configuration data and query commands to the other units of the SL1D

through the control bus. The command responses, alarms, and performance events are also

reported to the CPU unit through the control bus.

The logic control unit decodes the address read/write signals from the CPU unit of the system

control and communication unit and loads the FPGA software.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.9.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, STM-1 optical interfaces, and a label on the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-39 Front panel of the SL1D

    S    L    1    D

TX1/RX1

CLASS1

LASERPRODUCT

    S    L    1    D

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

    L    O    S    1

    L    O    S    2

TX2/RX2

 

Indicators

Table 3-65 Description of the indicators on the SL1D

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-91

Page 128: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 128/496

Indicator State Meaning  

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LOS1 On (red) The first optical interface of  

the SL1D reports the R_LOS

alarm.

Off The first optical interface of  

the SL1D does not report the

R_LOS alarm.

LOS2 On (red) The second optical interface

of the SL1D reports the

R_LOS alarm.Off The second optical interface

of the SL1D does not report

the R_LOS alarm.

 

Interfaces

Table 3-66 Description of the interfaces

Interface Description Connector Type Corresponding  Cable

TX1 Transmit port of the

first STM-1 optical

interface

LC (SFP) Fiber jumper

RX1 Receive port of the

first STM-1 optical

interface

TX2 Transmit port of the

second STM-1

optical interface

LC (SFP)

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-92 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 129: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 129/496

Interface Description Connector Type Corresponding  Cable

RX2 Receive port of the

second STM-1

optical interface

 

Labels

There is a laser safety class label on the front panel.

The laser safety class label indicates that the laser safety class of the optical interface is CLASS

1. That is, the maximum launched optical power of the optical interface is lower than 10 dBm

(10 mW).

3.9.5 Valid Slots

The SL1D can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the SL1D on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-40 Slots for the SL1D in the IDU chassis

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (SL1D)

Slot 5 (SL1D)

Slot 3 (SL1D)

Slot 2 (SL1D)

 Slot 4 (SL1D)

 Slot 6 (SL1D)

Slot 8

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

Figure 3-41 Logical slots for the logical boards of the SL1D

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (SL1D)

Slot 5 (SL1D)

Slot 3 (SL1D)

Slot 2 (SL1D)

 Slot 4 (SL1D)

 Slot 6 (SL1D)

Slot 8

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

Table 3-67 Slot allocation for the SL1D

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2 > slots 3 and 5

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-93

Page 130: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 130/496

3.9.6 Board Feature Code

The type of the SFP optical module equipped on the SL1D can be identified by the board feature

code of the bar code. In the bar code, the board feature code is the number next to the board

name.

Table 3-68 Board feature code of the SL1D

Feature Code Type of Optical Module Part Number of theOptical Module

01 Ie-1 (Multi-mode, 2km) 34060287

02 S-1.1 (Single-mode, 15km) 34060276

03 L-1.1 (Single-mode, 40km) 34060281

04 L-1.2 (Single-mode, 80km) 34060282

 

3.9.7 Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the SL1D.

Related References

A.14.10 Parameter Description: SDH InterfacesA.15.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead

A.15.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs

3.9.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including STM-1 optical interface performance,

 board mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

STM-1 Optical Interface Performance

The performance of the STM-1 optical interface is compliant with ITU-T G.957/G.825. Thefollowing table provides the primary performance.

Table 3-69 STM-1 optical interface performance

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 155520

Classification code Ie-1 S-1.1 L-1.1 L-1.2

Fiber type Multi-mode

fiber 

Single-mode

fiber 

Single-mode

fiber 

Single-mode

fiber 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-94 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 131: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 131/496

Item Performance

Transmission distance

(km)

2 15 40 80

Operating wavelength(nm)

1270 to 1380 1261 to 1360 1263 to 1360 1480 to 1580

Mean launched power 

(dBm)

-19 to -14 -15 to -8 -5 to 0 -5 to 0

Receiver minimum

sensitivity (dBm)

-30 -28 -34 -34

Minimum overload (dBm) -14 -8 -10 -10

Minimum extinction ratio

(dB)

10 8.2 10 10

 

NOTE

The OptiX RTN 950 uses SFP modules for providing optical interfaces. You can use different types of SFP

modules to provide optical interfaces with different classification codes and transmission distances.

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-70 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width)

Weight 0.30 kg

 

Power Consumption

Power consumption: < 3.4 W

3.10 SP3S/SP3D

The SP3S is a 16xE1 75-ohm/120-ohm tributary board. The SP3D is a 32xE1 75-ohm/120-ohm

tributary board.

3.10.1 Version Description

The functional version of the SP3S is SL91. The functional version of the SP3D is TNH1.

3.10.2 Functions and Features

The SP3S receives and transmits 16xE1 signals. The SP3D receives and transmits 32xE1 signals.

3.10.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-95

Page 132: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 132/496

This topic considers the processing of one E1 signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the SP3S/SP3D.

3.10.4 Front Panel

There are indicators and E1 interfaces on the front panel.

3.10.5 Valid Slots

The SP3S/SP3D can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the SP3S/SP3D on the NMS

should be the same as the physical slots.

3.10.6 Board Feature Code

The E1 interface impedance of the SP3S/SP3D can be identified by the board feature code of 

the bar code. In the bar code, the board feature code is the number next to the board name.

3.10.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the SP3S/SP3D.

3.10.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the E1 interface performance, boardmechanical behavior and board power consumption.

3.10.1 Version Description

The functional version of the SP3S is SL91. The functional version of the SP3D is TNH1.

3.10.2 Functions and Features

The SP3S receives and transmits 16xE1 signals. The SP3D receives and transmits 32xE1 signals.

Overhead and Pointer Processing 

l Processes overheads and pointers at the VC-12 level.

l Supports the query of the J2 and V5 bytes.

l Supports the setting of the J2 and V5 bytes.

Clock Processing 

l Supports the E1 retiming function.

l Supports the first and fifth E1 signals to be extracted as the tributary clock source.

Alarms and Performance Events

l Reports various alarms and performance events.

l Supports the alarm management functions such as setting the alarm reversion function and

setting the BER threshold.

l Supports the performance event management functions such as setting the performance

thresholds and setting the automatic reporting of 15-minute/24-hour performance events.

NOTE

For details about the alarm management and performance event management functions, see the OptiX RTN 

950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance Guide.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-96 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 133: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 133/496

Maintenance Features

l Supports the inloop and outloop over the E1 tributary interfaces.

l Supports the PRBS 15 test.

l Supports the warm reset and cold reset on the board.l Supports the query of the board manufacturing information.

NOTE

l For details on the loopback function, see the OptiX RTN 950 Radio Transmission System Maintenance

Guide.

l A warm reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control and communication unit but

does not affect the services. A cold reset causes the reset on the board software unit in the system control

and communication unit, the initiation of the board (if the board has the FPGA, the FPGA is reloaded), and

a service interruption.

3.10.3 Working Principle and Signal Flow

This topic considers the processing of one E1 signal as an example to describe the working

 principle and signal flow of the SP3S/SP3D.

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-42 Functional block diagram of the SP3S/SP3D

Backplane

Logic

control

unit

Cross-connect unit

E1

E1

Inte

rfaceunit

Mapping/Demappi

ngunit

System control and

communication unit

Service bus

Control bus

E1 signal Co

decunit

Logic

processingunit

+3.3 V

Clock

unit

Clock signal provided to the

other units on the boardSystem clock signal

Power

Supply Unit

-48 V1+3.3V power supplied

to the board

-48 V2

+3.3V backup power

supplied to the board

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-97

Page 134: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 134/496

Signal Processing Flow in the Receive Direction

Table 3-71 Signal processing flow in the receive direction of the SP3S/SP3D

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow1 Interface unit The external E1 signals are coupled by the transformer  

and then are transmitted to the board.

2 Codec unit   l Equalizes the received signals.

l Recovers the clock signal.

l Detects the T_ALOS alarm.

l Performs the HDB3 decoding.

3 Mapping/

Demapping unit

l Asynchronously maps the signals into C-12s.

l

Adds the path overhead bytes to the C-12s, thusforming VC-12s.

l Processes the pointers, thus forming TU-12s.

l Performs the byte interleaving for three TU-12s, thus

forming one TUG-2.

l Performs the byte interleaving for seven TU-2s, thus

forming one TUG-3.

l Performs the byte interleaving for three TU-3s, thus

forming one C-4.

l Adds the higher order path overhead bytes to the C-4,

thus forming one VC-4.

4 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Transmits the VC-4 signal and pointer indication

signal to the main and standby cross-connect units.

 

Signal Processing Flow in the Transmit Direction

Table 3-72 Signal processing flow in the transmit direction of the SP3S/SP3D

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

1 Logic processing

unit

l Processes the clock signal.

l Receives the VC-4 signal and pointer indication signal

from the cross-connect unit.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-98 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 135: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 135/496

Step Functional Unit Processing Flow

2 Mapping/

Demapping unit

l Demultiplexes three TUG-3s from one VC-4.

l Demultiplexes seven TUG-2s from one TUG-3.

l Demultiplexes three VC-12s from one TUG-2.

l Processes path overheads and pointers and detects the

corresponding alarms and performance events.

l Extracts the E1 signals.

3 Codec unit Performs the HDB3 coding.

4 Interface unit The E1 signals are coupled by the transformer and then

are transmitted to the external cable.

 

Control Signal Processing Flow

The SP3S/SP3D is directly controlled by the CPU unit of the system control and communication

unit. The CPU unit issues the configuration data and query commands to the other units of the

SP3S/SP3D through the control bus. The command responses, alarms, and performance events

are also reported to the CPU unit through the control bus.

The logic control unit decodes the read/write address signals from the CPU unit of the system

control and communication unit.

Power Supply Unit

This unit receives two -48 V power supplies from the backplane, converts the -48 V power into

the +3.3 V power, and then supplies the +3.3 V power to the other units on the board.

The power supply unit receives a +3.3 V power supply from the backplane, which functions as

a +3.3 V power backup for the other units on the board.

Clock Unit

This unit receives the system clock from the control bus in the backplane and provides the clock 

signal to the other units on the board.

3.10.4 Front PanelThere are indicators and E1 interfaces on the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-43 Front panel of the SP3S

    S    P    3    S

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

1-16  S

    P    3    S

E1

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-99

Page 136: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 136/496

Page 137: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 137/496

Table 3-75 Description of the interfaces on the SP3D

Interface Description ConnectorType

Corresponding Cable

1-22 The first to sixteenthE1 interfaces

Anea 96 E1 Cable to the ExternalEquipment orE1 Cable to the

E1 Panel

23-42 The seventeenth to

thirty-second E1

interfaces

Anea 96 E1 Cable to the External

Equipment orE1 Cable to the

E1 Panel

 

NOTE

In the case of the OptiX RTN 950, only the ports 1-16 and 22-37 of the SP3D interface are used. Ports 1-16

correspond to E1 signals 1-16 and ports 22-37 correspond to E1 signals 17-32.

The interfaces on the SP3S/SP3D use the Anea 96 connectors. The pin assignment information

of the Anea 96 interfaces is provided in Figure 3-45 and Table 3-76.

Figure 3-45 Pin assignment of the Anea 96 interface

POS.96

POS.1

 

Table 3-76 Pin assignment of the Anea 96 interface

Pin Signal Pin Signal

1 The first received E1

differential signal (+)

25 The first transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

2 The first received E1

differential signal (-)

26 The first transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

3 The second received E1

differential signal (+)

27 The second transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

4 The second received E1

differential signal (-)

28 The second transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

5 The third received E1

differential signal (+)

29 The third transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-101

Page 138: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 138/496

Pin Signal Pin Signal

6 The third received E1

differential signal (-)

30 The third transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

7 The fourth received E1differential signal (+)

31 The fourth transmitted E1 differentialsignal (+)

8 The fourth received E1

differential signal (-)

32 The fourth transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

9 The fifth received E1

differential signal (+)

33 The fifth transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

10 The fifth received E1

differential signal (-)

34 The fifth transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

11 The sixth received E1

differential signal (+)

35 The sixth transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

12 The sixth received E1

differential signal (-)

36 The sixth transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

13 The seventh received E1

differential signal (+)

37 The seventh transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

14 The seventh received E1

differential signal (-)

38 The seventh transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

15 The eighth received E1

differential signal (+)

39 The eighth transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

16 The eighth received E1

differential signal (-)

40 The eighth transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

17 The ninth received E1

differential signal (+)

41 The ninth transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

18 The ninth received E1

differential signal (-)

42 The ninth transmitted E1 differential

signal (-)

19 The tenth received E1

differential signal (+)

43 The tenth transmitted E1 differential

signal (+)

20 The tenth received E1differential signal (-)

44 The tenth transmitted E1 differentialsignal (-)

21 The eleventh received E1

differential signal (+)

45 The eleventh transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

22 The eleventh received E1

differential signal (-)

46 The eleventh transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

23 The twelfth received E1

differential signal (+)

47 The twelfth transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

24 The twelfth received E1

differential signal (-)

48 The twelfth transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-102 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 139: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 139/496

Pin Signal Pin Signal

49 The thirteenth received E1

differential signal (+)

73 The thirteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

50 The thirteenth received E1differential signal (-)

74 The thirteenth transmitted E1differential signal (-)

51 The fourteenth received E1

differential signal (+)

75 The fourteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

52 The fourteenth received E1

differential signal (-)

76 The fourteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

53 The fifteenth received E1

differential signal (+)

77 The fifteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

54 The fifteenth received E1

differential signal (-)

78 The fifteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

55 The sixteenth received E1

differential signal (+)

79 The sixteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (+)

56 The sixteenth received E1

differential signal (-)

80 The sixteenth transmitted E1

differential signal (-)

 

3.10.5 Valid Slots

The SP3S/SP3D can be inserted in slots 1-6. The logical slots of the SP3S/SP3D on the NMSshould be the same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-46 Slots for the SP3S/SP3D in the IDU 950 chassis

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 5 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 3 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 2 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 4 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 6 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 8Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11(FAN)

 

Figure 3-47 Logical slots for the logical boards of the SP3S/SP3D

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 5 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 3 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 2 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 4 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 6 (SP3S/SP3D)

Slot 8Slot 10(PIU)

Slot 11(FAN)

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-103

Page 140: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 140/496

Table 3-77 Slot configuration for the SP3S/SP3D

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2 > slots 3 and 5

 

3.10.6 Board Feature Code

The E1 interface impedance of the SP3S/SP3D can be identified by the board feature code of 

the bar code. In the bar code, the board feature code is the number next to the board name.

Table 3-78 Board feature code of the SP3S/SP3D

Board Feature Code Interface Impedance (Ohm)

A 120

B 75

 

3.10.7 Board Parameter Settings

This topic provides the hyperlinks of the main parameter settings for the SP3S/SP3D.

Related ReferencesA.14.12 Parameter Description: PDH Interfaces

A.15.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs

3.10.8 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the E1 interface performance, board

mechanical behavior and board power consumption.

E1 Interface Performance

Table 3-79 E1 interface performance

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 2048

Code pattern HDB3

Wire pair in each

transmission direction

One coaxial wire pair One symmetrical wire pair  

Impedance (ohm) 75 120

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-104 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 141: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 141/496

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-80 Mechanical behavior 

Item PerformanceSP3S SP3D

Dimensions 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm (width)

Weight 0.54 kg 0.64 kg

 

Power consumption

Power consumption of the SP3S: < 5.7 W

Power consumption of the SP3D: < 9.6 W

3.11 AUX

The AUX is the auxiliary and management interface board of the OptiX RTN 950. One NE can

house only one AUX.

3.11.1 Version Description

The functional version of the AUX is SL91.

3.11.2 Functions and FeaturesThe AUX provides multiple auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces, including the one

orderwire interface, one synchronous data interface, one asynchronous data interface, and one

four-input/two-output external alarm interface.

3.11.3 Working Principle

The main components of the AUX are the orderwire unit, logic control unit, and clock unit.

3.11.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, and auxiliary interfaces on the front panel.

3.11.5 Valid Slots

The AUX can be inserted in Slots 1-6. The logical slots of the AUX on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

3.11.6 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including auxiliary interface performance, board

mechanical behavior, and board power consumption.

3.11.1 Version Description

The functional version of the AUX is SL91.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-105

Page 142: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 142/496

3.11.2 Functions and Features

The AUX provides multiple auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces, including the one

orderwire interface, one synchronous data interface, one asynchronous data interface, and one

four-input/two-output external alarm interface.

l Provides one orderwire interface.

l Provides one 64 kbit/s synchronous transparent data interface.

l Supports one 19.2 kbit/s asynchronous transparent data interface.

l Supports the input of four channels of external alarms.

l Supports the output of two channels of external alarms.

l Supports hot swapping.

l Supports the detection of the board power supply.

3.11.3 Working Principle

The main components of the AUX are the orderwire unit, logic control unit, and clock unit.

Functional Block Diagram

Figure 3-48 Functional block diagram of the AUX

19.2 kbit/s as ynchronous

data interface

Orderwireunit

Power supply unit

Clock unit

Logic control

unit

Board statusdetection unit

Backplane

four-input/two-outputalarm interface

One orderwire interface

64 kbit/s synchronousdata interface

Power dipdetection signal

System bus

+3.3 V

System control andcommunication unit

System control and

communication unitClock

signal

Power Supply Unit

l Access the +3.3 V power supply from the backplane to other units on the AUX.

l Receives and shuts down the control signal.

Orderwire Unit

l Supports the input of four channels of alarms.

l Supports the output of two channels of alarms.

l Provides one Orderwire interface.

l Provides one 64 kbit/s synchronous transparent data interface.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-106 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 143: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 143/496

l Provides one 19.2 kbit/s asynchronous transparent data interface.

NOTE

The 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface can transparently transmit the orderwire byte. One interface can,

however, implement only one of the two functions: 64 kbit/s synchronous data interface and transparent

transmission of the orderwire byte.

Logic Control Unit

l Provides the CPU unit interface and works with the CPU unit to realize the board control

function.

l Processes the orderwire byte and overhead bytes.

l Processes the clock signal.

l Provides the board status information.

l Checks the status of the main and standby CST/CSH boards.

l Checks the status of the main and standby clocks.

l Supports the switching of the clock reference source automatically and by running the

corresponding command.

l Supports the detection and reporting of the key clock status of each board in the system.

Board Status Detection Unit

l Detects the board performance data, such as the board voltage.

l Stores the board manufacturing information.

Clock Unit

Provides the clock signal to the logic control unit.

3.11.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, management interfaces, and auxiliary interfaces on the front panel.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-49 shows the appearance of the front panel of the AUX.

Figure 3-49 Front panel of the AUX

    A    U    X

    S    T    A    T

    S    R    V

F1/S1 PHONE ALMO ALMI

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-107

Page 144: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 144/496

Indicators

Table 3-81 Description of the indicators on the AUX

Indicator State Meaning  STAT On (green) The board is working normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs on the board.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the

system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

 

Auxiliary Interfaces and Management Interfaces

Table 3-82 Description of the auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces

Interface Description Connector Type

F1/S1 Synchronous/Asynchronous data interface RJ-45

ALMI Alarm input

ALMO Alarm output

PHONE Orderwire phone

 

The auxiliary interfaces and management interfaces use RJ-45 connectors. The pin assignments

of the interfaces, however, are different. Figure 3-50 shows the front view of the RJ-45

connector.

Figure 3-50 Front view of the RJ-45 connector 

8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-108 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 145: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 145/496

 

The pin assignment information of the F1/S1 interface is provided in Table 3-83.

Table 3-83 Pin assignment of the F1/S1 interface

Interface Pin Signal

F1/S1 1 Transmitting asynchronous data signals

2 Grounding end

3 Receiving asynchronous data signals

4 Transmitting synchronous data signals (TIP)

5 Transmitting synchronous data signals (RING)

6 Grounding end

7 Receiving synchronous data signals (TIP)

8 Receiving synchronous data signals (RING)

 

For the pin assignment information of the ALMI and ALMO interfaces, see Table 3-84 and see

Table 3-85.

Table 3-84 Pin assignment of the ALMI interface

Interface Pin Signal

ALMI 1 The first external alarm input signal

2 Grounding end for the first external alarm input signal

3 The second external alarm input signal

4 The third external alarm input signal

5 Grounding end for the second external alarm input

signal

6 Grounding end for the third external alarm input signal

7 The forth external alarm input signal

8 Grounding end for the forth external alarm input signal

 

Table 3-85 Pin assignment of the ALMO interface

Interface Pin Signal

ALMO 1 The first external alarm output signal (+)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-109

Page 146: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 146/496

Interface Pin Signal

2 The first external alarm output signal (-)

3 The second external alarm output signal (+)

4 The first external alarm output signal (+)

5 The first external alarm output signal (-)

6 The second external alarm output signal (-)

7 The second external alarm output signal (+)

8 The second external alarm output signal (-)

 

3.11.5 Valid Slots

The AUX can be inserted in Slots 1-6. The logical slots of the AUX on the NMS should be the

same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-51 Slots for the AUX in the IDU chassis

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (AUX)

Slot 5 (AUX)

Slot 3 (AUX)

Slot 2 (AUX)

 Slot 4 (AUX)

 Slot 6 (AUX)

Slot 8

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

Figure 3-52 Logical slots for the logical boards of the AUX

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1 (AUX)

Slot 5 (AUX)

Slot 3 (AUX)

Slot 2 (AUX)

 Slot 4 (AUX)

 Slot 6 (AUX)

Slot 8

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

Table 3-86 Slot configuration for the AUX

Item Description

Slot allocation priority Slots 4 and 6 > slots 1 and 2 > slots 3 and 5

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-110 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 147: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 147/496

3.11.6 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including auxiliary interface performance, board

mechanical behavior, and board power consumption.

Orderwire Interface Performance

Table 3-87 Orderwire interface performance

Item Performance

Transmission path Uses the E1 and E2 bytes in the SDH overhead or the Huawei-

defined byte in the overhead of the microwave frame.

Orderwire type Addressing call

Wire pair in each

transmission direction

One symmetrical wire pair 

Impedance (ohm) 600

 

NOTE

The OptiX RTN equipment also supports the orderwire group call function. For example, when an OptiX RTN

equipment calls the number of 888, the orderwire group call number, all the OptiX RTN equipment orderwire

 phones in the orderwire subnet ring until a phone is answered. Then, a point-to-point orderwire phone call is

established.

Synchronous Data Interface Performance

Table 3-88 Synchronous data interface performance

Item Performance

Transmission path Uses the F1 byte in the SDH overhead or the Huawei-defined

 byte in the overhead of the microwave frame.

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s) 64

Interface type Codirectional

Interface characteristics Meets the ITU-T G.703 standard.

 

Asynchronous Data Interface

Table 3-89 Asynchronous data interface performance

Item Performance

Transmission path Uses the user-defined byte of the SDH overhead or the

Huawei-defined byte in the overhead of the microwave frame.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-111

Page 148: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 148/496

Item Performance

 Nominal bit rate (kbit/s)   ≤ 19.2

Interface characteristics Meets the RS-232 standard.

 

Mechanical Behavior

Table 3-90 Mechanical behavior 

Item Performance

Dimensions 19.82 mm (height) x 196.70 mm (depth) x 193.80 mm

(width)

Weight 0.27 kg

 

Power Consumption

Power consumption: < 1.3 W

3.12 PIU

The PIU is the power supply board. The OptiX RTN 950 supports two PIUs, each of which

accesses one -48 V/-60 V DC power sup ply.

3.12.1 Version Description

The functional version of the PIU is TND1.

3.12.2 Functions and Features

The PIU supports the functions and features such as power access, power protection, lightning

 protection, and information reporting.

3.12.3 Working Principle

The PIU mainly consists of the lightning protection and failure detection unit, communication

unit, slot ID unit, and board in-position unit.

3.12.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, power access interfaces, and a label.

3.12.5 Valid Slots

The PIU can be inserted in Slots 9 and 10. The logical slots of the PIU on the NMS should be

the same as the physical slots.

3.12.6 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the dimensions and input voltage.

3.12.1 Version Description

The functional version of the PIU is TND1.

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-112 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 149: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 149/496

3.12.2 Functions and Features

The PIU supports the functions and features such as power access, power protection, lightning

 protection, and information reporting.

l Power access

Each of the two PIU accesses one -48 V DC or -60 V DC power supply for the equipment.

l Power protection

The PIU protects the DC power supply against overcurrent and short circuits. In this

manner, the board and board components are prevented from being blown out in the case

of overcurrent.

l Lightning protection

The PIU protects the equipment against lightning and reports an alarm if the protection

fails.

l Power backup

The two PIUs provide 1+1 hot backup for each other. One PIU is capable of supplying

 power for the entire chassis.

3.12.3 Working Principle

The PIU mainly consists of the lightning protection and failure detection unit, communication

unit, slot ID unit, and board in-position unit.

Figure 3-53 shows the functional block diagram of the PIU.

Figure 3-53 Functional block diagram of the PIU

Communication

unit

Board

in-position unit

Backplane

Inter-board

communication

bus System control and

communication unit

Lightning protection

and failure

detection unit

-48 V/-60 V

Board

in-position

signal

 Alarm signal indicating

lightning protection failure

Other boards

System control and

communication unit

Slot ID unit

Slot ID

informationSystem control and

communication unit

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-113

Page 150: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 150/496

Lightning Protection and Failure Detection Unit

This unit protects the equipment against lightning and detects the failure of the lightning

 protective circuit. If the lightning protection fails, the PIU reports the alarm signals to system

control and communication unit, through the communication unit.

Communication Unit

This unit reports the board manufacturing information, PCB version information, and alarm

signals indicating the lightning protection failure to the system control and communication unit.

Slot ID Unit

This unit reports the slot ID information to the system control and communication unit.

Board In-Position Unit

This unit reports the board in-position signals to the system control and communication unit.

3.12.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, power access interfaces, and a label.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 3-54 shows the appearance of the front panel of the PIU.

Figure 3-54 Front panel of the PIU

  -    4    8    V

  -    6    0    V

    P    W    R

    N    E    G    (  -    )    R    T    N    (    +    )

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-114 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 151: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 151/496

Indicators

Table 3-91 Description of the power status indicators

Indicator Status DescriptionPWR On (green) The power supply is connected.

Off There is no power supplied to the PIU or the power  

supply is connected incorrectly.

 

Interfaces

The PIU accesses one power supply. Table 3-92 lists the types of the interfaces on the PIU and

their respective usage.

Table 3-92 Description of the interfaces on the PIU

Interface Interface Type Usage

 NEG(-) -48 V power input

interface

Inputs the -48 V power.

RTN(+) BGND power input

interface

Inputs the BGND power.

 

Label

The label on the front panel indicates that the PIU accesses multiple power supplies.

CAUTION

Multiple power supplies are accessed for the equipment. When powering off the equipment,

ensure that these power supplies are disabled.

3.12.5 Valid Slots

The PIU can be inserted in Slots 9 and 10. The logical slots of the PIU on the NMS should be

the same as the physical slots.

Figure 3-55 Slots for the PIU in the IDU chassis

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1

Slot 5

Slot 3

Slot 2

 Slot 4

 Slot 6

Slot 8

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-115

Page 152: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 152/496

 

Figure 3-56 Logical slots for the logical boards of the PIU

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1

Slot 5

Slot 3

Slot 2

 Slot 4

 Slot 6

Slot 8

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 10(PIU)

 

3.12.6 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the dimensions and input voltage.

Table 3-93 lists the technical specifications for the PIU.

Table 3-93 Technical specifications

Item Performance

Dimensions 41.4 mm (width) x 229.9 mm (depth) x 21.0

mm (height)

Weight 0.12 kg

Power Consumption < 0.5 W

Input voltage -38.4 V to -72.0 V

 

3.13 FAN

The FAN is the fan board that dissipates the heat from the chassis through wind cooling.

3.13.1 Version Description

The functional version of the FAN is TND1.

3.13.2 Functions and FeaturesThe FAN adjusts the fan rotating speed, and detects and reports the fan status.

3.13.3 Working Principle

The FAN mainly consists of the combiner/start-delay unit, filter unit, communication unit,

intelligent fan speed adjustment unit, and board in-position unit.

3.13.4 Front Panel

There are indicators, ESD wrist strap jack, and labels on the front panel.

3.13.5 Valid Slots

The FAN is inserted in slot 11 in the IDU chassis. The logical slot of the FAN on the NMS

should be the same as the physical slot.

3.13.6 Technical Specifications

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-116 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 153: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 153/496

This topic describes the board specifications, including the dimensions, weight, power 

consumption, and working voltage.

3.13.1 Version Description

The functional version of the FAN is TND1.

3.13.2 Functions and Features

The FAN adjusts the fan rotating speed, and detects and reports the fan status.

The FAN has the following functions and features:

l Accesses two +12 V power supplies for driving the six fans each of which consumes 6 W

 power.

l Provides start-delay for the power supply of the fans, protects fans against overcurrent, and

filters the lower frequency.

l Intelligently adjusts the rotating speed of fans to ensure proper heat dissipation of the system

with lowest power consumption and lowest noise.

l Reports the fan rotating speed, alarms, version number, and board in-position information.

l Provides alarm indicators.

l Disables the power supplies to the fans.

3.13.3 Working Principle

The FAN mainly consists of the combiner/start-delay unit, filter unit, communication unit,

intelligent fan speed adjustment unit, and board in-position unit.

Figure 3-57 shows the functional block diagram of the FAN.

Figure 3-57 Functional block diagram of the FAN

Six fans

+12 power shutdownsignal

+12 V

Inter-board communicationbus

Board in-position

unit

PWM signal

Communicatio

n unit

System control and

communication unit

Fan rotating speed signal

Fan in-position signal

+12 V

+12 V

+12 V

Filter unit

Combiner/start-

delay unit

CombineStart delay

+12 V

Intelligent fan speed

adjustment unit

PWM drivingunit

Rotating speed

reporting unit

System control and

communication unit

System control and

communication unit

System control and

communication unit

System control andcommunication unit

System control and

communication unit

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-117

Page 154: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 154/496

Page 155: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 155/496

Figure 3-58 Front Panel Diagram

FAN

CRIT

MAJ

MIN

 

Indicators

Table 3-95 Description of the fan status indicators

Indicator State Meaning  

FAN On (green) The fan is running normally.

On (red) The fan is faulty.

Off The fan is not powered on or is not installed.

 

NOTE

The CRIT, MAJ, or MIN indicator on the front panel of the FAN indicates the current alarm severity of the

subrack.

ESD Wrist Strap Jack

The ESD wrist strap needs to be connected to the ESD wrist strap jack to realize the proper 

grounding of the human body.

Labels

The front panel of the FAN has the following labels:

l ESD protection label: indicates that the equipment is static-sensitive.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 3 Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-119

Page 156: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 156/496

l Fan warning label: warns you not to touch the fan leaves when the fan is rotating.

3.13.5 Valid Slots

The FAN is inserted in slot 11 in the IDU chassis. The logical slot of the FAN on the NMSshould be the same as the physical slot.

Figure 3-59 Slot for the FAN in the IDU chassis

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1

Slot 5

Slot 3

Slot 2

 Slot 4

 Slot 6

Slot 8

Slot 9

(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

Figure 3-60 Logical slot for the logical board of the FAN

Slot 11

(FAN)

Slot 7

Slot 1

Slot 5

Slot 3

Slot 2

 Slot 4

 Slot 6

Slot 8

Slot 9(PIU)

Slot 10

(PIU)

 

3.13.6 Technical Specifications

This topic describes the board specifications, including the dimensions, weight, power 

consumption, and working voltage.

Table 3-96 lists the technical specifications for the FAN.

Table 3-96 Technical specifications for the FAN

Item Performance

Dimensions 86.2 mm (width) x 217.6 mm (depth) x 28.5 mm height)

Weight 0.302 kg

Power consumption <4.1 W (room temprature)

<29.6 W (high temperature)

Working voltage 10.8 V-13.2 V (for accessing the 12 V DC power)

 

3 Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

3-120 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 157: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 157/496

Page 158: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 158/496

Page 159: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 159/496

Figure 4-2 Pin assignments of an E1 port (E1 panel)

Pos. 1

Pos. 37

 

Table 4-2 Pin assignments of an E1 port (E1 panel)

Pin Signal Pin Signal

20 1st E1 receiving differentialsignal (+) 21 1st E1 transmitting differentialsignal (+)

2 1st E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

3 1st E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

22 2nd E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

23 2nd E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

4 2nd E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

5 2nd E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

24 3rd E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

25 3rd E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

6 3rd E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

7 3nd E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

26 4th E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

27 4th E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

8 4th E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

9 4th E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

36 5th E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

35 5th E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

17 5th E1 receiving differentialsignal (-)

16 5th E1 transmitting differentialsignal (-)

34 6th E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

33 6th E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

15 6th E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

14 6th E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

32 7th E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

31 7th E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

13 7th E1 receiving differential

signal (-)

12 7th E1 transmitting differential

signal (-)

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 4 Accessories

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

4-3

Page 160: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 160/496

Pin Signal Pin Signal

30 8th E1 receiving differential

signal (+)

29 8th E1 transmitting differential

signal (+)

11 8th E1 receiving differentialsignal (-)

10 8th E1 transmitting differentialsignal (-)

Others Reserved - -

 

4.2 PDU

The PDU is installed on the top of a 19-inch cabinet. The PDU is used to distribute the input

 power to the equipment in the cabinet.

4.2.1 Front Panel

There are input power terminals, PGND terminals, output power terminals, and power switches

on the front panel of the PDU.

4.2.2 Functions and Working Principle

The PDU realizes the simple power distribution function. The PDU distributes the input power 

to the equipment in a cabinet.

4.2.3 Power Distribution Mode

The PDU supports the DC-C and DC-I power distribution modes. By default, the DC-C power 

distribution mode is used.

4.2.1 Front Panel

There are input power terminals, PGND terminals, output power terminals, and power switches

on the front panel of the PDU.

Front Panel Diagram

Figure 4-3 Front panel of the PDU

NEG2(-)

INPUT

RTN2(+)RTN1(+) NEG1(-)

3

ON

OFF

ON

OFF

1 2 3 4

1 4

1 2 3 4

OUTPUT OUTPUT A B

2

20A20A 20A 20A20A20A 20A 20A

5 6

1. Output power terminals (A) 2. PGND terminals

4 Accessories

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

4-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 161: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 161/496

3. Input power terminals 4. Output power terminals (B)

5. Power switches (A) 6. Power switches (B)

 

Interfaces

Table 4-3 Interfaces on the PDU

Position Interface Description

Output power 

terminals (A)

+ Power output (+)

- Power output (-)

PGND

terminals

Grounding stud

of the two-holeOT terminal

For connecting the PGND cable

Input power 

terminals

RTN1(+) The first power input (+)

RTN2(+) The second power input (+)

 NEG1(-) The first power input (-)

 NEG2(-) The second power input (-)

Output power 

terminals (B)

+ Power output (+)

- Power output (-)

Power 

switches (A)

20 A They are switches for the power outputs. The fuse

capacity is 20 A. The switches from the left to the right

correspond to output power terminals 1-4 on the A side,

respectively.

Power 

switches (B)

20 A They are switches for the power outputs. The fuse

capacity is 20 A. The switches from the left to the right

correspond to output power terminals 1-4 on the B side,

respectively.

 

4.2.2 Functions and Working Principle

The PDU realizes the simple power distribution function. The PDU distributes the input power 

to the equipment in a cabinet.

Functions

l The PDU supports two inputs of -48 V/-60 V DC power.

l Each input power supply supports four outputs.

l The fuse capacity of the switch of each power output is 20 A.

l The PDU supports the DC-C and DC-I power distribution modes.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 4 Accessories

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

4-5

Page 162: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 162/496

 Working Principle

The PDU mainly consists of input terminals, output terminals, and miniature circuit breakers

(MCBs). The PDU supports the simple power distribution function for the input power.

Figure 4-4 Functional block diagram of the PDU

SW1

SW2

SW3

SW4

SW1

SW2

SW4

SW4

INPUT

RTN1(+)

RTN2(+)

NEG1(-)

NEG2(-)

+  1-

+  2-

+  3-

+  4

-

+  1-

+  2-

+  3-

+  4-

OUTPUT A

OUTPUT B

PGND

BGND

BGND

 

4.2.3 Power Distribution Mode

The PDU supports the DC-C and DC-I power distribution modes. By default, the DC-C power 

distribution mode is used.

The power distribution mode of the PDU is controlled by the short-circuiting copper bar that is

inside the PDU.

DC-C Power Distribution ModeWhen the DC-C power distribution mode is used, the short-circuiting copper bar short-circuits

terminal RTN1(+), terminal RTN2(+), and the PGND.

4 Accessories

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

4-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 163: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 163/496

Page 164: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 164/496

Page 165: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 165/496

5 Cables

About This Chapter

This topic describes the purpose, appearance, and pin assignment information of various cables

of the IDU 950.

5.1 Power Ca ble

The power ca ble connects the PIU board in the IDU to the power supply device (for example,

the PDU on top of the cabinet), thus conducting the -48 V power to the IDU.

5.2 PGND Cable

The PGND cable is available in two types, namely, the IDU PGND cable and E1 panel PGND

cable.

5.3 IF Jumper 

The IF jumper connects the IDU and IF cable. The IF jumper is used with the IF cable to transmit

the IF signal, O&M signal, and -48 V power between the ODU and the IDU.

5.4 XPIC Ca ble

The XPIC ca ble is used to transmit the reference IF signal between the two IFX2 boards of the

XPIC working group to realize the XPIC function.

5.5 Fiber Jumper 

The fiber jumper transmits optical signals. One end of the fiber jumper is terminated with an

LC/PC connector and is connected to the SDH optical interface or GE optical interface on the

OptiX RTN 950. The connector with which the other end of the fiber jumper is terminated

depends on the type of the optical interface on the equipment to be connected.

5.6 E1 Cables

The E1 cable is available in two types, namely, the E1 cable (Anea 96) to the external equipment

and E1 cable to the E1 panel.

5.7 Orderwire Cable

The orderwire cable connects the orderwire phone to the equipment. Both ends of the orderwire

cable are terminated with RJ-11 connectors. One end of the orderwire cable is connected to the

PHONE interface on the AUX. The other end of the orderwire cable is connected to the interface

of the orderwire phone.

5.8 Network Cable

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-1

Page 166: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 166/496

The network cable connects two pieces of Ethernet equipment. Both ends of the network cable

are terminated with RJ-45 connectors.

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 167: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 167/496

5.1 Power Cable

The power cable connects the PIU board in the IDU to the power supply device (for example,

the PDU on top of the cabinet), thus conducting the -48 V power to the IDU.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-1 Power cable

 

Table 5-1 Specifications of the power cable

Model Cable Terminal

6 mm2 power 

cable and

terminal

Power Cable, 450 V/

750 V, H07Z-K-6

mm2, Blue/Black,

Low Smoke Zero

Halogen Cable

Common Terminal, Single Cord End Terminal,

Conductor Cross Section 6 mm2, 30 A, Insertion

Depth 12 mm, Blue

 

NOTE

In the case of the OptiX RTN 950, the power cable whose conductor line has a sectional area of 6 mm 2 can

extend for a maximum distance of 43 m.

5.2 PGND Cable

The PGND cable is available in two types, namely, the IDU PGND cable and E1 panel PGND

cable.

5.2.1 IDU PGND Cable

The IDU PGND cable connects the left ground point of the IDU to the ground point of the

external equipment (for example, the ground support of a cabinet) so that the IDU and theexternal equipment share the same ground.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-3

Page 168: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 168/496

5.2.2 E1 Panel PGND Cable

The E1 panel PGND cable connects the right ground nut of the E1 panel to the ground point of 

the external equipment (for example, the ground support of a cabinet) so that the E1 panel and

the external equipment share the same ground.

5.2.1 IDU PGND Cable

The IDU PGND cable connects the left ground point of the IDU to the ground point of the

external equipment (for example, the ground support of a cabinet) so that the IDU and the

external equipment share the same ground.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-2 IDU PGND cable

2

Main label

H.S.tubeCable tie1

L

1. Bare crimping terminal, OT 2. Bare crimping terminal, OT

 

Pin Assignment

 None.

5.2.2 E1 Panel PGND Cable

The E1 panel PGND cable connects the right ground nut of the E1 panel to the ground point of 

the external equipment (for example, the ground support of a cabinet) so that the E1 panel and

the external equipment share the same ground.

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 169: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 169/496

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-3 E1 panel PGND cable

1

Main label

L

Bare crimping terminal, OT

 

Pin Assignment

 None.

5.3 IF Jumper

The IF jumper connects the IDU and IF cable. The IF jumper is used with the IF cable to transmit

the IF signal, O&M signal, and -48 V power between the ODU and the IDU.

The IF jumper is a 2 m RG-223 cable. One end of the IF jumper is terminated with a type-N

connector and is connected to the IF cable. The other end of the IF jumper is terminated with a

TNC connector and is connected to the IF board.

NOTE

l The 5D IF cable is directly connected to the IF board. Thus, when the 5D IF cable is used, the IF jumper 

is not required.

l When the RG-8U or 1/2-inch IF cable is used, an IF jumper is required to connect the RG-8U or 1/2-

inch IF cable to the IF board.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-5

Page 170: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 170/496

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-4 IF jumper 

1

2H.S.tube 2 PCS

L = 3 cm

2000 mm

1. RF coaxial cable connector, TNC, male 2. RF coaxial cable connector, type-N, female

 

Pin Assignment

 None.

5.4 XPIC Cable

The XPIC cable is used to transmit the reference IF signal between the two IFX2 boards of theXPIC working group to realize the XPIC function.

The XPIC cable is an RG316 cable with SMA connectors at both ends. One end of the XPIC

cable is connected to the X-IN port of one IFX2 board of an XPIC working group, and the other 

end of the XPIC cable is connected to the X-OUT port of the other IFX2 board of the same XPIC

working group.

When the XPIC function of an IFX2 board is disabled, use an XPIC cable to connect the X-IN

 port and X-OUT port of the IFX2 board to loop back signals.

The XPIC cable is available in the following two types:

l

XPIC cable using angle connectors: The XPIC cable using angle connectors is very long,and is used to connect the two IFX2 boards in the horizontal direction, for example, the

IFX2 boards in slots 3 and 4.

l XPIC cable using straight connectors: The XPIC cable using straight connectors is very

short, and is used to connect the two IFX2 boards in the vertical direction, for example, the

IFX2 boards in slots 3 and 5. The XPIC cable using straight connectors is also used to

connect the X-IN port and X-OUT port of the same IFX2 board to loop back signals.

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 171: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 171/496

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-5 View of the XPIC cable

L1

1 1

L2

22

1. Coaxial cable connector, SMA, angle, male 2. Coaxial cable connector, SMA, straight, male

 

Cable Connection Table

 None.

5.5 Fiber Jumper

The fiber jumper transmits optical signals. One end of the fiber jumper is terminated with an

LC/PC connector and is connected to the SDH optical interface or GE optical interface on the

OptiX RTN 950. The connector with which the other end of the fiber jumper is terminated

depends on the type of the optical interface on the equipment to be connected.

Types of Fiber Jumpers

Table 5-2 Types of fiber jumpers

Connector 1 Connector 2 Cable

LC/PC FC/PC 2 mm single-mode fiber  

2 mm multi-mode fiber 

LC/PC SC/PC 2 mm single-mode fiber  

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-7

Page 172: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 172/496

Connector 1 Connector 2 Cable

2 mm multi-mode fiber 

LC/PC LC/PC 2 mm single-mode fiber  

2 mm multi-mode fiber 

 

NOTE

In the case of the OptiX RTN 950, multi-mode fibers are required to connect to the 1000Base-SX GE optical

interfaces.

Fiber Connectors

The following figures show three common types of fiber connectors, namely, LC/PC connector,

SC/PC connector, and FC/PC connector.

Figure 5-6 LC/PC connector 

 

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-8 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 173: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 173/496

Figure 5-7 SC/PC connector 

 

Figure 5-8 FC/PC connector 

 

5.6 E1 Cables

The E1 cable is available in two types, namely, the E1 cable (Anea 96) to the external equipment

and E1 cable to the E1 panel.

5.6.1 E1 Cable to the External Equipment

The E1 cable to the external equipment is used when the IDU needs to input or output E1 signals

directly to the external equipment.

5.6.2 E1 Cable to the E1 Panel

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-9

Page 174: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 174/496

The E1 cable to the E1 panel is used together with the E1 transit cable to connect the IDU to the

E1 panel when the E1 panel functions as the DDF. One end of the E1 cable is terminated with

a DB44 connector and is connected to the E1 transit cable. The other end of the E1 cable is

terminated with a DB37 connector and is connected to the E1 panel.

5.6.3 E1 Transit CableAn E1 transit cable is used to connect an E1 interface on the IDU. One end of the E1 transit

cable is terminated with an Anea 96 connector and is connected to the E1 interface on the IDU.

The other end of the E1 transit cable is terminated with a DB44 connector and is connected to

the E1 cable on the external equipment or to the E1 cable on the E1 panel.

5.6.1 E1 Cable to the External Equipment

The E1 cable to the external equipment is used when the IDU needs to input or output E1 signals

directly to the external equipment.

Each E1 cable to the external equipment can transmit a maximum of 16 E1 signals. The E1

cables to the external equipment are categorized into two types, namely, 75-ohm coaxial cablesand 120-ohm twisted pair cables.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-9 E1 cable

Main label

1

W

X1  A

View A

Pos .1

Pos.96Cable Connector, Anea, 96PIN,

Female Connector 

1. Cable connector, Anea 96, female

NOTE

l The appearance of the 120–ohm E1 cable is the same as the appearance of the 75–ohm E1 cable.

l The core of a 75–ohm E1 cable is 1.6 mm. Therefore, use 2.5 mm (0.098–inch) crimp pliers to terminate

the ends of E1 cables on the DDF frame with 75–1–1 coaxial connectors.

 

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 175: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 175/496

Pin Assignment

Table 5-3 Pin assignment of the 75-ohm E1 cable

Pin W1 Remarks Pin W2 RemarksCore Serial

No.Core Serial

No.

1 Tip 1 R1 25 Tip 2 T1

2 Ring 26 Ring

3 Tip 3 R2 27 Tip 4 T2

4 Ring 28 Ring

5 Tip 5 R3 29 Tip 6 T3

6 Ring 30 Ring

7 Tip 7 R4 31 Tip 8 T4

8 Ring 32 Ring

9 Tip 9 R5 33 Tip 10 T5

10 Ring 34 Ring

11 Tip 11 R6 35 Tip 12 T6

12 Ring 36 Ring

13 Tip 13 R7 37 Tip 14 T7

14 Ring 38 Ring

15 Tip 15 R8 39 Tip 16 T8

16 Ring 40 Ring

17 Ring 17 R9 41 Ring 18 T9

18 Tip 42 Tip

19 Ring 19 R10 43 Ring 20 T10

20 Tip 44 Tip

21 Ring 21 R11 45 Ring 22 T11

22 Tip 46 Tip

23 Ring 23 R12 47 Ring 24 T12

24 Tip 48 Tip

49 Ring 25 R13 73 Ring 26 T13

50 Tip 74 Tip

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-11

Page 176: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 176/496

Page 177: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 177/496

Pin W1 Remarks

Pin W2 Remarks

Color oftheCore

Relation

Color oftheCore

Relation

17 White Twisted

 pair 

R9 41 White Twisted

 pair 

T9

18 Blue 42 Orange

19 White Twisted

 pair 

R10 43 White Twisted

 pair 

T10

20 Green 44 Brown

21 White Twisted

 pair 

R11 45 Red Twisted

 pair 

T11

22 Grey 46 Blue

23 Red Twisted pair  R12 47 Red Twisted pair  T1224 Orange 48 Green

49 Red Twisted

 pair 

R13 73 Red Twisted

 pair 

T13

50 Brown 74 Grey

51 Black Twisted

 pair 

R14 75 Black Twisted

 pair 

T14

52 Blue 76 Orange

53 Black Twisted

 pair 

R15 77 Black Twisted

 pair 

T15

54 Green 78 Brown

55 Black Twisted

 pair 

R16 79 Yellow Twisted

 pair 

T16

56 Grey 80 Blue

Shell Braid Shell Braid

 

5.6.2 E1 Cable to the E1 Panel

The E1 cable to the E1 panel is used together with the E1 transit cable to connect the IDU to the

E1 panel when the E1 panel functions as the DDF. One end of the E1 cable is terminated with

a DB44 connector and is connected to the E1 transit cable. The other end of the E1 cable is

terminated with a DB37 connector and is connected to the E1 panel.

Each E1 cable can transmit eight E1 signals. The interface impedance of the E1 cable is 75 ohms.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-13

Page 178: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 178/496

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-10 E1 cable that connects the IDU to an E1 panel

1500 mm

 A

 APos.1

Pos.44

X1B

Pos.1

Pos.37

B

X2

X1. Cable connector, type-D, 44 male X2. Cable connector, type-D, 37 male

 

Cable Connection Table

Table 5-5 Connection table of the E1 cable that connects a PO1/PH1 board to an E1 panel

ConnectorX1

ConnectorX2

Remarks ConnectorX1

ConnectorX2

Remarks

X1.38 X2.20 R1 X1.34 X2.36 R5

X1.23 X2.2 X1.19 X2.17

X1.37 X2.22 R2 X1.33 X2.34 R6

X1.22 X2.4 X1.18 X2.15

X1.36 X2.24 R3 X1.32 X2.32 R7

X1.21 X2.6 X1.17 X2.13

X1.35 X2.26 R4 X1.31 X2.30 R8

X1.20 X2.8 X1.16 X2.11

X1.15 X2.21 T1 X1.11 X2.35 T5

X1.30 X2.3 X1.26 X2.16

X1.14 X2.23 T2 X1.10 X2.33 T6

X1.29 X2.5 X1.25 X2.14

X1.13 X2.25 T3 X1.9 X2.31 T7

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-14 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 179: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 179/496

ConnectorX1

ConnectorX2

Remarks ConnectorX1

ConnectorX2

Remarks

X1.28 X2.7 X1.24 X2.12

X1.12 X2.27 T4 X1.8 X2.29 T8

X1.27 X2.9 X1.7 X2.10

Shell Braid Shell Braid

 

5.6.3 E1 Transit Cable

An E1 transit cable is used to connect an E1 interface on the IDU. One end of the E1 transit

cable is terminated with an Anea 96 connector and is connected to the E1 interface on the IDU.

The other end of the E1 transit cable is terminated with a DB44 connector and is connected tothe E1 cable on the external equipment or to the E1 cable on the E1 panel.

An E1 transit cable can be connected to a 75-ohm E1 interface or a 120-ohm E1 interface.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-11 E1 transit cable terminated with the Anea 96 and DB44 connectors

Label 2M092

X3

X2

2

#4-40View B

Pos.44

Pos.1

Main Label

W2

W1

Label 1

X1 A

B

400

X1. Cable connector, Anea 96, female X2/X3. Cable connector, type-D, 44 female

Label 1: "CHAN 0-7" Label 2: "CHAN 8-15"

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-15

Page 180: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 180/496

Cable Connection Table

Table 5-6 Connection table of the E1 transit cable terminated with the Anea 96 and DB44

connectors

 Wire Connector X1

Connector X2/X3

Remarks Connector X1

Connector X2/X3

Remarks

W1 X1.2 X2.38 R1 X1.10 X2.34 R5

X1.1 X2.23 X1.9 X2.19

X1.26 X2.15 T1 X1.34 X2.11 T5

X1.25 X2.30 X1.33 X2.26

X1.4 X2.37 R2 X1.12 X2.33 R6

X1.3 X2.22 X1.11 X2.18

X1.28 X2.14 T2 X1.36 X2.10 T6

X1.27 X2.29 X1.35 X2.25

X1.6 X2.36 R3 X1.14 X2.32 R7

X1.5 X2.21 X1.13 X2.17

X1.30 X2.13 T3 X1.38 X2.9 T7

X1.29 X2.28 X1.37 X2.24

X1.8 X2.35 R4 X1.16 X2.31 R8

X1.7 X2.20 X1.15 X2.16

X1.32 X2.12 T4 X1.40 X2.8 T8

X1.31 X2.27 X1.39 X2.7

W2 X1.18 X3.38 R9 X1.50 X3.34 R13

X1.17 X3.23 X1.49 X3.19

X1.42 X3.15 T9 X1.74 X3.11 T13

X1.41 X3.30 X1.73 X3.26

X1.20 X3.37 R10 X1.52 X3.33 R14

X1.19 X3.22 X1.51 X3.18

X1.44 X3.14 T10 X1.76 X3.10 T14

X1.43 X3.29 X1.75 X3.25

X1.22 X3.36 R11 X1.54 X3.32 R15

X1.21 X3.21 X1.53 X3.17

X1.46 X3.13 T11 X1.78 X3.9 T15

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-16 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 181: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 181/496

 Wire Connector X1

Connector X2/X3

Remarks Connector X1

Connector X2/X3

Remarks

X1.45 X3.28 X1.77 X3.24

X1.24 X3.35 R12 X1.56 X3.31 R16

X1.23 X3.20 X1.55 X3.16

X1.48 X3.12 T12 X1.80 X3.8 T16

X1.47 X3.27 X1.79 X3.7

  Shell Braid Shell Braid

 

5.7 Orderwire CableThe orderwire cable connects the orderwire phone to the equipment. Both ends of the orderwire

cable are terminated with RJ-11 connectors. One end of the orderwire cable is connected to the

PHONE interface on the AUX. The other end of the orderwire cable is connected to the interface

of the orderwire phone.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-12 Orderwire cable

1

6

1

6

1 Main label

X1 X2

1. Orderwire interface, RJ-11 connector 

 

Pin Assignment

Table 5-7 Pin assignment of the orderwire cable

Connector X1 Connector X2 Function

X1.3 X2.3 Tip

X1.4 X2.4 Ring

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-17

Page 182: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 182/496

5.8 Network Cable

The network cable connects two pieces of Ethernet equipment. Both ends of the network cableare terminated with RJ-45 connectors.

Two types of interfaces use the RJ-45 connectors, which are the medium dependent interface

(MDI) and MDI-X. The MDI interface is used by the terminal equipment, for example, the

network card. For the pin assignment information of the MDI interface, see Table 5-8. The MDI-

X interface is used by the network equipment. For the pin assignment information of the MDI-

X interface, see Table 5-9.

Table 5-8 Pin assignment of the MDI interface

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

1 TX+ Transmitting data (+) BIDA+ Bidirectional data wire A

(+)

2 TX- Transmitting data (-) BIDA- Bidirectional data wire A

(-)

3 RX+ Receiving data (+) BIDB+ Bidirectional data wire B

(+)

4 Reserved - BIDC+ Bidirectional data wire C

(+)

5 Reserved - BIDC- Bidirectional data wire C

(-)

6 RX- Receiving data (-) BIDB- Bidirectional data wire B

(-)

7 Reserved - BIDD+ Bidirectional data wire D

(+)

8 Reserved - BIDD- Bidirectional data wire D

(-)

 

Table 5-9 Pin assignment of the MDI-X interface

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

1 RX+ Receiving data (+) BIDB+ Bidirectional data wire B

(+)

2 RX- Receiving data (-) BIDB- Bidirectional data wire B

(-)

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-18 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 183: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 183/496

Pin 10/100BASE-T(X) 1000BASE-T

Signal Function Signal Function

3 TX+ Transmitting data (+) BIDA+ Bidirectional data wire A

(+)

4 Reserved - BIDD+ Bidirectional data wire D

(+)

5 Reserved - BIDD- Bidirectional data wire D

(-)

6 TX- Transmitting data (-) BIDA- Bidirectional data wire A

(-)

7 Reserved - BIDC+ Bidirectional data wire C

(+)

8 Reserved - BIDC- Bidirectional data wire C

(-)

 

Straight through cables are used between MDI and MDI-X interfaces, and crossover cables are

used between MDI interfaces or between MDI-X interfaces. The only difference between the

straight through cable and crossover cable is with regard to the pin assignment.

The NMS/COM interface, NE interface, and Ethernet service electrical interfaces of the OptiX

RTN 950 support the MDI and MDI-X autosensing modes. Straight through cables and crossover 

cables can be used to connect the NMS/COM interface, EXT interface, and Ethernet serviceelectrical interfaces to MDI or MDI-X interfaces.

Cable Diagram

Figure 5-13 Network cable

1

8

1

8

1Label 1 Label 2Main Label

1. Network port connector, RJ-45

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description 5 Cables

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

5-19

Page 184: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 184/496

Pin Assignment

Table 5-10 Pin assignment of the straight through cable

Connector X1 Connector X2 Color RelationX1.1 X2.1 White/Orange Twisted pair  

X1.2 X2.2 Orange

X1.3 X2.3 White/Green Twisted pair  

X1.6 X2.6 Green

X1.4 X2.4 Blue Twisted pair  

X1.5 X2.5 White/Blue

X1.7 X2.7 White/Brown Twisted pair  

X1.8 X2.8 Brown

 

Table 5-11 Pin assignment of the crossover cable

Connector X1 Connector X2 Color Relation

X1.6 X2.2 Orange Twisted pair  

X1.3 X2.1 White/Orange

X1.1 X2.3 White/Green Twisted pair  

X1.2 X2.6 Green

X1.4 X2.4 Blue Twisted pair  

X1.5 X2.5 White/Blue

X1.7 X2.7 White/Brown Twisted pair  

X1.8 X2.8 Brown

 

5 Cables

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

5-20 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 185: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 185/496

A Parameters Description

This topic describes the parameters used in this document.

A.1 Parameters for NE Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing network elements (NEs).

A.2 Parameters for Cable Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing cables.

A.3 Parameters for Communications Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for communications management.

A.4 Radio Link Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio links.

A.5 Multiplex Section Protection ParametersThis topic describes the parameters that are related to multiplex section protection (MSP).

A.6 SDH/PDH Service Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to SDH/PDH services.

A.7 Clock Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to clocks.

A.8 Parameters for Ethernet Services

This topic describes the parameters that are related to Ethernet services.

A.9 Ethernet Protocol Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet protocol.

A.10 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet operation, administration and

maintenance (OAM).

A.11 QoS Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to QoS.

A.12 RMON Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON performances.

A.13 Parameters for the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the orderwire and auxiliary interfaces.

A.14 Parameters for Board Interfaces

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-1

Page 186: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 186/496

This topic describes the parameters that are related to board interfaces.

A.15 Parameters for Overhead

This topic describes the parameters that are related to overhead.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 187: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 187/496

A.1 Parameters for NE Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing network elements (NEs).

A.1.1 Parameter Description: NE Searching

This topic describes the parameters that are used for searching for NEs.

A.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are related to NE creation.

A.1.3 Parameter Description: Object Attribute_Changing NE IDs

This topic describes the parameters that are used for changing NE IDs.

A.1.4 Parameter Description: NE Time Synchronization

This topic describes the parameters that are used for synchronizing the time of NEs.

A.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE Time

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for localization management of the NE

time.

A.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the standard NTP key.

A.1.7 Parameter Description: Automatic Disabling of the Functions of NEs

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for automatically disabling the functions

of an NE.

A.1.1 Parameter Description: NE Searching 

This topic describes the parameters that are used for searching for NEs.

Navigation Path

On the Main Topology, choose File > Discovery > NE.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-3

Page 188: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 188/496

Parameters for the Search Field

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Address Type IP Address of GNE

 NSAP Address

IP Address Range of GNE

IP Address Range of GNE   l If the OSI protocol is

used on the DCN, youcan search for an NE

 based on NSAP

Address only.

l If the IP protocol is

used on the DCN, you

can search for an NE

 based on IP Address of 

GNE or IP Address

Range of GNE.

l To search for all the

 NEs that communicatewith the gateway NE,

select IP Address

Range of GNE.

l To select the gateway

 NE only, select IP

Address of GNE.

NOTEIf Address Type is set to IP

Address of GNE or IP

Address Range of GNE,

and if the U2000 (server)

and the gateway NE arelocated in different network 

segments, ensure that the

U2000 and relevant routers

are configured with the IP

routes for the network 

segment in which the

U2000 and gateway NE are

located.

If Address Type is set to

NSAP Address, ensure that

the OSI protocol stack is

installed.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 189: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 189/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Search Address - -   l If Address Type is set

to IP Address of 

GNE, enter the IP

address of the gateway

 NE, such as 129.9.x.x.

l If Address Type is set

to IP Address Range

of GNE, enter the

number of the IP

network segment in

which the gateway NE

is located, such as

129.9.255.255.

l If Address Type is set

to NSAP Address,

enter the NSAP address

of the gateway NE.

User Name - - This parameter specifies

the user name of the

gateway NE.

Password - - This parameter specifies

the password of the

gateway NE.

 

Parameter for Searching for NEs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Search for NE Selected

Deselected

Selected This parameter specifies

whether to search for all

the NEs in the specified

domain.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-5

Page 190: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 190/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Create NE after search Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l To create NEs in

 batches, it is

recommended that you

select Create NE after

search. The NEs are

automatically created

after they are found.

l After Create NE after

search is selected,

enter NE User and

Password that are used

for creating an NE.

NOTEIf only Create NE after

search is selected, Searchfor NE is selected

automatically.

NE User - -   l This parameter 

specifies the user name

to be entered when an

 NE is created.

l This parameter is valid

only when Create NE

after search is

selected.

Password - -   l This parameter 

specifies the password

to be entered when an

 NE is created.

l This parameter is valid

only when Create NE

after search is

selected.

Upload after create Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l This parameter 

specifies whether to

automatically uploadthe NE data after the

 NE is found and

created.

l If only Upload after

create is selected,

Search for NE and

Create NE after

search are selected

automatically.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 191: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 191/496

Parameter for the Found NEs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE ID - - This parameter indicates

the ID of the found NE,which consists of 

extended ID and NE ID.

For example, in the case of 

 NE9-25, the value 9

indicates the extended ID,

and the value 25 indicates

the NE ID.

GNE Address - - This parameter indicates

the address of the gateway

 NE that is connected to the

found NE.

GNE ID - - This parameter indicates

the ID of the gateway NE

that is connected to the

found NE.

Created As GNE Yes

 No

Yes   l This parameter 

specifies the password

to be entered when an

 NE is created.

l This parameter is valid

only when Create NEafter search is

selected.

Connection Mode Common

Security SSL

Common The communication

 between the client and the

server is encrypted if this

 parameter is set to

Security SSL.

Port - 1400 This parameter specifies

the communication port.

NE Status Created

Uncreated

- This parameter indicateswhether the found NE is

created.

 

A.1.2 Parameter Description: NE Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are related to NE creation.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-7

Page 192: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 192/496

Page 193: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 193/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Gateway Type  Non-Gateway

Gateway

 Non-Gateway   l This parameter is set to

Gateway if the new NE

is a gateway NE.

l This parameter is set to

Non-Gateway if the

new NE is a non-

gateway NE.

l This parameter is set

according to the DCN

 planning if the new NE

can function as a

gateway NE or a non-

gateway NE.

Affiliated Gateway - - This parameter indicatesthe gateway NE of the new

 NE when Gateway Type

is set to Non-Gateway.

Affiliated Gateway

Protocol

IP

OSI

IP   l This parameter needs to

 be set when Gateway

Type is set to

Gateway.

l When the OSI over 

DCC solution is used,

this parameter is set to

OSI.

l In other cases, this

 parameter is set to IP.

IP Address - - This parameter indicates

the IP address of the new

 NE. This parameter needs

to be set when Affiliated

Gateway Protocol is set

to IP.

Connection Mode Common

Security SSL

Common The communication

 between the client and theserver is encrypted if this

 parameter is set to

Security SSL.

Port - 1400 This parameter specifies

the communication port.

NE User - - This parameter specifies

the user name to be

entered when an NE is

created.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-9

Page 194: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 194/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Password - - This parameter specifies

the password to be entered

when an NE is created.

NSAP Address - - This parameter indicates

the NSAP address of the

new NE. This parameter 

needs to be set when

Affiliated Gateway

Protocol is set to OSI.

You need to set the area ID

only, and the other parts

are automatically

generated by the NE.

 

A.1.3 Parameter Description: Object Attribute_Changing NE IDs

This topic describes the parameters that are used for changing NE IDs.

Navigation Path

1. In the Main Topology, right-click the NE whose ID needs to be modified.

2. Choose Object Attributes.

3. Click Modify NE ID.

Parameters for Changing NE IDs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

New ID - -   l The new ID refers to

the basic ID. If the

extended ID is not

used, the basic ID of an

 NE must be unique on

the networks that are

managed by the same

 NMS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

NOTEThe NE ID consisting of the

 basic ID and extended ID

identifies an NE on the

 NMS.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 195: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 195/496

Page 196: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 196/496

Parameters for the Standard NTP Server

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Standard NTP Server

Identifier

 NE ID

IP

 NE ID   l If the NE functions as

the gateway NE, this parameter is set to IP.

l If the NE functions as a

non-gateway NE and

communicates with the

gateway NE through

the HWECC protocol,

this parameter is set to

NE ID.

l If the NE functions as a

non-gateway NE and

communicates with thegateway NE through

the IP protocol, this

 parameter is set to IP.

Standard NTP Server - -   l If the NE functions as

the gateway NE, this

 parameter is set to the

IP address of the

external NTP server.

l If the NE functions as a

non-gateway NE, this

 parameter is set to theID or IP address of the

gateway NE.

Standard NTP Server

Key

0 to 1024 0   l If the NTP server does

not need to

authenticated, this

 parameter is set to the

value "0".

l If the NTP server needs

to be authenticated, the

authentication is

 performed according to

the allocated key of the

 NTP server. In this

case, the NE

authenticates the NTP

server based on the key

and the corresponding

 password (specified in

the management of the

standard NTP key).

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-12 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 197: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 197/496

Parameters for Setting Automatic Synchronization

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Synchronization

Starting Time

- -   l This parameter 

specifies the start timeof the synchronization

 period. After this

 parameter is specified,

the NMS and the NE

synchronize the time

once at the intervals of 

Synchronization

Period(days).

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

DST Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l This parameter 

indicates whether 

Synchronization

Starting Time is the

daylight saving time.

l This parameter is set

according to the actual

situation.

Synchronization Period

(days)

1 to 300 1   l This parameter 

indicates the period of synchronizing the time

of the NE with the time

of the NMS.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

 

A.1.5 Parameter Description: Localization Management of the NE

Time

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for localization management of the NE

time.

Navigation Path

1. On the Main Topology, choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time

Localization Management.

2. Select the NE for time localization management from the Object Tree, and then click 

.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-13

Page 198: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 198/496

Parameters for Localization Management of the NE Time

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE - - This parameter indicates the name of the

 NE.

TimeZone - - This parameter indicates the time zone.

DST - - This parameter indicates whether DST is

enabled.

 

Parameters for Time Zone

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Time Zone - -   l After the time zone is changed, the

current time of the NE is changed

accordingly.

l This parameter is set according to the

 place where the NE is located.

DST Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l The parameters related to daylight saving

time can be valid only when this

 parameter is selected.

l This parameter is set according to the

situation whether daylight saving time is

used in the place where the NE is located.

Offset 1 to 120

Unit: minute(s)

- This parameter specifies the offset value of  

the daylight saving time.

Start Rule DATE

WEEK 

WEEK This parameter specifies the method of  

adjusting the daylight saving time.

Start Time - - This parameter specifies the start daylight

saving time.

End Rule DATE

WEEK 

WEEK This parameter specifies the method of  

adjusting the daylight saving time.

End Time - - This parameter specifies the end daylight

saving time.

 

A.1.6 Parameter Description: Standard NTP Key Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the standard NTP key.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-14 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 199: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 199/496

Navigation Path

1. Choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > NE Time Synchronization from

the Main Menu.

2. Click the Standard NTP Key Management tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE Name - - This parameter indicates

the name of the NE.

NE ID - - This parameter indicates

the ID of the NE.

Key 1 to 1024 -   l This parameter 

indicates the key for  NTP authentication.

l This parameter is set

according to the

requirements of the

external NTP server.

Password - -   l This parameter 

indicates the password

that corresponds to

Key.

l This parameter is set

according to the

requirements of the

external NTP server.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-15

Page 200: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 200/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Trusted Yes

 No

Yes   l When this parameter is

set to No, the key

verification is not

trusted. After receiving

the key, the NE rejects

the clock 

synchronization

service.

l When this parameter is

set to Yes, the key

verification is trusted.

After receiving the key,

the NE provides the

clock synchronization

service.

l After receiving an

unknown or incorrect

key, the NE rejects the

clock synchronization

service. Hence, it is

recommended that you

set a trusted key only.

 

A.1.7 Parameter Description: Automatic Disabling of the Functionsof NEs

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for automatically disabling the functions

of an NE.

Navigation Path

1. On the Main Topology, choose Configuration > NE Batch Configuration > Automatic

Disabling of NE Function.

2. Select the NE whose functions need to be automatically disabled from the Object Tree, and

then click .

Parameters for Automatically Disabling the Functions of NEs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE Name - - This parameter indicates the name of the

 NE.

NE Type OptiX RTN 950 - This parameter indicates the type of the NE.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-16 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 201: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 201/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Operation Type - - This parameter indicates the type of the

operation, such as loopback, and shutdown

of the laser.

Auto Disabling Disabled

Enabled

Enabled This parameter specifies whether to

automatically disable the operations such as

loopback, and shutdown of the laser.

Auto Disabling

Time(min)

1 to 2880 5 This parameter specifies the time of  

automatically disabling the operations such

as loopback, and shutdown of the laser.

 

A.2 Parameters for Cable ManagementThis topic describes the parameters that are used for managing cables.

A.2.1 Parameter Description: Fiber Search

This topic describes the parameters that are used for searching for fibers.

A.2.2 Parameter Description: Fiber Creation

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating fibers.

A.2.3 Parameter Description: Radio Link Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating radio links.

A.2.1 Parameter Description: Fiber Search

This topic describes the parameters that are used for searching for fibers.

Navigation Path

1. Choose File > Discovery > Fiber from the Main Menu.

2. Select the board of the NE on which the fiber needs to be searched for or the IF board of 

the NE on which radio links need to be searched for from the Subject Tree, and the click 

.

3. Click Search.

Parameters for Searching For Fibers

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source NE - - This parameter indicates

the name of the source NE

on which fibers or radio

links are found.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-17

Page 202: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 202/496

Page 203: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 203/496

 

A.2.2 Parameter Description: Fiber Creation

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating fibers.

Navigation Path

1. Choose File > Create > Link  from the Main Menu. The Add Object dialog box is

displayed.

2. Choose Link  > Fiber from the Object Tree.

Parameters for Fibers

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Create Ways Common Ways

Batch Ways

Common Ways   l If Common Ways is

selected, fibers need to

created one by one.

l If Batch Ways is

selected, fibers can be

created in batches.

Fiber/Cable Type Fiber Fiber This parameter indicates

that Fiber/Cable Type to

 be created is a fiber.

Name - - This parameter specifiesthe name of the fiber to be

created. The name

consists of up to 255

characters, excluding

certain special marks such

as | * ? " < >.

Remarks - - This parameter specifies

the remark information

customized by the user.

Source NE - - This parameter specifiesthe source NE on which

the fiber needs to be

created.

Source NE Slot-Board

Type-Port

- - This parameter specifies

the board, slot, and port of 

the source NE on which

the fiber needs to be

created.

Rate Level - - This parameter indicates

the level that corresponds

to the port on the board.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-19

Page 204: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 204/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Medium Type G.652

G.653

G.654

G.655

G.652 This parameter specifies

the medium type of the

fiber.

Sink NE - - This parameter specifies

the sink NE on which the

fiber needs to be created.

Sink NE Slot-Board

Type-Port

- - This parameter specifies

the board, slot, and port of 

the sink NE on which the

fiber needs to be created.

Direction Two-Fiber BidirectionalSingle-Fiber 

Unidirectional

- This parameter specifiesthe direction of the fiber to

 be created.

Length(km) - - This parameter specifies

the length of the fiber to be

created.

Attenuation(dB) - - This parameter specifies

the attenuation of the fiber 

to be created.

Created On - - This parameter specifies

the time when the fiber is

created.

Creator - - This parameter specifies

the name of the person

who creates the fiber.

Maintainer - - This parameter specifies

the name of the person

who maintains the fiber.

 

A.2.3 Parameter Description: Radio Link Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating radio links.

Navigation Path

1. Choose File > Create > Link  from the Main Menu. The Add Object dialog box is

displayed.

2. Choose Link  > Microwave Link  from the Object Tree.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-20 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 205: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 205/496

Parameters for Microwave Links

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Fiber/Cable Type Radio Link Radio Link This parameter indicates

that a radio link needs to be created is Fiber/Cable

Type.

Name - - This parameter specifies

the name of the radio link 

to be created. The name

consists of up to 255

characters, excluding

certain special marks such

as | * ? " < >.

Remarks - - This parameter specifiesthe remark information

customized by the user.

Source NE - - The parameter specifies

the source NE on which

the radio link needs to be

created.

Source NE Slot-Board

Type-Port

- - This parameter specifies

the board, slot, and port of 

the source NE on which

the radio link needs to be

created.

Rate Level - - This parameter indicates

the level that corresponds

to the port on the IF board.

Sink NE - - The parameter specifies

the sink NE on which the

radio link needs to be

created.

Sink NE Slot-Board

Type-Port

- - This parameter specifies

the board, slot, and port of 

the sink NE on which the

radio link needs to be

created.

Length(km) - - This parameter specifies

the length of the radio link 

to be created.

Created On - - This parameter indicates

the time when the radio

link is created.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-21

Page 206: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 206/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Creator - - This parameter specifies

the name of the person

who creates the radio link.

Maintainer - - This parameter specifies

the name of the person

who maintains the radio

link.

 

A.3 Parameters for Communications Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for communications management.

A.3.1 Parameter Description: NE Communication Parameter Setting

This topic describes the parameters that are used for NE communication setting.

A.3.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Rate Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the DCC rate.

A.3.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC Transparent Transmission Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for DCC transparent transmission management.

A.3.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet Port Extended ECC

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the extended ECCs of Ethernet ports.

A.3.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link ManagementThis topic describes the parameters that are used for NE ECC link management.

A.3.6 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for IP route management.

A.3.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IP Route Management Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for new static IP routes.

A.3.8 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_OSPF Parameter Settings

This topic describes the parameters that are used for OSPF settings.

A.3.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARP

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the proxy ARP.

A.3.10 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network Layer Parameter 

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the network layer of the OSI protocol

model.

A.3.11 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Routing Table

This topic describes the parameters that are related to OSI routing tables.

A.3.12 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the OSI tunnels.

A.3.13 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Bandwidth Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for bandwidth management of the inband DCN.

A.3.14 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Port Setting

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-22 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 207: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 207/496

Page 208: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 208/496

A.3.2 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC RateConfiguration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the DCC rate.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC

Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the DCC Rate Configuration tab.

Parameters for DCC Rate Configuration

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the port that is

connected to the DCC channel.

NOTEOn the NMS interface, the first interface on the

system control, switching, and clock board (like

7-CSH-1) corresponds to its external clock 

interface.

Enabled/Disabled Enabled

Disabled

Enabled (for line

 ports)

Disabled (for 

external clock 

interfaces)

It is recommended that you use the default

value, except for the following cases:

l If the port is connected to the other ECC

subnet, Enabled/Disabled is set to

Disabled.

l If the port is connected to a third-party

network and does not exchange the

network management information with

other ports, Enabled/Disabled is set to

Disabled.

l If external clock interfaces are used to

transparently transmit the DCC solution,

Enabled/Disabled is set to Enabled for 

the external clock interfaces.

Channel Type D1-D3D4-D12

D1-D12

D1-D1

D1-D1 (for the PDHradio whose

transmission

capacity is less than

16xE1)

D1-D3 (for other 

cases)

It is recommended that you use the defaultvalue, except for the following cases:

l If the IP over DCC or OSI over DCC

solution is adopted, Channel Type for 

the SDH line ports is set to a value that is

the same as the value for third-party

network.

l If the DCC transparent transmission

solution is adopted, the value of Channel

Type for the SDH line ports should not

conflict with the value that is set for the

third-party network.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-24 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 209: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 209/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

DCC Resources - - This parameter indicates the DCC

resources.

CommunicationStatus

- - This parameter indicates thecommunication status.

Protocol Type HWECC

TCP/IP

OSI

HWECC It is recommended that you use the default

value, except for the following cases:

l If the IP over DCC solution is adopted,

Protocol Type is set to TCP/IP.

l If the OSI over DCC solution is adopted,

Protocol Type is set to OSI.

LAPD Role User 

 Network 

User    l This parameter is valid only when

Protocol Type is set to OSI.

l In the case of a DCC channel, LAPD

Role must be set to User for one end and

must be set to Network  for the other end.

 

A.3.3 Parameter Description: DCC Management_DCC TransparentTransmission Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for DCC transparent transmission management.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCC

Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the DCC Transparent Transmission Management tab.

Parameters for DCC Transparent Transmission Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source Timeslot/

Porta

- - This parameter indicates the source timeslot

or port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-25

Page 210: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 210/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Transparent

Transmission of 

Overhead Bytes at

Source Port

D1

D2

D3

D4

D5

D6

D7

D8

D9

D10

D11

D12

E1

E2

F1

K1

K2

X1

X2

X3

X4

-   l Only one overhead byte can be selected

each time.

l X1, X2, X3, and X4 indicate thecustomized overhead bytes that are used

for transmitting asynchronous data

services.

l An overhead byte cannot be a byte that is

used. For example, an overhead byte

cannot be a byte in the used DCC channel.

Sink Timeslot/

Porta

- - This parameter indicates the sink timeslot or  

 port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-26 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 211: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 211/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Transparent

Transmission of 

Overhead Bytes at

Sink Port

D1

D2

D3

D4

D5

D6

D7

D8

D9

D10

D11

D12

E1

E2

F1

K1

K2

X1

X2

X3

X4

-   l Only one overhead byte can be selected

each time.

l An overhead byte cannot be a byte that isused. For example, an overhead byte

cannot be a byte in the used DCC channel.

l Generally, Transparent Transmission

of Overhead Bytes at Sink Port can be

set to a value that is the same as or 

different from the value in the case of 

Source Timeslot/Port.

 

NOTE

a. A bidirectional cross-connection is set up between the source port and the sink port. Hence, a port functions

the same regardless of the source port or sink port.

A.3.4 Parameter Description: ECC Management_Ethernet PortExtended ECC

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the extended ECCs of Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path

Click an NE in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > ECC Management from the

Function Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-27

Page 212: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 212/496

Parameters for the ECC Extended Mode

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ECC Extended

Mode

Automatically

Assign

Specified mode

Automatically

Assign

It is recommended that you use the default

value.

 

Parameters for Setting the Server

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

IP - 0.0.0.0 This parameter indicates the IP address of  

the server.

Port 1601 to 1699 1601   l This parameter is valid only when ECCExtended Mode is set to Specified

mode.

l This parameter can be set only when the

 NE functions as the server of the

extended ECC. In normal cases, the NE

that is close to the U2000 functions as the

server.

l This parameter can be set to any value

from 1601 to 1699.

 

Parameters for Setting the Client

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Opposite IP - 0.0.0.0   l This parameter is valid only when ECC

Extended Mode is set to Specified

mode.

l This parameter can be set only when the

 NE functions as the client of the extended

ECC. Except for the NE that functions as

the server, all other NEs that use theextended ECC can function as the client.

l Opposite IP and Port are respectively set

to the IP address of the server NE and the

specified pot number.

Port 1601 to 1699 1601

 

A.3.5 Parameter Description: NE ECC Link Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for NE ECC link management.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-28 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 213: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 213/496

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > NE ECC

Link Management from the Function Tree.

Parameter for NE ECC Link Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Destination NE - - This parameter specifies the sink NE of the

ECC connection.

Transfer NE - - This parameter specifies the next transfer  

 NE and the direction of the ECC route.

Distance 0 to 64 0   l This parameter specifies the number of 

 NEs (excluding the source NE and sink 

 NE) through which the ECC route passes,namely, the number of ECC packet

forwarding attempts. The value can be set

to a value that is greater than the number 

of actual ECC packet forwarding

attempts. If the value is set to a value that

is less than the number of actual ECC

 packet forwarding attempts, however, the

destination NE fails to be accessed.

l If the value is set to 0, it indicates that the

source NE is adjacent to the destination

 NE.

Level 4

5

-   l This parameter indicates that multiple

ECC routes from the source NE to the

destination NE may be available. An

ECC route of a higher priority is selected

to transmit the packets to the destination

 NE.

l If the ECC route is generated

automatically, the priority is 4.

l If the ECC route is added manually, the

 priority is 5.

Mode Manual

Automatic

- This parameter indicates the ECC routing

mode.

SCC No. - - This parameter specifies the physical port

through which the ECC route passes. The

value of this parameter is automatically

assigned the NE.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-29

Page 214: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 214/496

A.3.6 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IPRoute Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for IP route management.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP

Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the IP Route Management tab.

Parameters for IP Route Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Destination

Address

- - This parameter specifies the destination

address of the packets. This parameter can

 be set to a valid IP address of class A, B, or 

C only, but cannot be set to the IP address

of the local host or the loopback address

with the 127 field.

Mask  - - This parameter indicates the subnet mask of  

the destination address of the packets.

Gateway IP - - This parameter specifies the IP address of  

the gateway on the subnetwork where the

 NE is located, namely, the IP address of thenext hop of the packets.

Protocol DIRECT

STATIC

OSPF

RIP

OSPF_ASE

OSPF_NSSA

-   l DIRECT: indicates the route between

the local NE and an adjacent NE.

l STATIC: indicates the route that is

created manually.

l OSPF: indicates the route between the

local NE and a non-adjacent NE.

l RIP: indicates the route that is discovered

 by the routing information protocol.

l OSPF_ASE: indicates the route whoseDestination Address is beyond the

OSPF domain.

l OSPF_NSSA: indicates the route whose

Destination Address is in a not so stubby

area (NSSA).

l A route can be deleted in the case of 

STATIC only, but cannot be edited in the

other cases.

l Compared with a dynamic route, a static

route has a higher priority. If any conflict

occurs, the static route is preferred.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-30 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 215: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 215/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Interface - - This parameter indicates the interface that is

used on the route. Interface is a concept

specified in the TCP/IP protocol stack. In

the TCP/IP protocol stack, you can create

multiple types of interface, such as a

loopback interface (namely, the interface

whose IP address is 127.0.0.1), an Ethernet

interface, and PPP interface. Each interface

must have a unique interface name.

Hop Count 0 to 65535 - This parameter indicates the maximum

number of routers through which the

 packets are transmitted. Hop Count is used

to indicate the overhead bytes that are

transmitted to the destination address. The

smaller the value, the less the overhead

 bytes. If multiple routes can reach the same

destination address, a route whose overhead

is less is preferred to transmit the packets.

Working Status Working

Unworking

- This parameter indicates whether the

current IP route is available.

 

A.3.7 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack Management_IPRoute Management Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for new static IP routes.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP

Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the IP Route Management tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters for Creating IP Routes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Destination

Address

- - This parameter specifies the destination

address of the packets. This parameter can

 be set to a valid IP address of class A, B, or 

C only, but cannot be set to the IP address

of the local host or the loopback address

with the 127 field.

Subnet Mask  - - This parameter indicates the subnet mask of  

the destination address of the packets.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-31

Page 216: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 216/496

Page 217: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 217/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

DCC Neighbor

Dead Time(s)

1 to 65535 6   l DCC Neighbor Dead Time(s) specifies

the dead time of a neighbor router at the

DCC interface.

l If the local router fails to receive the hello

 packets from the connected neighbor 

router within the time specified in DCC

Neighbor Dead Time(s), it considers

that the neighbor router is unavailable.

l DCC Neighbor Dead Time(s) should be

set to a value that is a minimum of twice

the value of DCC Hello Timer(s).

l In the case of adjacent NEs, DCC

Neighbor Dead Time(s) must be set to

the same value. Otherwise, the OSPF protocol fails to operate normally.

DCC

Retransmission

Timer(s)

1 to 65535 5 DCC Retransmission Timer(s) specifies

the interval for transmitting a request

through the DCC interface to retransmit the

link state advertisement (LSA) packets.

DCC Delay(s) 1 to 3600 1   l DCC Delay(s) specifies the delay time to

transmit the LSA packets through the

DCC interface.

l The LSA packets in the LSA database of 

the local router are aged as the timeelapses, but are not aged when they are

 being transmitted on the network. Hence,

 before the LSA packets are transmitted,

you need to increase the age of the LSA

 packets based on the value of DCC Delay

(s).

LAN Hello Timer

(s)

1 to 255 -   l DCC Hello Timer(s) specifies the hello

 packet timer at the LAN interfaces.

l The hello packets are used for detecting

the neighbor router on the network that is

connected to the router. By periodicallytransmitting the hello packets, you can

determine whether the interface on the

neighbor router is still in the active status.

l LAN Hello Timer(s) determines the

interval for the hello packet timer of the

 NE to transmit the hello packets.

l In the case of two interconnected NEs,

LAN Hello Timer(s) must be set to the

same value.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-33

Page 218: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 218/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

LAN Neighbor

Dead Time(s)

1 to 65535 -   l LAN Neighbor Dead Time(s) specifies

the dead time of a neighbor router at the

LAN interface.

l If the local router fails to receive the hello

 packets from the connected neighbor 

router within the time specified in LAN

Neighbor Dead Time(s), it considers

that the neighbor router is unavailable.

l LAN Neighbor Dead Time(s) should be

set to a value that is a minimum of two

times the value of LAN Neighbor Dead

Time(s).

l In the case of adjacent NEs, DCC

Neighbor Dead Time(s) must be set tothe same value. Otherwise, the OSPF

 protocol fails to operate normally.

LAN

Retransmission

Timer(s)

1 to 65535 5 LAN Retransmission Timer(s) specifies

the time for transmitting a request for 

retransmission of the LSA packets through

the LAN interface.

LAN Delay(s) 1 to 3600 1   l LAN Delay(s) specifies the delay time to

transmit the LSA packets through the

LAN interface.

l

The LSA packets in the LSA database of the local router are aged as the time

elapses, but are not aged when they are

 being transmitted on the network. Hence,

 before the LSA packets are transmitted,

you need to increase the age of the LSA

 packets based on the value of LAN Delay

(s).

 

A.3.9 Parameter Description: IP Protocol Stack_Proxy ARPThis topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the proxy ARP.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > IP

Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Proxy ARP tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-34 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 219: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 219/496

Parameters for configuring the proxy ARP

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Proxy ARP Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l The proxy ARP enables the NEs in the

same network segment but differentdomains to communicate with each other.

l To realize communication between such

 NEs, the source NE sends the ARP

 broadcast packet to address the route to

the destination NE. The NE with the

 proxy ARP function enabled checks the

routing table after sensing the ARP

 broadcast packet. If the routing table

contains the destination address that the

ARP broadcast packet looks for, the NE

returns a ARP spoofing packet, whichenables the NE that sends the ARP

 broadcast packet to consider that the

MAC address of the NE that returns the

ARP spoofing packet is the MAC address

of the destination NE. In this manner, the

 packet that is to be sent to the destination

 NE is first sent to the NE with the proxy

ARP function enabled and then

forwarded to the destination NE.

 

A.3.10 Parameter Description: OSI Management_Network LayerParameter

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the network layer of the OSI protocol

model.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI

Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Network Layer Parameters tab.

Network Layer Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE - - This parameter indicates the name of the

 NE.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-35

Page 220: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 220/496

Page 221: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 221/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Adjacency State - - This parameter indicates the state of the

adjacency.

Peer End Area ID - - This parameter indicates the area ID that iscontained in the NSAP address of the

opposite NE.

Peer End System

ID

- - This parameter indicates the system ID of  

the opposite NE. Generally, the system ID

is the MAC address.

Destination Area

ID

- - This parameter indicates the area ID of the

destination NE.

Destination SYSID - - This parameter indicates the system ID of  

the destination NE. Generally, the system

ID is the MAC address.

Metric - - ++This parameter indicates the number of  

hops that reach the destination NE or 

destination area.

Adjacency No.1 - - This parameter indicates the number of the

adjacent link that is connected to the

destination NE.

Adjacency No.2 - - This parameter indicates the number of the

adjacent link that is connected to the

destination NE.

 

A.3.12 Parameter Description: OSI Management_OSI Tunnel

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the OSI tunnels.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > OSI

Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the OSI Tunnel tab.

Parameters for OSI Tunnel Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Remote IP Address - - This parameter indicates the IP address of  

the opposite end of the OSI tunnel.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-37

Page 222: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 222/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

LAPD Actor User 

 Network 

User    l This parameter specifies the LAPD actor.

l If the adjacent NEs run the OSI protocol,

they can perform the LAPD negotiationonly when the LAPD actor is set to

User at one end and is set to Network  at

the other end.

Efficient LAPD

Enable

- - This parameter indicates whether the

current LAPD is enabled.

Configurable

LAPD Enable

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled This parameter specifies whether the LAPD

is enabled.

 

LAPD Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Remote IP Address - - This parameter indicates the IP address of  

the opposite end of the OSI tunnel.

L2 Wait Time to

Retry(s)

1 to 20 1   l This parameter specifies L2 Wait Time

to Retry(s).

l L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) indicates the

interval for retransmitting packets at the

LAPD link layer.l L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) needs to be

set according to the network situation. If 

the network is in good situation, L2 Wait

Time to Retry(s) can be set to a smaller 

value. Otherwise, it is recommended that

you set L2 Wait Time to Retry(s) to a

greater value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use the

default value.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-38 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 223: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 223/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

L2 Retry Times 2 to 6 3   l This parameter specifies L2 Retry

Times.

l L2 Retry Times indicates the maximumnumber of packet retransmission

attempts at the LAPD link layer.

l L2 Retry Times needs to be set

according to the network situation. If the

network is in good situation, L2 Retry

Times can be set to a smaller value.

Otherwise, it is recommended that you

set L2 Retry Times to a greater value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use thedefault value.

L3 Hello Timer(s) 1 to 100 3   l This parameter specifies L3 Hello Timer

(s).

l L3 Hello Timer(s) indicates the Hello

 packet timer at the LAPD link network 

layer. It is used for periodical

transmission of the Hello packets.

l The Hello timer determines the interval

for transmitting the Hello packets once.

L3 Hello Timer(s) needs to be set

according to the network situation. If thenetwork is in good situation, L3 Hello

Timer(s) can be set to a greater value.

Otherwise, it is recommended that you

set L3 Hello Timer(s) to a smaller value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use the

default value.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-39

Page 224: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 224/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

L3 ES Timer(s) 1 to 200 50   l This parameter specifies L3 ES Timer

(s).

l L3 ES Timer(s) indicates the ESconfiguration timer at the LAPD link 

network layer. It is used for setting the

time to transmit the configuration

information on the ES route.

l L3 ES Timer(s) needs to be set according

to the network situation. If the network is

in good situation, L3 ES Timer(s) can be

set to a greater value. Otherwise, it is

recommended that you set L3 Hello

Timer(s) to a smaller value.

l

This parameter needs to be set accordingto the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use the

default value.

L3 IS Timer(s) 1 to 200 10   l This parameter specifies L3 IS Timer

(s).

l L3 IS Timer(s) indicates the IS

configuration timer at the LAPD link 

network layer. It is used for setting the

time to transmit the configuration

information through the L1/L2 router.

l L3 IS Timer(s) needs to be set accordingto the network situation. If the network is

in good situation, L3 IS Timer(s) can be

set to a greater value. Otherwise, it is

recommended that you set L3 IS Timer

(s) to a smaller value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use the

default value.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-40 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 225: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 225/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

L3 Hold Timer(s) 2 to 63 5   l This parameter specifies L3 Hold Timer

(s).

l L3 Hold Timer(s) indicates the holdtimer at the LAPD link network layer.

l L3 Hold Timer(s) needs to be set

according to the network situation. If the

network is in good situation, L3 Hold

Timer(s) can be set to a smaller value.

Otherwise, it is recommended that you

set L3 IS Timer(s) to a greater value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. In normal

cases, it is recommended that you use the

default value.

COST 1 to 63 20   l This parameter specifies COST.

l COST indicates the overhead value of 

the virtual LAPD that corresponds to the

OSI tunnel.

l The overhead value determines whether 

this link is perverted. If the overhead

value is smaller, this link has a higher 

 priority to be selected.

l This parameter needs to set according to

the planning information. 

A.3.13 Parameter Description: DCN Management_BandwidthManagement

This topic describes the parameters that are used for bandwidth management of the inband DCN.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > DCNManagement from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Bandwidth Management tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-41

Page 226: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 226/496

Page 227: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 227/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable Status Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter specifies whether the FE

or GE port is enabled.

l The inband DCN can transmit thenetwork management information over 

the link only after the inband DCN

function is enabled at the FE or GE ports

at both ends of a link.

 

Parameters for Setting IF Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Name - - This parameter indicates the name of the IF port.

Enable Status Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter specifies whether the IF

 port is enabled.

l The inband DCN can transmit the

network management information over 

the link only after the IF ports at both ends

of a link are enabled on the inband DCN.

 

A.3.15 Parameter Description: DCN Management_Protocol Setting 

This topic describes the parameters that are used for setting a protocol of the inband DCN.

Navigation Path

1. In the NE Explorer, select the required NE from the Object Tree, and then choose

Communication > DCN Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Protocol Settings tab.

Parameters for Setting a Protocol

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - Displays the port name.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-43

Page 228: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 228/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protocol Type IP

HWECC

IP   l If the values of ProtocolType are

different from each other, the equipment

at both ends cannot be interconnected

with each other. Therefore, Protocol

Type must be set to the same value for 

the equipment at both ends of a link.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information. Generally, it

is recommended that you set this

 parameter to IP.

 

A.3.16 Parameter Description: Access ControlThis topic describes the parameters that are used for access control of the NMS.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Communication > Access

Control from the Function Tree.

Parameters for Ethernet Access Control

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

The First Network 

Port

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled After The First Network Port is set to

Enabled for Ethernet access, the NE can

access the NMS through the Ethernet port.

 

Parameters for Access Control over Serial Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable Serial Port

Access

Selected

Deselected

Selected After Enable Serial Port Access is

selected, the NE can access the NMS or 

command lines through the serial port.

Access Command

Line

Selected

Deselected

Deselected If Access Command Line is selected, the

serial interface can be used to access the

command line terminal.

Access NM Selected

Deselected

Selected If Access NM is selected, the serial interface

can be used to access the NMS.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-44 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 229: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 229/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Baud Rate 1200

2400

4800

9600

19200

38400

57600

115200

9600   l This parameter specifies the data

transmission rate in the communications

through serial ports.

l This parameter is set according to the rate

of the serial port at the opposite end, and

the rates at both ends must be the same.

 

A.3.17 Parameter Description: LCT Access ControlThis topic describes the parameters that are used for LCT access control.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Security > LCT Access

Control from the Function Tree.

Parameters for LCT Access Control

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE - - This parameter indicates the name of the

 NE.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-45

Page 230: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 230/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

LCT Access

Control Switch

Access Allowed

Disable Access

Access Allowed   l  No NMS user logs in to the NE. In this

case, when the LCT requests an LCT user 

to log in to the NE, the NE does not check 

the status of LCT Access Control

Switch, and directly allows the LCT user 

to log in to the NE.

l An NMS user first logs in to the NE. In

this case, when the LCT requests an LCT

user to log in to the NE, the NE

determines whether to allow the LCT

user to log in to the NE through the LCT

according to the status of LCT Access

Control Switch.

l An LCT user first logs in to the NE. In

this case, when the NMS requests an

 NMS user to log in to the NE, the NMS

user can directly log in to the NE. After 

the NMS user successfully logs in to the

 NE, the online LCT user is not affected.

l When both the LCT user and NMS user 

log in to the NE, the online LCT user is

not affected after LCT Access Control

Switch is set to Disable Access.

 

A.4 Radio Link Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio links.

A.4.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC Workgroup_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.

A.4.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.

A.4.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF N+1 protection group.A.4.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF N+1 protection.

A.4.5 Parameter: IF 1+1 Protection_Create

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF 1+1 protection group.

A.4.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF 1+1 protection.

A.4.7 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the IF/ODU.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-46 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 231: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 231/496

A.4.1 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC Workgroup_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link 

Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the XPIC tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

IF Channel

Bandwidth

28M

56M

-   l This parameter specifies the working

 bandwidth of the radio link.

l When this parameter is set to 56M, the

high-power ODU must be used.

Polarization

direction-V

- -   l This parameter indicates the polarization

direction of a radio link.

l It is recommended that you install the two

IFX2 boards that form an XPIC

workgroup in the slots that are at the same

layer or in the same column, and set the

IF port on the IFX2 board that has asmaller slot number to Link ID-V and the

IF port on the other IFX2 board to Link 

ID-H.

Polarization

direction-H

Link ID-V 1 to 4094 1   l Set Link ID-V and Link ID-H.

l A link ID is an identifier of a radio link 

and is used to prevent the radio links

 between sites from being wrongly

connected.

l When the link ID received by an NE is

different from the link ID set for the NE,the NE reports an MW_LIM alarm and

inserts the AIS.

l These two parameters are set according

to the planning information. These two

 parameters must be set to different

values, but Link ID-V must be set to the

same value at both ends of a link and Link 

ID-H must also be set to the same value

at both ends of a link.

Link ID-H 2

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-47

Page 232: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 232/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the transmit

 power of an ODU. The value of this

 parameter must not exceed the rated

 power range supported by the ODU.

l The transmit power of the ODU must be

set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

l Consider the receive power of the ODU

at the opposite end when you set this

 parameter. Ensure that the receive power 

of the ODU at the opposite end can ensure

stable radio services.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Maximum

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the maximum

transmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power rang of the

ODU in the guaranteed capacity

modulation module..

l This parameter is set to limit the

maximum transmit power of the ODU

within this preset range.

l The maximum transmit power adjusted

 by using the ATPC function should notexceed this value.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Transmission

Frequency(MHz)

- -   l This parameter indicates the channel

central frequency.

l The value of this parameter must not be

less than the sum of the lower transmit

frequency limit supported by the ODU

and a half of the channel spacing, and

must not be more than the difference between the upper transmit frequency

limit supported by the ODU and a half of 

the channel spacing.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-48 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 233: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 233/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

T/R Spacing(MHz) - -   l This parameter specifies the spacing

 between the transmit frequency and the

receive frequency of an ODU to prevent

mutual interference between the

transmitter and the receiver.

l If Station Type of the ODU is TX high,

the transmit frequency is one T/R spacing

higher than the receive frequency. If 

Station Type of the ODU is TX low, the

transmit frequency is one T/R spacing

lower than the receive frequency.

l If the ODU supports only one T/R 

spacing, set this parameter to 0,

indicating that the T/R spacing supported

 by the ODU is used.

l A valid T/R spacing value is determined

 by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing

should be set according to the technical

specifications of the ODU.

l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be

set to the same value at both the ends of 

a radio link.

Transmission

Status

unmute

mute

unmute   l When this parameter is set to mute, the

ODU does not transmit microwave

signals but can normally receivemicrowave signals.

l When this parameter is set to unmute, the

ODU normally transmits and receives

microwave signals.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

unmute.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-49

Page 234: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 234/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Enabled Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC function is enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabledand if the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB

higher or lower than the central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold at the receive

end, the receiver notifies the transmitter 

to decrease or increase the transmit power 

until the RSL is within the range that is 2

dB higher or lower than the central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold.

l The settings of the ATPC attributes must

 be consistent at both ends of a radio link.

l In the case of areas where fast fading

severely affects the radio transmission, it

is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Disabled.

l During the commissioning process, set

this parameter to Disabled to ensure that

the transmit power is not changed. After 

the commissioning, re-set the ATPC

attributes.

ATPC UpperThreshold(dBm)

-75.0 to -20.0 -45.0   l The central value between the ATPCupper threshold and the ATPC lower 

threshold is set as the expected receive

 power.

l It is recommended that you set ATPC

Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of 

the planned central value between the

ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC

lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC

Lower Threshold(dBm) to the

difference between the planned central

value between the ATPC upper threshold

and the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB.

l You can set the ATPC upper threshold

only when ATPC Automatic Threshold

Enable Status is set to Disabled.

ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm)

-35.0 to -90.0 -70.0

ATPC Automatic

Threshold Enable

Status

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

automatic threshold function is enabled.

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the

equipment automatically uses the preset

ATPC upper and lower thresholds

according to the work mode of the radio

link.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-50 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 235: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 235/496

 

A.4.2 Parameter Description: Link Configuration_XPIC

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the XPIC function.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Link 

Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the XPIC tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Group ID - - This parameter indicates the ID of the work  

group.

Polarization

direction-V

- - This parameter indicates the IF port to which

the polarization direction V corresponds.

Link ID-V - - This parameter indicates the link ID to

which the polarization direction V

corresponds.

Polarization

direction-H

- - This parameter indicates the IF port to which

the polarization direction H corresponds.

Link ID-H - - This parameter indicates the link ID to

which the polarization direction H

corresponds.

IF Channel

Bandwidth

28M

56M

-   l IF Channel Bandwidth refers to the

channel spacing of the corresponding

radio links.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-51

Page 236: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 236/496

Page 237: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 237/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maximum

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the maximum

transmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power rang of the

ODU in the guaranteed capacity

modulation module..

l This parameter is set to limit the

maximum transmit power of the ODU

within this preset range.

l The maximum transmit power adjusted

 by using the ATPC function should not

exceed this value.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power range of the

ODU.

l The transmit power of the ODU should

 be set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

l Consider the receive power of the ODU

at the opposite end when you set this

 parameter. Ensure that the receive power of the ODU at the opposite end can ensure

stable radio services.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Transmission

Frequency(MHz)

- -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,

the channel central frequency.

l The value of this parameter must not be

less than the sum of the lower TX

frequency limit supported by the ODUand a half of the channel spacing, and

must not be more than the difference

 between the upper TX frequency limit

supported by the ODU and a half of the

channel spacing.

l The difference between the transmit

frequencies of both the ends of a radio

link should be one T/R spacing.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-53

Page 238: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 238/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

T/R Spacing(MHz) - -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

spacing between the transmit frequency

and receive frequency of the ODU to

 prevent mutual interference between the

transmitter and receiver.

l If the ODU is a Tx high station, the

transmit frequency is one T/R spacing

higher than the receive frequency. If the

ODU is a Tx low station, the transmit

frequency is one T/R spacing lower than

the receive frequency.

l If the ODU supports only one T/R 

spacing, this parameter is set to 0,

indicating that the T/R spacing supported

 by the ODU is used.

l A valid T/R spacing value is determined

 by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing

should be set according to the technical

specifications of the ODU.

l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be

set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

Transmission

Status

unmute

mute

unmute   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit status of the ODU.

l If this parameter is set to mute, thetransmitter of the ODU does not work but

can normally receive microwave signals.

l If this parameter is set to unmute, the

ODU can normally transmit and receive

microwave signals.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

unmute.

 

Parameters for Hybrid/AM Configuration

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Group ID - - This parameter indicates the ID of the work  

group.

Polarization

direction

- - This parameter indicates the IF port to which

the polarization direction H or the

 polarization direction V corresponds.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-54 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 239: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 239/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

AM Enable Status Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l When this parameter is set to Disabled,

the radio link uses only the specified

modulation scheme. In this case, you

need to select Manually Specified

Modulation Mode.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the radio link uses the corresponding

modulation scheme according to the

channel conditions.

Hence, the Hybrid radio can ensure the

reliable transmission of the E1 services and

 provide bandwidth adaptively for the

Ethernet services when the AM function is

enabled.

Modulation Mode

of the Guaranteed

AM Capacity

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

- This parameter specifies the highest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according to

the planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

 bandwidth of the services that need to be

transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the

availability of the radio link that

corresponds to this modulation scheme.

NOTEModulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity

must be higher than Modulation Mode of the

Guaranteed AM Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Enabled.

Modulation Mode

of the Full AM

Capacity

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

- This parameter specifies the highest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according to

the planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

 bandwidth of the services that need to be

transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the

availability of the radio link thatcorresponds to this modulation scheme.

NOTEModulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity

must be higher than Modulation Mode of the

Guaranteed AM Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Enabled.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-55

Page 240: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 240/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Manually Specified

Modulation Mode

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

QPSK This parameter specifies the modulation

scheme that the radio link uses for signal

transmission.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Disabled.

Guaranteed E1

Capacity

- -   l When AM Enable Status is set to

Enabled, this parameter depends on IF

Channel Bandwidth and Modulation

Mode of the Guaranteed AM

Capacity and cannot be set.

l When AM Enable Status is set to

Disabled, this parameter depends on IF

Channel Bandwidth and Manually

Specified Modulation Mode and cannot

 be set.

E1 Capacity 1 to 75 - This parameter specifies the number of E1

services that can be transmitted in Hybrid

work mode. The value of this parameter 

cannot exceed the Guaranteed E1

Capacity.

The E1 Capacity must be set to the same

value at both ends of a radio link.

 

Parameters for ATPC Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Group ID - - This parameter indicates the object to be set.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-56 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 241: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 241/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Enable

Status

Disabled

Enabled

Enabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC function is enabled.

l If this parameter is set to Enabled and if the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB higher 

or lower than the central value between

the ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC

lower threshold at the receive end, the

receiver notifies the transmitter to

decrease or increase the transmit power 

until the RSL is within the range that is 2

dB higher or lower than the central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold.

l The settings of the ATPC attributes must

 be consistent at both ends of a radio link.

l In the case of areas where fast fading

severely affects the radio transmission, it

is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Disabled.

l During the commissioning process, set

this parameter to Disabled to ensure that

the transmit power is not changed. After 

the commissioning, re-set the ATPC

attributes.

ATPC UpperThreshold(dBm)

-75.0 to -20.0 -45.0   l Set the central value between the ATPCupper threshold and the ATPC lower 

threshold to a value for the expected

receive power.

l It is recommended that you set ATPC

Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of 

the planned central value between the

ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC

lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC

Lower Threshold(dBm) o the difference

 between the planned central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB.

l You can set this parameter only when

ATPC Automatic Threshold Enable

Status is set to Disabled.

ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm)

-35.0 to -90.0 -70.0

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-57

Page 242: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 242/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Automatic

Threshold Enable

Status

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC automatic threshold function is

enabled.

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the

equipment automatically uses the preset

ATPC upper and lower thresholds

according to the work mode of the radio

link.

l If this parameter is set to Disabled, you

need to manually set ATPC Upper

Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm).

 

A.4.3 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection_Create

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF N+1 protection group.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1

Protection from the Function Tree.

2. Click Create.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

WTR time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter specifies the wait-to-

restore (WTR) time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

set WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l It is recommended that you use thedefault value.

Enabled Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter specifies whether the SD

switching function of N+1 protection is

enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the SD condition is considered as a

trigger condition of protection switching.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Enabled.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-58 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 243: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 243/496

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Select Mapping

Direction

Work Unit

Protection Unit

Work Unit   l This parameter specifies the mapping

direction of N+1 protection.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Select Mapping

Way

- -   l In the case of N+1 protection, map N IF

 ports as Work Unit and map the

remaining IF port as Protection Unit.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Mapped Board - - This parameter indicates the working unit

and protection unit that have been set.

 

A.4.4 Parameter Description: N+1 Protection

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF N+1 protection.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > N+1

Protection from the Function Tree.

Protection Group Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Group

ID

- - This parameter indicates the ID of the

 protection group.

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

WTR time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

set WTR time, a revertive switchingoccurs.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-59

Page 244: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 244/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

SD Enable Enabled

Disabled

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the SD switching function of N

+1 protection is enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the SD condition is considered as a

trigger condition of protection switching.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Enabled.

Protocol Status - - This parameter indicates the status of the

switching control protocol.

 

Protection Unit Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Unit - - This parameter indicates the protection unit.

Line - - This parameter indicates the information

about the working board or protection

 board.

Switching Status - - This parameter indicates the switching state.

Protection Unit - - This parameter indicates the protected unit.

Remote/Local End

Indication

- - This parameter indicates the local end or  

remote end.

 

A.4.5 Parameter: IF 1+1 Protection_Create

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an IF 1+1 protection group.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1

Protection from the Function Tree.

2. Click Create.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-60 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 245: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 245/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Working Mode HSB

FD

SD

HSB   l This parameter specifies the working

mode of the IF 1+1 protection.

l In HSB mode, the equipment provides a

1+1 hot standby configuration for the IF

 board and ODU at both ends of each hop

of a radio link to realize the protection.

l In FD mode, the system uses two

channels that have a frequency spacing

 between them, to transmit and receive the

same signal. The remote end selects

signals from the two received signals.

With FD protection, the impact of the

fading on signal transmission is reduced.l In SD mode, the system uses two

antennas that have a space distance

 between them, to receive the same signal.

The equipment selects signals from the

two received signals. With SD protection,

the impact of the fading on signal

transmission is reduced.

l The FD mode and SD mode are

compatible with the HSB switching

function.

l This parameter is set according to the planning information.

Revertive Mode Revertive Mode

 Non-Revertive

Mode

Revertive Mode   l This parameter specifies the revertive

mode of the IF 1+1 protection.

l When this parameter is set to Revertive

Mode, the NE that is in the switching

state releases the switching and enables

the former working channel to return to

the normal state some time after the

former working channel is restored to

normal.

l When this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive Mode, the NE that is in the

switching state keeps the current state

unchanged unless another switching

occurs even though the former working

channel is restored to normal.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive Mode.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-61

Page 246: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 246/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter specifies the wait-to-

restore (WTR) time.

l When the time after the former workingchannel is restored to normal reaches the

set WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive

Mode.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

Enable Reverse

Switching

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates whether the

reverse switching function is enabled.

l When both the main IF board and the

standby IF board at the sink end report

service alarms, they send the alarms to the

source end by using the MWRDI

overhead in the microwave frame. When

this parameter at the source end is set to

Enabled and the reverse switching

conditions are met, the IF 1+1 protection

switching occurs at the source end.

l This parameter is valid only when

Working Mode is set to HSB or SD.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you set this parameter to Enabled.

Working Board - - This parameter specifies the working board

of the protection group.

Protection Board - - This parameter specifies the protection

 board of the protection group.

 

NOTE

Each of the parameters Working Mode, Revertive Mode, WTR Time(s), and Enable Reverse

Switching must be set to the same value at both ends of a radio hop.

A.4.6 Parameter Description: IF 1+1 Protection

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF 1+1 protection.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > IF 1+1

Protection from the Function Tree.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-62 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 247: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 247/496

Protection Group Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Group

ID

- - This parameter indicates the ID of the

 protection group.

Working Mode HSB

FD

SD

HSB   l This parameter indicates the working

mode of the created IF 1+1 protection

group.

l In HSB mode, the equipment provides a

1+1 hot standby configuration for the IF

 board and ODU at both ends of each hop

of a radio link to realize the protection.

l In FD mode, the system uses two

channels that have a frequency spacing

 between them, to transmit and receive thesame signal. The remote end selects

signals from the two received signals.

With FD protection, the impact of the

fading on signal transmission is reduced.

l In SD mode, the system uses two

antennas that have a space distance

 between them, to receive the same signal.

The equipment selects signals from the

two received signals. With SD protection,

the impact of the fading on signal

transmission is reduced.

l The FD mode and SD mode are

compatible with the HSB switching

function.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Revertive Mode Revertive Mode

 Non-Revertive

Mode

Revertive Mode   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

revertive mode of the protection group.

l When this parameter is set to Revertive

Mode, the NE that is in the switching state

releases the switching and enables the

former working channel to return to thenormal state some time after the former 

working channel is restored to normal.

l When this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive Mode, the NE that is in the

switching state keeps the current state

unchanged unless another switching

occurs even though the former working

channel is restored to normal.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive Mode.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-63

Page 248: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 248/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

WTR time.

l When the time after the former workingchannel is restored to normal reaches the

set WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive

Mode.

l It is recommended that you use the default

value.

Enable Reverse

Switching

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the reverse switching function is

enabled.

l When both the main IF board and the

standby IF board at the sink end report

service alarms, they send the alarms to the

source end by using the MWRDI

overhead in the microwave frame. When

this parameter at the source end is set to

Enabled and the reverse switching

conditions are met, the IF 1+1 protection

switching occurs at the source end.

l This parameter is valid only when

Working Mode is set to HSB or SD.

Switching Status of 

Device

- -   l This parameter indicates the switching

state on the equipment side.

l Unknown is displayed when the

switching state on the channel side is not

queried or not obtained after a query.

Switching Status of 

Channel

- -   l This parameter indicates the switching

state on the channel side.

l Unknown is displayed when the

switching state on the channel side is not

queried or not obtained after a query.

Active Board of 

Device

- - This parameter indicates the current

working board on the equipment side.

Active Board of 

Channel

- - This parameter indicates the current

working board on the channel side.

 

NOTE

Each of the parameters Working Mode, Revertive Mode, WTR Time(s), and Enable ReverseSwitching must be set to the same value at both ends of a radio hop.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-64 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 249: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 249/496

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Unit - - This parameter indicates the working board

and protection board.

Slot Mapping

Relation

- - This parameter indicates the names and

 ports of the working board and protection

 board.

Working Status of 

Device

- - This parameter indicates the working state

on the equipment side.

Signal Status of 

Channel

- - This parameter indicates the status of the

link signal.

 

A.4.7 Parameter: Link Configuration_IF/ODU Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the IF/ODU.

Navigation Path

1. In the NE Explorer, select the NE and then choose Configuration > Link 

Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the IF/ODU Configuration tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-65

Page 250: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 250/496

Parameters for Configuring the IF

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Work Mode 1,4E1,7MHz,QPSK 

2,4E1,3.5MHz,

16QAM

3,8E1,14MHz,QPS

4,8E1,7MHz,

16QAM

5,16E1,28MHz,QP

SK 

6,16E1,14MHz,

16QAM

7,STM-1,28MHz,128QAM

8,E3,28MHz,QPSK 

9,E3,14MHz,

16QAM

10,22E1,14MHz,

32QAM

11,26E1,14MHz,

64QAM

12,32E1,14MHz,

128QAM

13,35E1,28MHz,

16QAM

14,44E1,28MHz,

32QAM

15,53E1,28MHz,

64QAM

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

work mode of the radio link in "work mode number, service capacity, channel

spacing, modulation mode" format.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information. The work modes

of the IF boards at the two ends of a radio

link must be the same.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IFU2

 board and the IFX2 board.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-66 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 251: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 251/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable AM Disabled

Enabled

Disable   l When this parameter is set to Disabled,

the radio link uses only the specified

modulation scheme. In this case, you

need to select Manually Specified

Modulation Mode.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the radio link uses the corresponding

modulation scheme according to the

channel conditions.

Hence, the Hybrid radio can ensure the

reliable transmission of the E1 services and

 provide bandwidth adaptively for the

Ethernet services when the AM function is

enabled.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Channel Space 7M

14M

28M

56M

7M Channel Space indicates the channel

spacing of the corresponding radio link.

This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Guaranteed

Capacity

Modulation

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

QPSK This parameter specifies the lowest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according tothe planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

service transmission bandwidth that the

Hybrid radio must ensure and the

availability of the radio link that

corresponds to this modulation scheme.

This parameter is valid only when Enable

AM is set to Enabled.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-67

Page 252: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 252/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Full Capacity

Modulation

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

- This parameter specifies the highest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according to

the planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

 bandwidth of the services that need to be

transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the

availability of the radio link that

corresponds to this modulation scheme.

NOTEFull Capacity Modulation must be higher than

Guaranteed E1 Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when Enable

AM is set to Enabled.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Manually Specified

Modulation

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

QPSK This parameter specifies the modulation

scheme that the radio link uses for signal

transmission.

This parameter is valid only when Enable

AM is set to Disabled.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Guaranteed E1

Capacity

- -   l When Enable AM is set to Enabled, this

 parameter depends on Channel Spaceand Guaranteed E1 Capacity and is not

configurable.

l When Enable AM is set to Disabled, this

 parameter depends on Channel Space

and Manually Specified Modulation

Mode and is not configurable.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

Specified Max E1

Capacity

- - This parameter specifies the number of E1

services that can be transmitted in the

Hybrid work mode. The value of this

 parameter cannot exceed the Guaranteed

E1 Capacity.

The E1 Capacity must be set to the same

value at both ends of a radio link.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-68 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 253: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 253/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Link ID 1 to 4094 1   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

ID of a radio link. As the identifier of a

radio link, this parameter is used to

 prevent incorrect connections of radio

links between sites.

l If the value of Received Radio Link ID

does not match the preset value of Link 

ID at the local end, the local end inserts

the AIS signal to the downstream

direction of the service. At the same time,

the local end reports MW_LIM alarm to

the NMS, indicating that the link IDs do

not match.

l Each radio link of an NE should have a

unique link ID, and the link IDs at both

ends of a radio link should be the same.

Received Link ID 1 to 4094 - This parameter indicates the received ID of  

the radio link.

NOTEWhen the radio link becomes faulty, this

 parameter is displayed as an invalid value.

ATPC Enable

Status

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC function is enabled. If the APTC

function is enabled, the transmit power of 

the transmitter automatically varieswithin the specified ATPC range

according to the change of the RSL at the

receive end.

l In the case of areas where fast fading

severely affects the radio transmission, it

is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Disabled.

l During the commissioning process, set

this parameter to Disabled to ensure that

the transmit power is not changed. After 

the commissioning, re-set the ATPCattributes.

ATPC Upper

Threshold(dBm)

-75.0 to -20.0 -45.0   l Set the central value between the ATPC

upper threshold and the ATPC lower 

threshold to a value for the expected

receive power.

l It is recommended that you set ATPC

Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of 

the planned central value between the

ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC

lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-69

Page 254: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 254/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm)

-35.0 to -90.0 -70.0 Lower Threshold(dBm) to the

difference between the planned central

value between the ATPC upper threshold

and the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB.

l You can set the ATPC upper threshold

only when ATPC Automatic Threshold

(dBm) is set to Disabled.

ATPC AutomaticThreshold Enable

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether theATPC automatic threshold function is

enabled.

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the

equipment automatically uses the preset

ATPC upper and lower thresholds

according to the work mode of the radio

link.

l If this parameter is set to Disabled, you

need to manually set ATPC Upper

Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm).

Enable IEEE-1588

Timeslot

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled If the OptiX RTN 950 is interconnected with

the packet radio equipment, this parameter 

is set to Enabled. Otherwise, this parameter 

is set to Disabled.

NOTEThis parameter is not applicable to the IF1 board.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-70 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 255: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 255/496

Parameters for Configuring the ODU

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

TX Frequency

(MHz)

- -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,the channel central frequency.

l The value of this parameter must not be

less than the sum of the lower TX

frequency limit supported by the ODU

and a half of the channel spacing, and

must not be more than the difference

 between the upper TX frequency limit

supported by the ODU and a half of the

channel spacing.

l The difference between the transmit

frequencies of both the ends of a radiolink should be one T/R spacing.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information.

Range of TX

Frequency(MHz)

- -   l This parameter indicates the range of the

transmit frequency of the ODU.

l The Range of Frequency(MHz)

depends on the specifications of the

ODU.

Actual TX

Frequency(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual transmit

frequency of the ODU.

Actual RX

Frequency(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual receive

frequency of the ODU.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-71

Page 256: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 256/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

T/R Spacing(MHz) - -   l This parameter specifies the spacing

 between the transmit frequency and the

receive frequency of an ODU to prevent

interference between them.

l If Station Type of the ODU is TX high,

the TX frequency is one T/R spacing

higher than the receive frequency. If 

Station Type of the ODU is TX low, the

TX frequency is one T/R spacing lower 

than the receive frequency.

l If the ODU supports only one T/R 

spacing, set this parameter to 0, indicating

that the T/R spacing supported by the

ODU is used.

l A valid T/R spacing value is determined

 by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing

should be set according to the technical

specifications of the ODU.

l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be

set to the same value at both the ends of 

a radio link.

Actual T/R 

Spacing(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual T/R  

spacing of the ODU.

TX Power(dBm) - -  l

This parameter indicates or specifies thetransmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power range of the

ODU.

l This parameter cannot take a value

greater than the preset value of 

Maximum Transmit Power(dBm).

l The transmit power of the ODU should

 be set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

l

Consider the receive power of the ODUat the opposite end when you set this

 parameter. Ensure that the receive power 

of the ODU at the opposite end can ensure

stable radio services.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information.

TX High

Threshold(dBm)

- -   l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is greater than the preset

value of TX High Threshold(dBm), the

system separately records the duration

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-72 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 257: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 257/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

TX Low Threshold

(dBm)

- - when the value of the actual transmit

 power of the ODU is greater than the

 preset value of TX High Threshold

(dBm) and the duration when the value

of the actual transmit power of the ODU

is greater than the preset value of TX Low

Threshold(dBm) in the performance

events.

l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is greater than the preset

value of TX Low Threshold(dBm) and

is lower than the preset value of TX High

Threshold(dBm), the system records the

duration when the value of the actual

transmit power of the ODU is greater thanthe preset value of TX Low Threshold

(dBm) in the performance events.

l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is lower than the preset value

of TX Low Threshold(dBm), the system

does not record it.

l TX High Threshold(dBm) and TX Low

Threshold(dBm) are valid only when the

ATPC function is enabled.

RX High

Threshold(dBm)

- -   l If the value of the actual receive power of 

the ODU is lower than the preset value of 

RX Low Threshold(dBm), the system

records the duration when the value of the

actual receive power of the ODU is lower 

than the preset value of RX Low

Threshold(dBm) and duration when the

value of the actual transmit power of the

ODU is lower than the preset value of RX

High Threshold(dBm)in the

 performance events.

l If the value of the actual receive power of the ODU is greater than the preset value

of RX Low Threshold(dBm) and is

lower than the preset value of RX High

Threshold(dBm), the system records the

duration when the value of the actual

receive power of the ODU is Lower than

the preset value of RX High Threshold

(dBm) in the performance events.

l If the value of the actual receive power of 

the ODU is greater than the preset value

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-73

Page 258: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 258/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

RX Low Threshold

(dBm)

- - of RX High Threshold(dBm), the

system does not record it.

Power to Be

Received(dBm)

- -   l This parameter is used to set the expected

receive power of the ODU and is mainly

used in the antenna alignment stage. After 

this parameter is set, the NE

automatically enables the antenna

misalignment indicating function.

l When the antenna misalignment

indicating function is enabled, if the

actual receive power of the ODU exceeds

the range of receive power±3 dB, the

ODU LED of the IF board connected to

the ODU is on (yellow) for 300 ms and

off for 300 ms repeatedly, indicating that

the antenna is not aligned.

l After the antenna alignment, after the

state that the antenna is aligned lasts for 30 minutes, the NE automatically

disables the antenna misalignment

indicating function.

l This parameter needs to be according to

the planning.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-74 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 259: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 259/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maximum

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the maximum

transmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power rang of the

ODU in the guaranteed capacity

modulation module.

l This parameter is set to limit the

maximum transmit power of the ODU

within this preset range.

l The maximum transmit power adjusted

 by using the ATPC function should not

exceed this value.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the planning information.

Range of TX

Power(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the range of the

transmit power of the ODU.

Actual TX Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter indicates the actual

transmit power of the ODU.

l If the ATPC function is enabled, the

queried actual transmit power may be

different from the preset value.

Actual RX Power

(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the actual receive

 power of the ODU.

TX Status Unmute

Mute

Unmute   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit status of the ODU.

l When this parameter is set to Mute, the

transmitter of the ODU does not work but

can normally receive microwave signals.

l When this parameter is set to Unmute,

the ODU can normally transmit and

receive microwave signals.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you set this parameter to unmute.

Actual TX Status Unmute

Mute

- This parameter indicates the actual transmit

status of the ODU.

 

Equipment Information

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Frequency(GHz) - - This parameter indicates the frequency band

where the ODU operates.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-75

Page 260: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 260/496

Page 261: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 261/496

Page 262: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 262/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Revertive Mode  Non-Revertive

Revertive

 Non-Revertive (1+1

Protection)

Revertive (1:NProtection)

l This parameter specifies the revertive

mode of the linear MSP.

l When this parameter is set to Revertive,the NE that is in the switching state

releases the switching and enables the

former working channel to return to the

normal state some time after the former 

working channel is restored to normal.

l When this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the NE that is in the switching

state keeps the current state unchanged

unless another switching occurs even

though the former working channel is

restored to normal.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive.

l If the linear MSP type is set to 1:N

Protection, Revertive Mode can be set

to Revertive only.

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter specifies the WTR time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

 preset WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

SD Enable Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the switching at the SD alarm of 

the linear MSP is enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the B2_SD alarm is considered as a

switching condition.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Enabled.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-78 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 263: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 263/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protocol Type  New Protocol

Restructure Protocol

 New Protocol   l The new protocol is supported at the early

stage, and the mainstream protocol

version is used currently.

l The restructure protocol optimizes the

new protocol and provides better 

measures to protect the new protocol,

thus ensuring that the new protocol runs

in a better manner.

l The new protocol is more mature, and the

restructure protocol complies with the

standard. It is recommended that you use

the new protocol.

l You must ensure that the interconnected

 NEs run the protocols of the same type.

 

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Select Mapping

Direction

West Working Unit

West Protection

Unit

West Working Unit This parameter specifies the mapping

direction of the linear MSP.

Select MappingMode

- -  l

This parameter specifies the mapping board and port in the mapping direction.

l If the protection type is set to 1+1

Protection, only one line port can be

mapped as West Working Unit.

l Only one line port can be mapped as West

Protection Unit.

l The line port mapped as West Protection

Unit and the line port mapped as West

Working Unit should be configured for 

different boards if possible.

Mapped Board - - This parameter indicates the preset slot

mapping relations, including the mapping

direction and the corresponding mapping

mode.

 

A.5.2 Parameter Description: Linear MSP

This topic describes the parameters that are related to linear MSP groups.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-79

Page 264: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 264/496

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Linear MS

from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Group

ID

- - This parameter indicates the ID of the

 protection group.

Protection Type 1+1 Protection

1:N Protection

-   l This parameter indicates the protection

type of the linear MSP group.

l In the case of 1+1 linear MSP, one

working channel and one protection

channel are required. When the working

channel fails, the service is switched from

the working channel to the protection

channel.

l In the case of 1:N linear MSP, N working

channels and one protection channel are

required. Normal services are transmitted

on the working channels and extra

services are transmitted on the protection

channel. When one working channel

fails, the services are switched from this

working channel to the protection

channel, and the extra services areinterrupted.

l If extra services need to be transmitted or 

several working channels are required,

select 1:N Protection.

Switching Mode Single-Ended

Switching

Dual-Ended

Switching

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

switching mode of the linear MSP.

l In single-ended mode, the switching

occurs only at one end and the state of the

other end remains unchanged.

l

In dual-ended mode, the switching occursat both ends at the same time.

l If the linear MSP type is set to 1:N

Protection, Switching Mode can be set

to Dual-Ended Switching only.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-80 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 265: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 265/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Revertive Mode  Non-Revertive

Revertive

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

revertive mode of the linear MSP.

l When this parameter is set to Revertive,the NE that is in the switching state

releases the switching and enables the

former working channel to return to the

normal state some time after the former 

working channel is restored to normal.

l When this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the NE that is in the switching

state keeps the current state unchanged

unless another switching occurs even

though the former working channel is

restored to normal.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive.

l If the linear MSP type is set to 1:N

Protection, Revertive Mode can be set

to Revertive only.

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

WTR time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

 preset WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

SD Enable Enabled

Disabled

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the reverse switching function is

enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabled,

the B2_SD alarm is considered as a

switching condition.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Enabled.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-81

Page 266: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 266/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protocol Type  New Protocol

Restructure Protocol

-   l The new protocol is supported at the early

stage, and the mainstream protocol

version is used currently.

l The restructure protocol optimizes the

new protocol and provides better 

measures to protect the new protocol,

thus ensuring that the new protocol runs

in a better manner.

l You must ensure that the interconnected

 NEs run the protocols of the same type.

l The new protocol is more mature, and the

restructure protocol complies with the

standard. It is recommended that you use

the new protocol.

Protocol Status - - This parameter indicates the protocol status

of the linear MSP.

 

Slot Mapping Relation Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Unit - - This parameter indicates that which of the

units, namely, the west protection unit or the

west working unit, is currently in the protection status.

West Line -

-

- This parameter indicates the west protection

unit and the west working unit of the linear 

MSP.

West Switching

Status

- - This parameter indicates the switching

status of the line.

Protected Unit - - This parameter indicates the working

channel protected by the current protection

channel.

Remote/Local End

Indication

- - When Switching Mode is set to Dual-

Ended Switching, the central office end

that issues the switching command is

displayed.

 

A.6 SDH/PDH Service Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to SDH/PDH services.

A.6.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Creation

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-82 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 267: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 267/496

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating point-to-point cross-

connections.

A.6.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCP Service Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating SNCP services.

A.6.3 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_Converting Normal Services Into

SNCP Services

This topic describes the parameters that are used for converting normal services into SNCP

services.

A.6.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring SDH services (namely,

configuring cross-connections).

A.6.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control

This topic describes the parameters that are used for controlling SNCP services.

A.6.1 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_CreationThis parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating point-to-point cross-

connections.

Navigation Path

l Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH

Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

l Click Create.

ParametersParameter Value Range Default Value Description

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

VC12   l This parameter specifies the level of the

service to be created.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, set this parameter to VC12.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, set this

 parameter to VC3.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, set this parameter to

VC4.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-83

Page 268: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 268/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Direction Bidirectional

Unidirectional

Bidirectional   l When this parameter is set to

Unidirectional, create only the cross-

connections from the service source to the

service sink.

l When this parameter is set to

Bidirectional, create the cross-

connections from the service source to the

service sink and the cross-connections

from the service sink to the service

source.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you set this parameter to Bidirectional.

Source Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service source.

Source VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of 

the VC-4 channel where the service

source is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when

Source Slot is set to the slot of the

tributary board.

Source Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter indicates the timeslot

range of the service source.

l This parameter can be set to a number or 

several numbers. When setting this parameter to several numbers, use the

comma (,) to separate the discrete

numbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate

1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Sink Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service sink.

Sink VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of 

the VC-4 channel where the service sink 

is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when Sink 

Slot is set to the slot of the tributary board.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-84 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 269: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 269/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Sink Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter specifies the timeslot

range of the service sink.

l This parameter can be set to a number or several numbers. When setting this

 parameter to several numbers, use the

comma (,) to separate the discrete

numbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate

1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Activate

Immediately

Yes

 No

Yes   l This parameter specifies whether to

immediately activate the configuredservice.

l To immediately deliver the configured

SDH service to the NE, set this parameter 

to Yes.

 

A.6.2 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration_SNCPService Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating SNCP services.

Navigation Path

l Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH

Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

l Click Create SNCP Service.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service Type SNCP SNCP This parameter indicates that the type of the

service to be created is SNCP.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-85

Page 270: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 270/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Direction Bidirectional

Unidirectional

Bidirectional   l When this parameter is set to

Unidirectional, create only the cross-

connections from the SNCP service

source to the SNCP service sink.

l When this parameter is set to

Bidirectional, create the cross-

connections from the SNCP service

source to the service sink and the cross-

connections from the SNCP service sink 

to the service source.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you set this parameter to Bidirectional.

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

VC12   l This parameter specifies the level of the

SCNP service to be created.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, set this parameter to VC12.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, set this

 parameter to VC3.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, set this parameter to

VC4.

Hold-off Time(100ms)

0 to 100 0   l This parameter specifies the duration of the hold-off time.

l When a line is faulty, SNCP switching

can be performed on the NE after a delay

of time to prevent the situation where the

 NE performs SNCP switching and other 

 protection switching at the same time.

l If multiple link-based protection

schemes, such as SNCP, 1+1 protection,

and N+1 protection, are available at the

same time, the hold-off time needs to be

set to a duration that is longer than theswitching duration for the multiple link-

 based protection schemes.

l If only the SNCP scheme is available, it

is recommended that you set the hold-off 

time to 0.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-86 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 271: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 271/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Revertive Mode  Non-Revertive

Revertive

 Non-Revertive   l This parameter specifies whether to

switch the service to the original working

channel after the fault is rectified.

l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the

service is switched from the protection

channel to the original working channel.

If this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the service is not switched

from the protection channel to the

original working channel.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive.

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter specifies the WTR time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

 preset WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

Source Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service source.

Source VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of 

the VC-4 channel where the service

source is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when

Source Slot is set to the slot of the

tributary board.

Source Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter indicates the timeslot

range of the service source.

l This parameter can be set to a number or 

several numbers. When setting this

 parameter to several numbers, use thecomma (,) to separate the discrete

numbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate

1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Sink Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service sink.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-87

Page 272: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 272/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Sink VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of 

the VC-4 channel where the service sink 

is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when Sink 

Slot is set to the slot of the tributary board.

Sink Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter specifies the timeslot

range of the service sink.

l This parameter can be set to a number or 

several numbers. When setting this

 parameter to several numbers, use the

comma (,) to separate the discrete

numbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Configure SNCP

Tangent Ring

Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l After the Configure SNCP Tangent

Ring checkbox is selected, you can

quickly configure the SNCP service for 

the SNCP ring tangent point.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you do not select this checkbox.

Activate

Immediately

Selected

Deselected

Selected   l This parameter specifies whether toimmediately activate the configured

SNCP service.

l After the Activate Immediately

checkbox is selected, you can

immediately activate the created SNCP

service.

 

A.6.3 Parameter Description: SDH ServiceConfiguration_Converting Normal Services Into SNCP Services

This topic describes the parameters that are used for converting normal services into SNCP

services.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH

Service Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. If a bidirectional SDH service is created, select this service in Cross-Connection. Right-

click the selected service and choose Expand to Unidirectional from the shortcut menu.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-88 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 273: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 273/496

3. Select the unidirectional service. Right-click the selected service and choose Convert to

SNCP Service from the shortcut menu.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service Type SNCP SNCP This parameter indicates that the type of the

service to be created is SNCP.

Direction Unidirectional - This parameter indicates the direction of the

SNCP service.

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

-   l This parameter indicates the level of the

SNCP service.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, the parameter value is VC12.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, the parameter 

value is VC3.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, the parameter value is

VC4.

Hold-off Time

(100ms)

0 to 100 0   l This parameter specifies the duration of 

the hold-off time.

l When a line is faulty, SNCP switching

can be performed on the NE after a delayof time to prevent the situation where the

 NE performs SNCP switching and other 

 protection switching at the same time.

l If multiple link-based protection

schemes, such as SNCP, 1+1 protection,

and N+1 protection, are available at the

same time, the hold-off time needs to be

set to a duration that is longer than the

switching duration for the multiple link-

 based protection schemes.

l If only the SNCP scheme is available, itis recommended that you set the hold-off 

time to 0.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-89

Page 274: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 274/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Revertive Mode  Non-Revertive

Revertive

 Non-Revertive   l This parameter specifies whether to

switch the service to the original working

channel after the fault is rectified. If this

 parameter is set to "Revertive", the

service is switched from the protection

channel to the original working channel.

l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the

service is switched from the protection

channel to the original working channel.

If this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the service is not switched

from the protection channel to the

original working channel.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive.

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 600   l This parameter specifies the WTR time.

l When the time after the former working

channel is restored to normal reaches the

 preset WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

Source Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service source.

Source VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of 

the VC-4 channel where the service

source is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when

Source Slot is set to the slot of the

tributary board.

Source Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter indicates the timeslot

range of the service source.l This parameter can be set to a number or 

several numbers. When setting this

 parameter to several numbers, use the

comma (,) to separate the discrete

numbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate

1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-90 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 275: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 275/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Sink Slot - - This parameter specifies the slot of the

service sink.

Sink VC4 - -   l This parameter specifies the number of the VC-4 channel where the service sink 

is located.

l This parameter cannot be set when Sink 

Slot is set to the slot of the tributary board.

Sink Timeslot

Range(e.g.1,3-6)

- -   l This parameter specifies the timeslot

range of the service sink.

l This parameter can be set to a number or 

several numbers. When setting this

 parameter to several numbers, use the

comma (,) to separate the discretenumbers, or use the endash (-) to

represent a consecutive number. For 

example, the numbers 1, and 3-6 indicate

1, 3, 4, 5, and 6.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Configure SNCP

Tangent Ring

Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l After the Configure SNCP Tangent

Ring checkbox is selected, you can

quickly configure the SNCP service for 

the SNCP ring tangent point.

l In normal cases, it is recommended thatyou do not select this checkbox.

Activate

Immediately

Selected

Deselected

Selected   l This parameter specifies whether to

immediately activate the configured

SNCP service.

l After the Activate Immediately

checkbox is selected, you can

immediately activate the created SNCP

service.

 

A.6.4 Parameter Description: SDH Service Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring SDH services (namely,

configuring cross-connections).

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SDH Service

Configuration from the Function Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-91

Page 276: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 276/496

Cross-Connection Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

-   l This parameter indicates the level of the

service.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, VC12 is displayed.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is

displayed.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, VC4 is displayed.

Source Slot - - This parameter indicates the slot of the

service source.

Source Timeslot/

Path

- - This parameter indicates the timeslot or  

timeslot range of the service source.

Sink Slot - - This parameter indicates the slot of the

source sink.

Sink Timeslot/

Path

- - This parameter indicates the timeslot or  

timeslot range of the service sink.

Activation Status Yes

 No

- This parameter indicates whether to activate

the service.

Bound Group

Number

- - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Lockout Status - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Trail Name - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Schedule No. - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-92 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 277: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 277/496

Parameters for Automatically Generated Cross-Connections

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

-   l This parameter indicates the level of the

service.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, VC12 is displayed.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is

displayed.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, VC4 is displayed.

Source Slot - - This parameter indicates the slot of the

service source.

Source Timeslot/

Path

- - This parameter indicates the timeslot or  

timeslot range of the service source.

Sink Slot - - This parameter indicates the slot of the

source sink.

Sink Timeslot/

Path

- - This parameter indicates the timeslot or  

timeslot range of the service sink.

Lockout Status - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Trail Name - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Schedule No. - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

 

A.6.5 Parameter Description: SNCP Service Control

This topic describes the parameters that are used for controlling SNCP services.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > SNCP Service

Control from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service Type - - This parameter indicates the service

 protection type of the protection group.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-93

Page 278: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 278/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source - - This parameter indicates the timeslots where

the working service source and protection

service source of the protection group are

located.

Sink  - - This parameter indicates the timeslots where

the working service sink and protection

service sink of the protection group are

located.

Level VC12

VC3

VC4

-   l This parameter indicates the level of the

service.

l If the service is an E1 service or a data

service that is bound with VC-12

channels, VC12 is displayed.

l If the service is a data service that is

 bound with VC-3 channels, VC3 is

displayed.

l If all the services on a VC-4 channel pass

through the NE, VC4 is displayed.

Current Status - - This parameter indicates the current

switching mode and switching status of the

services of the protection group.

Revertive Mode Revertive

 Non-Revertive

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

revertive mode of the service.l This parameter determines whether to

switch the service from the protection

channel to the original working channel

after the fault is rectified.

l If this parameter is set to Revertive, the

service is switched from the protection

channel to the original working channel.

If this parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the service is not switched

from the protection channel to the

original working channel.

l It is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Revertive.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-94 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 279: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 279/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

WTR Time(s) 300 to 720 -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

WTR time.

l When the time after the former workingchannel is restored to normal reaches the

 preset WTR time, a revertive switching

occurs.

l You can set WTR Time(s) only when

Revertive Mode is set to Revertive.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

Hold-off Time

(100ms)

0 to 100 -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

duration of the hold-off time.

l

When a line is faulty, SNCP switchingcan be performed on the NE after a delay

of time to prevent the situation where the

 NE performs SNCP switching and other 

 protection switching at the same time.

l If multiple link-based protection

schemes, such as SNCP, 1+1 protection,

and N+1 protection, are available at the

same time, the hold-off time needs to be

set to a duration that is longer than the

switching duration for the multiple link-

 based protection schemes.

l If only the SNCP scheme is available, it

is recommended that you set the hold-off 

time to 0.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-95

Page 280: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 280/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Initiation

Condition

TIM

EXC

SD

UNEQ

 Null

 Null   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

conditions that trigger the protection

switching of the service.

l If TIM is selected, the SNCP service

considers the HP_TIM or LP_TIM alarm

as an automatic switching condition.

l If EXC is selected, the SNCP service

considers the B3_EXC or BIP _EXC

alarm as an automatic switching

condition.

l If SD is selected, the SNCP service

considers the B3_SD or BIP_SD alarm as

an automatic switching condition.

l If UNEQ is selected, the SNCP serviceconsiders the HP_UNEQ or LP_UNEQ

alarm as an automatic switching

condition.

l It is recommended that you set Initiation

Condition to the same condition for 

Working Service and Protection

Service.

l The protection switching conditions in

Initiation Condition are optional values

not included in the default values, and

they are set according to the planninginformation.

Trail Status - - This parameter indicates the status of the

working service and protection service of 

the protection group.

Service Grouping - - The OptiX RTN 950 does not support this

 parameter.

Active Channel - - This parameter indicates whether the

working service or protection service is

currently received by the protection group.

 

A.7 Clock ParametersThis topic describes the parameters that are related to clocks.

A.7.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the priority table of a clock source.

A.7.2 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet

This topic describes the parameters that are related to a clock subnet.

A.7.3 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Quality

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-96 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 281: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 281/496

This topic describes the parameters that are related clock quality.

A.7.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM Output Control

This topic describes the parameters that are related to SSM output control.

A.7.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock ID Enabling StatusThis topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the clock ID function.

A.7.6 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Restoration Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to clock source restoration.

A.7.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock Source Switching

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the switching conditions of a clock source.

A.7.8 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of the External Clock Source

This topic describes the parameters of the output phase-locked source of the external clock 

source.

A.7.9 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the clock synchronization status.

A.7.1 Parameter Description: Clock Source Priority Table

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the priority table of a clock source.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Source Priority.

2. Click the System Clock Source Priority List tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-97

Page 282: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 282/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Clock Source - -   l External clock source 1

indicates the externalclock source at the

CLK or TIME1 port on

the CST or CSH board

in physical slot 7.

External clock source 2

indicates the external

clock source at the

CLK or TIME1 port on

the CST or CSH board

in physical slot 8.

l

The internal clock source is always at the

lowest priority and

indicates that the NE

works in the free-run

mode.

l The clock sources and

the corresponding

clock source priority

levels are determined

according to the clock 

synchronization

schemes.

External Clock Source

Mode

2Mbit/s

2MHz

2Mbit/s   l This parameter 

indicates the type of the

external clock source

signal.

l This parameter is set

according to the

external clock signal.

In normal cases, the

external clock signal is

a 2 Mbit/s signal.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-98 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 283: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 283/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Synchronous Status Byte SA4 to SA8 SA4   l This parameter is valid

only when External

Clock Source Mode is

set to 2Mbit/s.

l This parameter 

indicates which bit of 

the TS0 in odd frames

of the external clock 

signal is used to

transmit the SSM.

l This parameter needs to

 be set only when the

SSM or extended SSM

is enabled. In normal

cases, the external

clock sources use the

SA4 to transmit the

SSM.

Clock Source Priority

Sequence (1 is the

highest)

- - Displays the priority

sequence of clock sources.

1 indicates the highest

clock source priority.

 

A.7.2 Parameter Description: Clock Subnet Setting_Clock Subnet

This topic describes the parameters that are related to a clock subnet.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Subnet Configuration.

2. Click the Clock Subnet tab.

Parameters for Setting a Clock Subnet

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Affiliated Subnet 0 to 255 0   l This parameter is used

when the clock subnet

needs to be created on

the NMS.

l The NEs that trace the

same clock source

should be allocated

with the same clock 

subnet ID.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-99

Page 284: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 284/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protection Status Start Extended SSM

Protocol

Start Standard SSMProtocol

Stop SSM Protocol

Stop SSM Protocol   l The SSM protocol is a

scheme used for 

synchronous

management on an

SDH network and

indicates that the SSM

is passed by the lower 

four bits of the S1 byte

and can be exchanged

 between the nodes. The

SSM protocol ensures

that the equipment

automatically selects

the clock source of the

highest quality andhighest priority, thus

 preventing mutual

clock tracing.

l After the standard SSM

 protocol is started, the

 NE first performs the

 protection switching on

the clock source

according to the clock 

quality level

information provided

 by the S1 byte. If thequality level of the

clock source is the

same, the NE then

 performs the protection

switching according to

the clock priority table.

That is, the NE selects

an unlocked clock 

source that is of the

highest quality and

highest priority from all

the current available

clock sources as the

clock source to be

synchronized and

traced by the local

station.

l If the SSM protocol is

stopped, it indicates

that the S1 byte is not

used. The NE selects

and switches a clock 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-100 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 285: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 285/496

Page 286: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 286/496

Page 287: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 287/496

Parameters for Clock Source Quality

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Clock Source - - This parameter indicates

the name of theconfigured clock source.

In Clock Source

Priority, you can set

whether to add or delete a

clock source.

Configuration Quality Unknown

Synchronization Quality

G.811 Clock Signal

G.812 Transit Clock 

SignalG.812 Local Clock Signal

G.813 SDH Equipment

Timing Source (SETS)

Signal

Do Not Use For 

Synchronization

Automatic Extraction

Automatic Extraction This parameter specifies

the quality level that is

configured for the clock 

source. This function is

required only in a special

scenario or in a test.Generally, this parameter 

need not be set.

Clock Quality - - This parameter indicates

the clock source quality

signal received by the NE.The NE extracts the clock 

source quality signal from

the S1 byte of each clock 

source.

 

Parameters for Manual Setting of 0 Quality Level

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE Name - - This parameter indicatesthe name of the NE.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-103

Page 288: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 288/496

Page 289: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 289/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

l Between G.812 Local

Clock and synchronous

equipment timing

source (SETS): lower 

than the quality level of 

the local exchange

clock signal specified

in ITU-T G.812 but

higher than the quality

level of the clock signal

of the SETS.

l SETS Clock: the clock 

signal of the SETS.

l Between synchronous

equipment timing

source (SETS) and

quality unavailable:

lower than the quality

level of the clock signal

of the SETS but higher 

than the quality level

unavailable in the

synchronous timing

source.

 

A.7.4 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_SSM OutputControl

This topic describes the parameters that are related to SSM output control.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Subnet Configuration.

2. Click the SSM Output Control tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-105

Page 290: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 290/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Line Port - -   l This parameter 

indicates the name of the line clock port.

l Line Port: indicates

the SSM quality

information output port

of the current available

line clock source and

the external clock 

source. This output port

can transmit the quality

information of the

clock source byoutputting the S1 byte

to the downstream NE.

Control Status Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter is valid

only when the SSM

 protocol or the

extended SSM protocol

is started.

l This parameter 

indicates whether the

SSM is output at the

line port.l When the line port is

connected to an NE in

the same clock subnet,

set this parameter to

Enabled. Otherwise,

set this parameter to

Disabled.

 

A.7.5 Parameter Description: Clock Subset Setting_Clock IDEnabling Status

This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the clock ID function.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Subnet Configuration.

2. Click the Clock ID Status tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-106 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 291: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 291/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Line Port - -   l This parameter 

indicates the name of the line clock port.

l Line Port: indicates

the SSM quality

information output port

of the current available

line clock source and

the external clock 

source. This output port

can transmit the quality

information of the

clock source byoutputting the S1 byte

to the downstream NE.

Enabled Status Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter is valid

only when the extended

SSM protocol is

started.

l This parameter 

indicates whether the

clock source ID is

output at the line port.

l If the line ports areconnected to the NEs in

the same clock subnet

and if the extended

SSM protocol is started

on the opposite NE, this

 parameter is set to

Enabled. Otherwise,

this parameter is set to

Disabled.

 

A.7.6 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_ClockSource Restoration Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to clock source restoration.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Source Switching.

2. Click the Clock Source Reversion Parameter tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-107

Page 292: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 292/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE Name - - This parameter indicates

the name of the NE.

Higher Priority Clock 

Source Reversion Mode

Auto-Revertive

 Non-Revertive

Auto-Revertive   l When the quality of a

higher-priority clock 

source degrades, the

 NE automatically

switches the clock 

source to a lower-

 priority clock source. If 

this parameter is set to

Auto-Revertive, the

 NE automatically

switches the clock source to the higher-

 priority clock source

when this higher-

 priority clock source

restores. If this

 parameter is set to Non-

Revertive, the NE does

not automatically

switch the clock source

to the higher-priority

clock source when this

higher-priority clock source restores.

l Correct setting of 

Clock Source

Switching Condition

ensures the reliability

of the clock source

switching. To improve

the clock quality, select

Auto-Revertive.

Otherwise, to prevent

 jitter of the clock,generally, it is

recommended that you

set this parameter to

Non-Revertive.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-108 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 293: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 293/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Clock Source WTR 

Time(min.)

0 to 12 5   l This parameter 

specifies the duration

from the time when the

clock source

restoration is detected

to the time when the

clock source switching

is triggered. This

 parameter is used to

avoid frequent

switching of the clock 

source due to

unstability of the clock 

source state within a

short time.l This parameter is valid

only when Higher

Priority Clock Source

Reversion Mode is set

to Auto-Revertive.

 

A.7.7 Parameter Description: Clock Source Switching_Clock

Source Switching This topic describes the parameters that are related to the switching conditions of a clock source.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Clock Source Switching.

2. Click the Clock Source Switching tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value DescriptionClock Source - - This parameter indicates

the name of the clock 

source.

Effective Status Valid

Invalid

- This parameter indicates

whether the clock source

is valid.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-109

Page 294: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 294/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Lock Status Lock 

Unlock 

-   l This parameter 

specifies the locking

status of the clock 

source in the priority

table.

l Lock: A clock source in

the priority table is in

the locked state. The

clock source in the

locked state cannot be

switched.

l Unlock: A clock source

in the priority table is in

the unlocked state. The

clock source in the

unlocked state can be

switched.

Switching Source - - This parameter indicates

the clock source to be

traced by the NE after the

switching.

Switching Status  Normal

Manual Switching

Forced Switching

- This parameter indicates

the switching status of the

current clock source.

 

A.7.8 Parameter Description: Output Phase-Locked Source of theExternal Clock Source

This topic describes the parameters of the output phase-locked source of the external clock 

source.

Navigation PathSelect the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Clock  >

Phase-Locked Source Output by External Clock .

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

2M Phase-Locked

Source Number

External Clock Source 1

External Clock Source 2

- This parameter indicates

the number of the external

clock source output of the

 NE.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-110 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 295: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 295/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

External Clock Output

Mode

2Mbit/s

2MHz

2Mbit/s   l This parameter 

specifies the mode of 

the output clock.

l This parameter needs to

 be set according to the

requirements of the

interconnected

equipment. Generally,

the output external

clock signal is a 2 Mbit/

s signal.

External Clock Output

Timeslot

SA4 to SA8

ALL

ALL   l This parameter is valid

only when External

Clock Output Mode isset to 2Mbit/s.

l This parameter 

indicates which bit of 

the TS0 in odd frames

of the output clock 

signal is used to

transmit the SSM.

l If this parameter is set

to ALL, it indicates

that all the bits of the

TS0 are used totransmit the SSM.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-111

Page 296: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 296/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

External Source Output

Threshold

Threshold Disabled

 Not Inferior to G.813

SETS Signal Not Inferior to G.812

Local Signal

 Not Inferior to G.812

Transit Clock Signal

 Not Inferior to G.811

Clock Signal

Threshold Disabled   l This parameter 

specifies the lowest

quality of the output

clock. If the clock 

quality is lower than the

value of this parameter,

it indicates that the

external clock source

does not output any

clock signal.

l If this parameter is set

to Threshold

Disabled, it indicates

that the external clock 

source always outputsthe clock signal.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

2M Phase-Locked

Source Fail Condition

 No Failure Condition

AIS

LOF

AIS OR LOF

 No Failure Condition   l This parameter 

specifies the failure

condition of the 2 Mbit/

s phase-locked clock 

source.

l

It is recommended thatyou use the default

value.

2M Phase-Locked

Source Fail Action

Shut Down Output

2M Output S1 Byte

Unavailable

Send AIS

Shut Down Output   l This parameter is valid

only when 2M Phase-

Locked Source Fail

Condition is not set to

No Failure Condition.

l This parameter 

specifies the operation

of the 2 Mbit/s phase-

locked loop (PLL)when the 2 Mbit/s

 phase-locked clock 

source meets the failure

conditions.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-112 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 297: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 297/496

A.7.9 Parameter Description: Clock Synchronization Status

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the clock synchronization status.

Navigation PathSelect the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Clock  > Clock 

Synchronization Status.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

NE Name - - This parameter indicates

the name of the NE.

NE Clock Working

Mode

- - This parameter indicates

the working mode of the

 NE clock.

S1 Byte Synchronization

Quality Information

- - This parameter indicates

the synchronization

quality information of the

S1 byte.

S1 Byte Synchronous

Source

- - This parameter indicates

the clock synchronization

source of the S1 byte.

Synchronous Source - - This parameter indicatesthe synchronization

source.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-113

Page 298: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 298/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Data Output Method in

Holdover Mode

 Normal Data Output

Mode

Keep the Latest Data

 Normal Data Output

Mode

l When all the reference

timing signals are lost,

the slave clock changes

to the holdover mode.

At this time, the slave

clock works based on

the latest frequency

information stored

 before the reference

timing signals are lost.

Then, the frequency of 

the oscillator drifts

slowly to ensure that

the offset between the

frequency of the slaveclock and the reference

frequency is very

small. As a result, the

impact caused by the

drift is limited within

the specified

requirement.

l  Normal Data Output

Mode: The slave clock 

works based on the

latest frequency

information stored before the reference

timing signals are lost,

and the holdover 

duration depends on the

size of the phase-

locked clock register on

the equipment. The

holdover duration can

 be up to 24 hours.

l Keep the Latest Data:

The slave clock worksin holdover mode all

the time based on the

latest frequency

information stored

 before the reference

timing signals are lost.

 

A.8 Parameters for Ethernet Services

This topic describes the parameters that are related to Ethernet services.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-114 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 299: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 299/496

A.8.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

This topic describes the interface parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet line (E-Line)

service.

A.8.2 Parameter Description: E-Line ServiceThis topic describes the parameters that are related to E-Line services.

A.8.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding Table Item_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating VLAN forwarding table items.

A.8.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet local area network (E-

LAN) service.

A.8.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

This topic describes the parameters that are related to E-LAN services.

A.8.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a QinQ link.

A.8.1 Parameter Description: E-Line Service_Creation

This topic describes the interface parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet line (E-Line)

service.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2. Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID 1 to 4294967294 - This parameter specifies

the ID of the E-Line

service.

Service Name - - This parameter specifies

the name of the E-Line

service.

Direction UNI-UNI

UNI-NNI

 NNI-NNI

UNI-UNI   l This parameter 

specifies the direction

of the E-Line service.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-115

Page 300: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 300/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

BPDU  Not Transparently

Transmitted

TransparentlyTransmitted

 Not Transparently

Transmitted

l This parameter 

specifies the

transparent

transmission ID of the

 bridge protocol data

unit (BPDU) packets. It

is used to indicate

whether the E-Line

service transparently

transmits the BPDU

 packets.

l If the BPDU packets

are used as the service

 packets and

transparentlytransmitted to the

opposite end, set this

 parameter to

Transparently

Transmitted.

l In other cases, set this

 parameter to Not

Transparently

Transmitted.

l This parameter is set

according to the planning information.

MTU(byte) - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Service Tag Role - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-116 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 301: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 301/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source Port - -   l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI.

l Before setting this

 parameter, check and

ensure that the

attributes in Ethernet

Interface of the port

are set correctly and are

the same as the

 planning information.

l The value of this

 parameter cannot be the

same as the value of 

sink port.

l The value of this

 parameter cannot be

used for the E-LAN

 port.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-117

Page 302: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 302/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source VLANs 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) to

separate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to represent

a consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6

indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

l This parameter is validonly when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI.

l The number of VLANs

must be the same value

of Sink VLANs.

Otherwise, you need to

create a VLAN

forwarding table for 

swapping VLAN IDs.

l If this parameter is setto null, all the services

at the source port are

used as the service

source.

l If this parameter is not

set to null, only the

service that contains

the VLAN ID at the

source port can be used

as the service source.

Bearer Type QinQ Link QinQ Link     l Uses the QinQ link tocarry the E-Line

service.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-NNI.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-118 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 303: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 303/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

QinQ Link ID - -   l Selects the QinQ link 

ID.

l A QinQ link ID is preset in QinQ Link .

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-NNI.

Bearer Type 1 QinQ Link QinQ Link     l Uses the QinQ link to

carry the E-Line

service.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to NNI-NNI.

QinQ Link ID 1 - -   l Selects the QinQ link 

ID of the first QinQ

link.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to NNI-NNI.

l The QinQ link ID is

 preset in QinQ Link .

Bearer Type 2 QinQ Link QinQ Link     l Uses the QinQ link to

carry the E-Lineservice.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to NNI-NNI.

QinQ Link ID 2 - -   l Selects the QinQ link 

ID of the second QinQ

link.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to NNI-NNI.

l The QinQ link ID is

 preset in QinQ Link .

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-119

Page 304: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 304/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Sink Port - -   l Before setting this

 parameter, check and

ensure that the

attributes in Ethernet

Interface of the port

are set correctly and are

the same as the

 planning information.

l The value of this

 parameter cannot be the

same as the value of 

Source Port.

l The value of this

 parameter cannot be

used for the E-LAN

 port.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Sink VLANs 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) toseparate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to represent

a consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6

indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

l The number of VLANs

must be the same value

of Source VLANs.

l If this parameter is set

to null, all the services

at the sink port are used

as the service sink.

l If this parameter is not

set to null, only the

service that contains

the VLAN ID at the

sink port can be used as

the service sink.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-120 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 305: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 305/496

A.8.2 Parameter Description: E-Line Service

This topic describes the parameters that are related to E-Line services.

Navigation PathSelect the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet

Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID 1 to 4294967294 - This parameter indicates

the ID of the E-Line

service.

Service Name - - This parameter indicates

or specifies the name of 

the E-Line service.

Source Node - - This parameter indicates

the source node.

Sink Node - - This parameter indicates

the sink node.

Service Tag Role - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

MTU(byte) 1518 to 9600 - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-121

Page 306: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 306/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

BPDU  Not Transparently

Transmitted

TransparentlyTransmitted

-   l This parameter 

indicates the

transparent

transmission tag of the

 bridge protocol data

unit (BPDU) packets.

This parameter is used

to indicate whether the

Ethernet line

transparently transmits

the BPDU packets.

l If the BPDU packets

are used as the service

 packets and

transparentlytransmitted to the

opposite end, set this

 parameter to

Transparently

Transmitted.

l If the BPDU packets

are used as the protocol

 packets to compute the

spanning tree topology

of the network, set this

 parameter to Not

Transparently

Transmitted.

Active Active

Inactive

- This parameter indicates

whether E-Line service is

active.

 

Parameters Associated with UNI Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value DescriptionPort - - This parameter indicates

the UNI port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-122 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 307: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 307/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLANs 1 to 4094 - This parameter indicates

or specifies the VLAN ID

of the UNI port.

l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) to

separate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to represent

a consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI in the

 process of creating an

E-Line service.

l If this parameter is set

to null, all the services

of the UNI work as theservice source or 

service sink.

l If this parameter is not

set to null, only the

services of the UNI port

whose VLAN IDs are

included in the set

value of this parameter 

work as the service

source or service sink.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-123

Page 308: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 308/496

Parameters Associated with NNI Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

QinQ Link ID 1 to 4294967295 -   l This parameter 

indicates the QinQ link ID of the QinQ link 

connected to the NNI

 port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI in the

 process of creating an

E-Line service.

Port - -   l This parameter 

indicates the NNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI in the

 process of creating an

E-Line service.

S-VLAN ID - -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the VLAN ID of the

 NNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-NNI or 

NNI-NNI in the

 process of creating an

E-Line service.

l This parameter is preset

in QinQ Link .

 

Parameters for the Port Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the QinQ link ID of the

QinQ link connected to

the port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-124 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 309: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 309/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable Port - -   l This parameter 

indicates whether to

enable the port.

l This parameter is preset

in General Attributes

of Ethernet Interface.

Encapsulation Type  Null

802.1Q

QinQ

-   l This parameter 

indicates the

encapsulation type of 

the port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Direction is

set to UNI-UNI or 

UNI-NNI in the process of creating an

E-Line service.

l If this parameter is set

to Null, the port

transparently transmits

the received packets.

l If this parameter is set

to 802.1Q, the port

identifies the packets

that comply with the

IEEE 802.1Q standard.l If this parameter is set

to QinQ, the port

identifies the packets

that comply with the

IEEE 802.1 QinQ

standard.

l This parameter is preset

in General Attributes

of Ethernet Interface.

TAG Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

  l This parameter 

indicates the tag of the

 port.

l This parameter is preset

in Layer 2 Attributes

of Ethernet

Interface .

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-125

Page 310: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 310/496

A.8.3 Parameter Description: VLAN Forwarding TableItem_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating VLAN forwarding table items.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Service Management > E-Line Service from the Function Tree.

2. Click the VLAN Forwarding Table Item tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters for VLAN Forwarding Table Item

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source Interface Type V-UNI V-UNI This parameter specifies

the network attribute of 

the source interface.

Source Interface - - This parameter specifies

the source interface.

Source VLAN ID 1 to 4094 - This parameter specifies

the VLAN ID of the

source service.

Sink Interface Type V-UNI V-UNI This parameter specifies

the network attribute of the sink interface.

Sink Interface - - This parameter specifies

the sink interface.

Sink VLAN ID 1 to 4094 - This parameter specifies

the VLAN ID of the sink 

service.

 

NOTE

l The VLAN ID of the UNI-UNI E-Line service can be converted after a VLAN forwarding table item is

created. In this case, a service from Source Interface to Sink Interface carries the VLAN ID specified in

Sink VLAN ID when the service is transmitted from Sink Interface.

l The VLAN ID in a VLAN forwarding table item is converted unidirectionally and can be converted from

Source VLAN ID to Sink VLAN ID only. The VLAN ID can be converted bidirectionally only when the

other VLAN forwarding table item is configured reversely.

l In normal cases, Ethernet services are bidirectional. Hence, you need to set bidirectional conversion of 

VLAN IDs.

A.8.4 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating an Ethernet local area network (E-LAN) service.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-126 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 311: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 311/496

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.

2. Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID 1 to 4294967294 -   l This parameter 

specifies the ID of the

E-LAN service.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports simultaneous

creation of an E-LAN

service only.

Service Name - - This parameter specifies

the name of the E-LAN

service.

BPDU - -   l This parameter 

indicates the

transparent

transmission tag of the

BPDU packets.

l In the case of an E-

LAN service, this parameter supports

only transparent

transmission of the

BPDU packets and

cannot be set manually.

l Not Transparently

Transmitted indicates

that the BPDU packets

are used as the protocol

 packets to compute the

spanning tree topology

of the network.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-127

Page 312: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 312/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Tag Type C-Awared

S-Awared

Tag-Transparent

C-Awared   l C-Awared indicates

that the packets are

learnt according to C-

Tag (the VLAN tag on

the client-side). To

create the 802.1q

 bridge, set this

 parameter to C-

Awared.

l S-Awared indicates

that the packets are

learnt according to S-

Tag (the VLAN tag at

the carrier service

layer). To create the802.1ad bridge, set this

 parameter to S-

Awared.

l Tag-Transparent

indicates that only the

Ethernet packets that

do not contain VLAN

tags are accessed. To

create the 802.1d

 bridge, set this

 parameter to Tag-

Transparent.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-128 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 313: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 313/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Self-Learning MAC

Address

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter 

specifies whether to

enable the MAC

address self-learning

function.

l If the MAC self-

learning function of an

Ethernet LAN is

enabled, the Ethernet

LAN learns an MAC

address according to

the original MAC

address in the packet

and automatically

refreshes the MACaddress forwarding

table.

l If the MAC self-

learning function of an

Ethernet LAN is

disabled, a static MAC

address forwarding

table needs to be

configured. Otherwise,

the Ethernet LAN fails

to forward the services.

MAC Address Learning

Mode

- -   l This parameter 

indicates the mode used

to learn an MAC

address.

l When the bridge uses

the SVL mode, all the

VLANs share one

MAC address table. If 

the bridge uses the IVL

mode, each VLAN has

an MAC address table.

MTU(byte) - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Service Tag Role - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-129

Page 314: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 314/496

Parameters for UNIs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the UNI port.

SVLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the S-VLAN

ID of the UNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Tag Type is

set to S-Awared.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

VLANs/CVLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the VLAN ID

of the UNI port.

l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) to

separate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to representa consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6

indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

l If this parameter is set

to null, all the services

of the UNI work as the

service source or 

service sink.

l

If this parameter is notset to null, only the

services of the UNI port

whose VLAN IDs are

included in the set

value of this parameter 

work as the service

source or service sink.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-130 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 315: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 315/496

Page 316: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 316/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Split Horizon Group

Member

- -   l A split horizon group

member indicates the

logical port member in

the split horizon group.

l The port members that

are added to the same

split horizon group

cannot communicate

with each other.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports only the

division of the split

horizon group

members according to

the Ethernet physical

 port.

l If a UNI or NNI logical

 port of the 802.1ad

 bridge is added to a

split horizon group

member, the physical

 port that is mounted

with the logical port is

automatically added to

the split horizon group

member.

 

A.8.5 Parameter Description: E-LAN Service

This topic describes the parameters that are related to E-LAN services.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet

Service Management > E-LAN Service from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID 1 to 4294967294 -   l This parameter 

indicates the ID of the

E-LAN service.

l The supports

simultaneous creation

of an E-LAN service

only.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-132 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 317: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 317/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service Name - - This parameter specifies

the name of the E-LAN

service.

BPDU - -   l This parameter 

indicates the

transparent

transmission tag of the

BPDU packets.

l In the case of an E-

LAN service, this

 parameter supports

only transparent

transmission of the

BPDU packets andcannot be set manually.

l Not Transparently

Transmitted indicates

that the BPDU packets

are used as the protocol

 packets to compute the

spanning tree topology

of the network.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-133

Page 318: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 318/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Tag Type C-Awared

S-Awared

Tag-Transparent

C-Awared   l C-Awared indicates

that the packets are

learnt according to C-

Tag (the VLAN tag on

the client-side). To

create the 802.1q

 bridge, set this

 parameter to C-

Awared.

l S-Awared indicates

that the packets are

learnt according to S-

Tag (the VLAN tag at

the carrier service

layer). To create the802.1ad bridge, set this

 parameter to S-

Awared.

l Tag-Transparent

indicates that only the

Ethernet packets that

do not contain VLAN

tags are accessed. To

create the 802.1d

 bridge, set this

 parameter to S-

Awared.

Self-Learning MAC

Address

Enabled Enabled   l This parameter 

indicates whether to

enable the MAC

address self-learning

function.

l If the MAC self-

learning function of an

Ethernet LAN is

enabled, the Ethernet

LAN learns an MACaddress according to

the original MAC

address in the packet

and automatically

refreshes the MAC

address forwarding

table.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-134 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 319: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 319/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MAC Address Learning

Mode

- -   l This parameter 

indicates the mode used

to learn an MAC

address.

l When the bridge uses

the SVL mode, all the

VLANs share one

MAC address table. If 

the bridge uses the IVL

mode, each VLAN has

an MAC address table.

MTU(byte) - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Service Tag Role - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

 

Parameters for UNIs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the UNI port.

SVLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the S-VLAN

ID of the UNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Tag Type is

set to S-Awared.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-135

Page 320: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 320/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLANs/CVLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the VLAN ID

of the UNI port.

l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) to

separate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to represent

a consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

l If this parameter is set

to null, the E-LAN

service exclusively

uses the corresponding

UNI physical port. That

is, the entire port is

mounted to the bridge.

l If this parameter is set

to a non-null value,only the corresponding

UNI port whose service

 packets contain this

VLAN ID works as the

logical port and is

mounted to the bridge.

 

Parameters for NNIs

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - -   l This parameter 

indicates the NNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Tag Type is

set to S-Awared.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-136 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 321: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 321/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

SVLANs - -   l This parameter 

specifies the S-VLAN

ID of the UNI port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Tag Type is

set to S-Awared.

l This parameter can be

set to null, a number, or 

several numbers. When

setting this parameter 

to several numbers, use

the comma (,) to

separate the discrete

numbers, or use the

endash (-) to represent

a consecutive number.

For example, the

numbers 1, and 3-6

indicate 1, 3, 4, 5, and

6.

 

Parameters for Static MAC Addresses

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLAN ID - 1   l This parameter is

invalid if MAC

Address Learning

Mode is SVL. That is,

the preset static MAC

address entries are

valid for all VLANs.

l If MAC Address

Learning Mode is set

to IVL, the preset static

MAC address entriesare valid for only the

VLANs whose VLAN

ID is equal to the preset

VLAN ID.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-137

Page 322: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 322/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MAC Address - -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the static MAC

address.

l A static MAC address

is an address that is set

manually. It is not aged

automatically and

needs to be deleted

manually.

l Generally, a static

MAC address is used

for the port that

receives but does not

forward Ethernet

service packets or the

 port whose MAC

address need not be

aged automatically.

Egress Interface - -   l This parameter 

specifies the Ethernet

 port that corresponds to

the MAC address.

l This parameter is set

according to the planning information.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-138 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 323: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 323/496

Parameters for Self-Learning MAC Address

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLAN ID - 1   l This parameter is

invalid if MACAddress Learning

Mode is SVL. That is,

the preset self-learning

MAC address entries

are valid for all

VLANs.

l If MAC Address

Learning Mode is set

to IVL, the preset self-

learning MAC address

entries are valid for only the VLANs whose

VLAN ID is equal to

the preset VLAN ID.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

MAC Address - -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the self-learning MAC

address. A self-

learning MAC addressis also called a dynamic

MAC address.

l A self-learning MAC

address is an entry

obtained by a bridge in

SVL or IVL learning

mode. A self-learning

MAC address can be

aged.

Egress Interface - -   l This parameter 

specifies the Ethernet port that corresponds to

the MAC address.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-139

Page 324: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 324/496

Parameters Associated with MAC Address Learning 

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Aging Ability Enabled

Disabled

Enabled The OptiX RTN 950

supports enabling/disabling of the aging

function and aging time

for the MAC address

table.

If one routing entry is not

updated in a certain

 period, that is, if no new

 packet from this MAC

address is received to

enable the re-learning of 

this MAC address, this

routing entry is

automatically deleted.

This mechanism is called

aging, and this period is

called aging time. The

aging time of a MAC

address table is 5 minutes

 by default.

Aging Time(min) - 5

 

Parameters for Disabled MAC Addresses

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLAN ID - 1 This parameter indicates

or specifies the VLAN ID

of the service. A disabled

MAC address is valid for 

the VLAN whose VLAN

ID is equal to the preset

VLAN ID.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-140 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 325: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 325/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MAC Address - -   l This parameter 

specifies or indicates

the disabled MAC

address. A disabled

MAC address is also

called a blacklisted

MAC address.

l This parameter is used

for discarding an entry,

also called a black hole

entry, whose data

frame that contains a

specific destination

MAC address. A

disabled MAC addressneeds to be set

manually and cannot be

aged.

 

Parameters for Unknown Frame Processing 

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Frame Type Unicast

Multicast

1 This parameter indicates

the type of the receivedunknown frame.

Handing Mode Discard

Broadcast

Broadcast Selects the method of  

 processing the unknown

frame. If this parameter is

set to Discard, the

unknown frame is directly

discarded. If this

 parameter is set to

Broadcast, the unknown

frame is broadcast at the

forwarding port.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-141

Page 326: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 326/496

Parameters for the Split Horizon Group

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Split Horizon Group ID - 1   l This parameter 

indicates the ID of thesplit horizon group.

l The default split

horizon group ID is 1

and cannot be set

manually.

Split Horizon Group

Member

- -   l A split horizon group

member indicates the

logical port member in

the split horizon group.

l

The port members thatare added to different

split horizon groups

cannot communicate

with each other.

l The supports only the

division of the split

horizon group

members according to

the Ethernet physical

 port.

l If a UNI or NNI logical

 port of the 802.1ad

 bridge is added to a

split horizon group

member, the physical

 port that is mounted

with the logical port is

automatically added to

the split horizon group

member.

 

Maintenance Association Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the created maintenance

association.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-142 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 327: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 327/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Association Name

- -   l This parameter specifies the name of the

maintenance association, which is a

domain related to a service. Through

maintenance association division, the

connectivity check (CC) can be

 performed on the network that transmits

a service instance.

l This parameter can contain a maximum

of eight bytes.

CC Test Transmit

Period

1s

10s

1m

10m

1s   l This parameter specifies the interval for 

transmitting packets in the CC test.

l The CC is performed to check the

availability of the service.

 

Parameters for the MEP

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the created MEP.

Maintenance

Association Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

association of the created MEP.

Node - - This parameter indicates the MEP node.

VLAN - - This parameter indicates the VLAN ID of  

the current service.

MP ID 1 to 2048 1   l This parameter specifies the MEP ID.

l Each MEP needs to be configured with

an MEP ID, which is unique in the

maintenance association. The MEP ID is

required in the OAM operation.

Direction Ingress

Egress

Ingress   l This parameter specifies the direction of 

the MEP.

l "Ingress" indicates the direction in which

the packets are transmitted to the port,

and "Egress" indicates the direction in

which the packets are transmitted from

the port.

CC Status Active

Inactive

Active   l This parameter specifies whether to

enable the CC function of the MEP.

l In the case of the tests based on the MP

IDs, CC Status must be set to Active.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-143

Page 328: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 328/496

A.8.6 Parameter Description: QinQ Link_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a QinQ link.

Navigation Path1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Service Management > QinQ Link  from the Function Tree.

2. Click New.

Parameters for the General Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

QinQ Link ID 1 to 4294967295 - This parameter specifies

the ID of the QinQ link.

NOTEThe OptiX RTN 950

supports 1024 QinQ links,

whose IDs must be different

from each other.

Board - - This parameter specifies

the board where the QinQ

link is located.

Port - - This parameter specifies

the port where the QinQ

link is located.

S-Vlan ID 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the VLAN ID

(at the network 

operator side) for the

QinQ link.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

 

A.9 Ethernet Protocol Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet protocol.

A.9.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating ERPS management tasks.

A.9.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS)

management.

A.9.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group CreationThis topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-144 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 329: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 329/496

A.9.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port Group Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

A.9.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ Bridge Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to MSTP bridges.

A.9.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CIST Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the MSTP CIST.

A.9.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About the CIST

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the running information about the MSTP

CIST.

A.9.8 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Protocol Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the IGMP snooping protocol.

A.9.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Adding Port to Be Quickly

Deleted

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding a port to be quickly deleted.

A.9.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for IGMP Snooping protocol route

management.

A.9.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuraiton_Static Router Port Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding static router ports.

A.9.12 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Member Port

Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the route member ports of the

IGMP Snooping protocol.

A.9.13 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Static Multicast Group Member 

Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding static multicast groups.

A.9.14 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Data Statistics

This topic describes the parameters that are used for collecting the data statistics of the IGMP

Snooping protocol.

A.9.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation Management_LAG Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a link aggregation group (LAG).

A.9.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_Port Priority

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the port priority of a LAG.

A.9.17 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating LPT management.

A.9.18 Parameter Description: Port Mirroring_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port mirroring tasks.

A.9.1 Parameter Description: ERPS Management_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating ERPS management tasks.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-145

Page 330: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 330/496

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protection > ERPS Management.

2. Click New.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ERPS ID 1 to 8 -   l This parameter 

specifies the ID of the

Ethernet ring

 protection switching

(ERPS) instance.

l The IDs of ERPS

instances on an NEmust be different from

each other.

East Port - - This parameter specifies

the east port of the ERPS

instance.

West Port - - This parameter specifies

the west port of the ERPS

instance.

RPLOwner Ring Node

Flag

Yes

 No

 No   l This parameter 

specifies whether thenode on the ring is the

ring protection link 

(RPL) owner.

l Only one node on the

ring can be set as the

RPL owner for each

Ethernet ring.

RPL Port - -   l This parameter 

specifies the RPL port.

l

There is only one RPL port and this RPL port

must be the east or west

 port on the RPL owner 

node.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-146 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 331: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 331/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Control VLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

specifies the VLAN ID

of Control VLAN.

l Each node on the

Ethernet ring transmits

the R-APS packets on

the dedicated ring APS

(R-APS) channel to

ensure consistency

 between the nodes

when the ERPS

switching is performed.

Control VLAN is used

for isolating the

dedicated R-APSchannel. Therefore, the

VLAN ID in Control

VLAN cannot be

duplicate with the

VLAN IDs that are

contained in the service

 packets or inband DCN

 packets.

l The Control VLAN

must be set to the same

value for all the NEs on

an ERPS ring.

Destination Node 01-19-A7-00-00-01 01-19-A7-00-00-01 This parameter indicates

the MAC address of the

destination node. The

default destination MAC

address in the R-APS

 packets is always 01-19-

A7-00-00-01.

 

A.9.2 Parameter Description: ERPS Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for Ethernet ring protection switching (ERPS)

management.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Ethernet

Protection > ERPS Management from the Function Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-147

Page 332: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 332/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ERPS ID 1 to 8 - This parameter indicates

the ID of the ERPSinstance.

East Port - - This parameter indicates

the east port of the ERPS

instance.

West Port - - This parameter indicates

the west port of the ERPS

instance.

RPL Owner Ring Node

Flag

Yes

 No

- This parameter indicates

whether a node on the ring

is the ring protection link 

(RPL) owner.

RPL Port - - This parameter indicates

the RPL port.

Control VLAN 1 to 4094 -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the VLAN ID of 

Control VLAN.

l Each node on the

Ethernet ring transmits

the R-APS packets onthe dedicated ring APS

(R-APS) channel to

ensure consistency

 between the nodes

when the ERPS

switching is performed.

Control VLAN is used

for isolating the

dedicated R-APS

channel. Therefore, the

VLAN ID in Control

VLAN cannot be

duplicate with the

VLAN IDs that are

contained in the service

 packets or inband DCN

 packets.

l The Control VLAN

must be set to the same

value for all the NEs on

an ERPS ring.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-148 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 333: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 333/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Destination Node 01-19-A7-00-00-01 - This parameter indicates

the MAC address of the

destination node. The

default destination MAC

address in the R-APS

 packets is always 01-19-

A7-00-00-01.

Hold-Off Time(ms) 0 to 10000, in step of 100 -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the hold-off time of the

ERPS hold-off timer.

l The hold-off timer is

used for negotiating the

 protection switchingsequence when the

ERPS coexists with

other protection

schemes so that the

fault can be rectified in

the case of other 

 protection switching

(such as LAG

 protection) before the

ERPS occurs. When a

node on the ring detects

one or more new faults,it starts up the hold-off 

timer if the preset hold-

off time is set to a value

that is not 0. During the

hold-off time, the fault

is not reported to

trigger an ERPS. When

the hold-off timer times

out, the node checks the

link status regardless

whether the fault that

triggers the startup of the timer exists. If the

fault exists, the node

reports it to trigger an

ERPS. This fault can be

the same as or different

from the fault that

triggers the initial

startup of the hold-off 

timer.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-149

Page 334: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 334/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Guard Time(ms) 10 to 2000, in step of 10 -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the guard time of the

ERPS guard timer.

l The nodes on the ring

continuously forward

the R-APS packets to

the Ethernet ring. As a

result, the outdated R-

APS packets may exist

on the ring network.

After a node on the ring

receives the outdated

R-APS packets, an

incorrect ERPS mayoccur. The ERPS guard

timer is an R-APS timer 

used for preventing a

node on the ring from

receiving outdated R-

APS packets. When a

faulty node on the ring

detects that the

switching condition is

cleared, the node starts

up the guard timer and

starts to forward the R-APS (NR) packets.

During this period, the

R-APS packets

received by the node

are discarded. The

received R-APS

 packets are forwarded

only after the time of 

the guard timer expires.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-150 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 335: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 335/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

WTR Time(min) 5 to 12, in step of 1 -   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

the WTR time of the

WRT timer in the case

of ERPS protection.

l The WTR time refers to

the duration from the

time when the working

channel is restored to

the time when the

switching is released.

When the working

channel is restored, the

WTR timer of the RPL

owner starts up. Inaddition, a signal that

indicates the operation

of the WTR timer is

continuously output in

the timing process.

When the WTR timer 

times out and no

switching request of a

higher priority is

received, the signal

indicating the

operation of the WTR timer is not transmitted.

In addition, the WTR 

release signal is

continuously output.

l The WTR timer is used

to prevent frequent

switching caused by the

unstable working

channel.

Packet Transmit

Interval(s)

1 to 10 - This parameter displays or  

specifies the interval for 

sending R-APS packets

 periodically.

Entity Level 0 to 7 - This parameter indicates

or specifies the level of the

maintenance entity.

Last Switching Request - - This parameter indicates

the last switching request.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-151

Page 336: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 336/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

RB Status - - This parameter indicates

the RB status of the

 packets received by the

working node.

l noRB: The RPL is not

 blocked.

l RB (RPL Blocked):

The RPL is blocked.

DNF Status - - This parameter indicates

the DNF status of the

 packets received by the

working node.

l noDNF: The R-APS

 packets do not contain

the DNF flag. In this

case, the packets are

forwarded by the node

that detects the fault on

a non-RPL link, and the

node that receives the

 packets is requested to

clear the forwarding

address table.

l DNF: The R-APS

 packets contain theDNF flags. In this case,

the packets are

forwarded by the node

that detects the fault on

an RPL link, and the

node that receives the

 packets is informed not

to clear the forwarding

address table.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-152 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 337: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 337/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Status of State Machine - - This parameter indicates

the status of the state

machine at the working

node.

l Idle: The Ethernet ring

is in normal state. For 

example, no node on

the Ethernet ring

detects any faults or 

receive the R_APS

(NR, RB) packets.

l Protection: The

Ethernet ring is in

 protected state. For 

example, a fault on the

node triggers the

ERPS, or a node on the

ring is in the WTR 

 period after the fault is

rectified.

Node Carried with

Current Packet

- - This parameter indicates

the MAC address carried

in the R-APS packets

received by the current

node. The MAC address

refers to the MAC addressof the source node that

initiates the switching

request.

 

A.9.3 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port GroupCreation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Port Group Parameters tab.

3. Click Create. The Create Port Group dialog box is displayed.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-153

Page 338: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 338/496

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Protocol Type MSTP

STP

MSTP This parameter specifies

the protocol type.

l MSTP: stands for 

Multiple Spanning

Tree Protocol. The

OptiX RTN 950

supports the CIST

MSTP only.

l STP: stands for 

Spanning Tree

Protocol.

Enable Protocol EnabledDisabled

Disabled  l

This parameter specifies whether to

enable the protocol of 

the port group or a

member port in the port

group.

l If the STP or MSTP is

enabled, the spanning

tree topology is

automatically re-

configured. As a result,

the services are

interrupted.

 

Parameters for Application Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter specifies

the board where the

member of port group is

located.

Available Port List - - This parameter indicates

the available port list in

which a port can be added

to the port group.

Selected Port List - - This parameter indicates

the selected ports that can

 be added to the port group.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-154 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 339: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 339/496

A.9.4 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Port GroupConfiguration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating MSTP port groups.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Port Group Parameters tab.

3. On the main interface, select the port group to be configured.

4. Click Config. The Configure Port Group dialog box is displayed.

Parameters for the Added Port

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter specifies

the board where the

member of port group is

located.

Available Port List - - This parameter indicates

the available port list in

which a port needs to be

added to the port group.

Selected Port List - - This parameter indicatesthe selected ports that

need to be added to the

 port group.

 

A.9.5 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_ BridgeParameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to MSTP bridges.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Bridge Parameters tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-155

Page 340: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 340/496

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Group ID - -   l This parameter 

indicates the ID of the port group.

l This parameter can be

set to only the port

group ID that is

automatically

allocated.

MST Domain Name - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Redaction Level - - The OptiX RTN 950 doesnot support this

 parameter.

Mapping List - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

 

Bridge Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Group ID - -   l This parameter 

indicates the ID of the

 port group.

l This parameter can be

set to only the port

Group ID that is

automatically

allocated.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-156 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 341: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 341/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Network Diameter 2 to 7 7   l This parameter 

specifies the MSTP

network diameter.

l Network Diameter is

related to the link 

whose number of 

switches is the most

and is indicated by the

number of switches that

are connected to the

link. When you set

Network Diameter for 

the switches, the MSTP

automatically sets Max

Age(s), Hello Time(s),and Forward Delay(s)

to the more appropriate

values for the switches.

l If the value of Network 

Diameter is greater,

the network is in a

larger scale.

Hello Time(s) - 2   l This parameter 

specifies the interval

for transmitting the

CBPDU packetsthrough the bridge.

l The greater the value of 

this parameter, the less

the network resources

that are occupied by the

spanning tree. The

topology stability,

however, decreases.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-157

Page 342: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 342/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Max Age(s) 6 to 40 20   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

age of the CBPDU

 packet that is recorded

 by the port.

l The greater the value,

the longer the

transmission distance

of the CBPDU, which

indicates that the

network diameter is

greater. When the value

of this parameter is

greater, it is less

 possible that the bridgedetects the link fault in

a timely manner and

thus the network 

adaptation ability is

reduced.

Forward Delay(s) 4 to 30 15   l This parameter 

specifies the holdoff 

time of a port in the

listening state and in

the learning state.

l The greater the value,the longer the delay of 

the network state

change. Hence, the

topology changes are

slower and the recovery

in the case of faults is

slower.

 

Port ParametersParameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port in the port group.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-158 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 343: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 343/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable Edge Attribute Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter 

specifies the

management edge

attributes of the port.

l This parameter 

specifies whether to set

the port as an edge port.

The edge port refers to

the bridge port that is

connected to the LAN.

In normal cases, this

 port does not receive or 

transmit BPDU

messages.

l This parameter can be

set to Enabled only

when the port is

directly connected to

the data

communications

terminal equipment,

such as a computer. In

other cases, it is

recommended that you

use the default value.

Actual Edge Attribute - - This parameter indicatesthe actual management

edge attributes of the port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-159

Page 344: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 344/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Point-to-Point Attribute false

true

auto

auto   l This parameter 

specifies the point-to-

 point attribute of the

 port.

l false: forced non-

 point-to-point link 

attribute

l true: forced point-to-

 point link attribute

l auto: automatically

detected point-to-point

link attribute

l If this parameter is set

to auto, the bridgedetermines Actual

Point-to-Point

Attribute of the port

according to the actual

working mode. If the

actual working mode is

full-duplex, the actual

 point-to-point attribute

is true. If the actual

working mode is half-

duplex, Actual Point-

to-Point Attribute isfalse.

l Only the designated

 port whose Actual

Point-to-Point

Attribute is "True" can

transmit the rapid state

migration request and

response.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

Actual Point-to-Point

Attribute

- - This parameter indicates

the actual point-to-point

attribute of the port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-160 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 345: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 345/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Max Transmit Packet

Count

1 to 255 3   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

number of packets to be

transmitted.

l The maximum number 

of packets to be

transmitted by the port

refers to the maximum

number of MSTP

 packets that the port

can transmit within 1s.

l This parameter needs to

 be set according to the

 planning information.

 

A.9.6 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_CISTParameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the MSTP CIST.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the CIST&MSTI Parameters tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Group - - This parameter specifies

the port group.

MSTI ID 0 0 This parameter indicates

the MSTI ID. The value 0

indicates common and

internal spanning tree

(CIST). TheOptiX RTN

950 supports only the

MSTP that uses CIST.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-161

Page 346: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 346/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Bridge Priority 0 to 61440, in step of 4096 32768   l The most significant 16

 bits of the bridge ID

indicates the priority of 

the bridge.

l When the value is

smaller, the priority is

higher. As a result, the

 bridge is more possible

to be selected as the

root bridge.

l If the priorities of all

the bridges in the STP

network use the same

value, the bridge whose

MAC address is the

smallest is selected as

the root bridge.

 

Port Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port in the port group.

Priority 0 to 240, in step of 16 128   l The most significant

eight bits of the port ID

indicate the port

 priority.

l When the value is

smaller, the priority is

higher.

Path Cost 1 to 200000000 200000   l This parameter 

indicates the status of 

the network that the

 port is connected to.

l In the case of the

 bridges on both ends of 

the path, set this

 parameter to the same

value.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-162 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 347: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 347/496

A.9.7 Parameter Description: MSTP Configuration_Running Information About the CIST

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the running information about the MSTP

CIST.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > MSTP Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the CIST Running Information tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Group ID - - This parameter indicates

the ID of the port group.

Protocol Running Mode MSTP

STP

Disabled   l This parameter 

indicates the running

mode of the protocol.

l MSTP: stands for 

Multiple Spanning

Tree Protocol. The

OptiX RTN 950

supports only the

CIST-based MSTP.l STP: stands for 

Spanning Tree

Protocol.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-163

Page 348: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 348/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Bridge Priority 0 to 61440, in step of 4096 32768   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

the bridge.

l The most significant 16

 bits of the bridge ID

indicates the priority of 

the bridge.

l When the value is

smaller, the priority is

higher. As a result, the

 bridge is more possible

to be selected as the

root bridge.

l

If the priorities of allthe bridges in the STP

network use the same

value, the bridge whose

MAC address is the

smallest is selected as

the root bridge.

Bridge MAC Address - - This parameter indicates

the MAC address of the

 bridge.

Root Bridge MAC

Address

- - This parameter indicates

the MAC address of theroot bridge.

External Path Cost

ERPC

- - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Domain Root Bridge

Priority

- - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Domain Root Bridge

MAC Address

- - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

Internal Path Cost IRPC - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-164 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 349: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 349/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Root Port Priority 0 to 240, in step of 16 128   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

the root port.

l The most significant

eight bits of the ID of 

the root port indicate

the priority of the root

 port.

l When the value is

smaller, the priority is

higher.

Root Port - - This parameter indicates

the root port.

Hello Time(s) - 2   l This parameter 

indicates the interval

for transmitting

CBPDU packets

through the bridge.

l The greater the value of 

this parameter, the less

the network resources

that are occupied by the

spanning tree. The

topology stability,

however, decreases.

Max Age(s) 6 to 40 20   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

age of the CBPDU

 packet that is recorded

 by the port.

l The greater the value,

the longer the

transmission distance

of the CBPDU, which

indicates that the

network diameter is

greater. When the value

of this parameter is

greater, it is less

 possible that the bridge

detects the link fault in

a timely manner and

thus the network 

adaptation ability is

reduced.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-165

Page 350: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 350/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Forward Delay(s) 4 to 30 15   l This parameter 

specifies the holdoff 

time of a port in the

listening state and in

the learning state.

l The greater the value,

the longer the delay of 

the network state

change. Hence, the

topology changes are

slower and the recovery

in the case of faults is

slower.

MST Domain Max HopCount

- - The OptiX RTN 950 doesnot support this

 parameter.

Topology Change Count - - This parameter indicates

the identifier of the

topology change.

Last Topology Change

Time(s)

- - This parameter indicates

the duration of the last

topology change.

Topology Change Count - - This parameter indicates

the count of the topologychanges.

 

Port Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port in the port group.

Enable Protocol EnabledDisabled

Disabled This parameter indicateswhether the protocol of 

the port group or a

member of the port group

is enabled.

Port Role - - This parameter indicates

the role of a port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-166 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 351: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 351/496

Page 352: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 352/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Bridge MAC Address - - This parameter indicates

the MAC address of the

 bridge.

Designated Port Priority 0 to 240, in step of 16 128   l The most significant

eight bits of the port ID

indicate the port

 priority.

l When the value is

smaller, the priority is

higher.

Design Port - - This parameter indicates

the designated port.

Edge Port Attribute Disabled

Enabled

Enabled   l This parameter specifies the

management edge

attributes of the port.

l This parameter 

specifies whether to set

the port as an edge port.

The edge port refers to

the bridge port that is

connected to the LAN.

In normal cases, this

 port does not receive or transmit BPDU

messages.

l This parameter can be

set to Enabled only

when the port is

directly connected to

the data

communications

terminal equipment,

such as a computer. In

other cases, it is

recommended that youuse the default value.

Actual Edge Port

Attribute

- - This parameter indicates

the actual management

edge attributes of the port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-168 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 353: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 353/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Point to Point false

true

auto

auto   l This parameter 

specifies the point-to-

 point attribute of the

 port.

l false: forced non-

 point-to-point link 

attribute

l true: forced point-to-

 point link attribute

l auto: automatically

detected point-to-point

link attribute

l If this parameter is set

to auto, the bridgedetermines Actual

Point to Point

Attribute of the port

according to the actual

working mode. If the

actual working mode is

full-duplex, the actual

 point-to-point attribute

is true. If the actual

working mode is half-

duplex, Actual Point

to Point Attribute isfalse.

l Only the designated

 port whose Actual

Point-to-Point

Attribute is "True" can

transmit the rapid state

migration request and

response.

l It is recommended that

you use the default

value.

Actual Point to Point - - This parameter indicates

the actual point-to-point

attribute of the port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-169

Page 354: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 354/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Max Count of 

Transmitting Message

1 to 255 3   l This parameter 

indicates the maximum

number of packets to be

transmitted.

l The maximum number 

of packets to be

transmitted by the port

refers to the maximum

number of MSTP

 packets that the port

can transmit within 1s.

Protocol Running Mode STP

MSTP

-   l This parameter 

indicates the running

mode of the protocol.l MSTP: stands for 

Multiple Spanning

Tree Protocol. The

OptiX RTN 950

supports only the

CIST-based MSTP.

l STP: stands for 

Spanning Tree

Protocol.

Hello Time(s) 1 to 10 2   l This parameter 

indicates the intervalfor transmitting the

CBPDU packets

through the bridge.

l The greater the value of 

this parameter, the less

the network resources

that are occupied by the

spanning tree. The

topology stability,

however, decreases.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-170 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 355: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 355/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Max Age(s) 6 to 40 20   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

age of the CBPDU

 packet that is recorded

 by the port.

l The greater the value,

the longer the

transmission distance

of the CBPDU, which

indicates that the

network diameter is

greater. When the value

of this parameter is

greater, it is less

 possible that the bridgedetects the link fault in

a timely manner and

thus the network 

adaptation ability is

reduced.

Forward Delay(s) 4 to 30 15   l This parameter 

specifies the holding

time of a port in the

listening state and in

the learning state.

l The greater the value,the longer the delay of 

the network state

change. Hence, the

topology changes are

slower and the recovery

in the case of faults is

slower.

Remain Hop - - The OptiX RTN 950 does

not support this

 parameter.

 

A.9.8 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Protocol Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the IGMP snooping protocol.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >EthernetProtocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-171

Page 356: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 356/496

2. Click the Protocol Configuration tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value DescriptionService ID - - This parameter indicates

the service ID.

Enabled Protocol Enabled

Disabled

Disabled   l This parameter 

specifies whether to

enable the IGMP

Snooping protocol.

l If the bridge accesses a

LAN where the IGMP

multicast server exists,

you can enable the

IGMP Snooping

 protocol according to

the requirement.

Router Port Aging Time

(min)

1 to 120 8   l If an entry is not

updated in a certain

 period (that is, no

IGMP query packet is

received), this entry is

automatically deleted.

This mechanism is

called aging, and this

 period is called aging

time.

l If this parameter is set

to a very large value,

the bridge stores

excessive multicast

entries that are

outdated.

Consequently, the

resources of the

multicast table are

exhausted.l If this parameter is set

to a very small value,

the bridge may delete

the multicast entry that

is required.

Consequently, the

forwarding efficiency

decreases.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-172 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 357: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 357/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maximum Times of No

Response from Multicast

Members

1 to 4 3   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

number of multicast

group members who do

not respond.

l If the IEEE 802.1q

 bridge transmits an

IGMP group query

 packet to the multicast

member ports, the

IEEE 802.1q bridge

starts the timer for the

query of the maximum

number of responses. If 

no IGMP report packets are received

within the query time,

the IEEE 802.1q bridge

adds one to the number 

of no responses at the

 port. When the number 

of no responses

exceeds the preset

value of Maximum

Times of No Response

from Multicast

Members, the IEEE802.1q bridge deletes

the additional multicast

members from the

multicast group.

Maximum Number of 

Multicast Groups

- -   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

number of allowable

multicast groups.

l The multicast group

records the mapping

relations between the

 ports on the router,

MAC multicast

addresses, and member 

 ports in the multicast

group.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-173

Page 358: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 358/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maximum Number of 

Multicast Group

Members

- -   l This parameter 

specifies the maximum

number of allowable

multicast group

members.

l A multicast group

member refers to the

host that is added to a

multicast group.

Actual Multicast Count - - This parameter indicates

the number of actually

used multicast groups.

Actual Multicast

Members Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of actually

used multicast group

members.

 

A.9.9 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Adding Port to Be Quickly Deleted

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding a port to be quickly deleted.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Protocol Configuration tab.

3. Click Add.

Parameters for Fast Leave Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter indicates

the service ID.

VLAN ID 1 to 4094 1   l This parameter 

specifies the VLAN

where the port to be

quickly deleted is

located.

l This parameter needs to

 be set according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-174 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 359: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 359/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Type V-UNI

V-NNI

V-UNI   l This parameter 

specifies the type of the

 port to be quickly

deleted.

l This parameter needs to

 be set according to the

 planning information.

Port - - This parameter specifies

the port to be quickly

deleted.

 

A.9.10 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for IGMP Snooping protocol route

management.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Router Port Management tab.

Parameters for Router Port Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter specifies

the ID of the created E-

LAN service.

VLAN ID 1 1 to 4094 This parameter indicates

the VLAN ID of the router 

 port.

Port Type - - This parameter indicates

the type of the router port.

Port - - This parameter indicates

the router port.

Port Status - - This parameter indicates

the status of the router 

 port.

Port Creating Time - - This parameter indicates

the time when the router 

 port is created.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-175

Page 360: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 360/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port Remainder Aging

Time(min)

- - This parameter indicates

the remaining aging time

of the router port.

 

A.9.11 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuraiton_Static Router Port Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding static router ports.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >EthernetProtocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Router Port Management tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters for Router Port Creation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter specifies

the ID of the created E-

LAN service.

VLAN ID 1 1 to 4094 This parameter indicates

the VLAN ID of the router 

 port.

Available Port - - This parameter indicates

the available ports.

Selected Port - - This parameter indicates

the specified router port.

 

A.9.12 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Route Member Port Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing the route member ports of the

IGMP Snooping protocol.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Route Member Port Management tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-176 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 361: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 361/496

Parameters for Multicast Groups Information

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter specifies

the ID of the created E-LAN service.

VLAN ID 1 1 to 4094 This parameter indicates

the VLAN ID of the

multicast group.

Multicast MAC Address - - This parameter indicates

the multicast MAC

address.

Multicast Groups Type - - This parameter indicates

the type of the multicast

group.

Multicast Group

Creating Time

- - This parameter indicates

the time when the

multicast group is set up.

 

Parameters for Multicast Group Members Information

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter specifiesthe ID of the created E-

LAN service.

VLAN ID 1 1 to 4094 This parameter indicates

the VLAN ID of the

multicast group member.

Port Type - - This parameter indicates

the type of the multicast

group member.

Port - - This parameter indicates

the multicast group

member port.

Port Remainder Aging

Times

- - This parameter indicates

the remaining non-

response times of the

multicast group member 

 port.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-177

Page 362: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 362/496

A.9.13 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Static Multicast Group Member Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for adding static multicast groups.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Route Member Port Management tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters for Router Port Creation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter specifies

the ID of the created E-

LAN service.

VLAN ID 1 1 to 4094 This parameter specifies

the VLAN ID of the

multicast group.

Multicast MAC Address - - This parameter specifies

the multicast MAC

address.

Available Port - - This parameter indicatesthe available interfaces.

Selected Port - - This parameter indicates

the preset port of the

multicast group members.

 

A.9.14 Parameter Description: IGMP Snooping Configuration_Data Statistics

This topic describes the parameters that are used for collecting the data statistics of the IGMP

Snooping protocol.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

Protocol Configuration > IGMP Snooping Configuration from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Packet Statistics tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-178 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 363: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 363/496

Parameters for Routing Member Interface Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Service ID - - This parameter indicates

the service ID.

VLAN ID - - This parameter indicates

the VLAN ID of the

service.

Port Type - - This parameter indicates

the port type.

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port.

Packet Statistics Status Clear 

Start

Stop

Clear This parameter indicates

or specifies the status of collecting the packet

statistics.

IGMPv1 Query Packet

Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of received

IGMPv1 query packets.

IGMPv2 Query Packet

Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of received

IGMPv2 query packets.

IGMPv3 Query Packet

Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of received

IGMPv3 query packets.

IGMP Leaving Packet

Count

- - This parameter displays

the number of leaving

 packets that are received.

IGMPv1 Member

Report Packet Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of received

 packets that are reported

 by the IGMPv1 members.

IGMPv2 MemberReport Packet Count - - This parameter indicatesthe number of received

 packets that are reported

 by the IGMPv2 members.

IGMPv3 Member

Report Packet Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of received

 packets that are reported

 by the IGMPv3 members.

Unrecognized or

Unprocessed Packet

Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of packets that

cannot be recognized or 

 processed.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-179

Page 364: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 364/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Discarded Incorrect

Packet Count

- - This parameter indicates

the number of discarded

error packets.

 

A.9.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link AggregationManagement_LAG Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a link aggregation group (LAG).

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Link Aggregation Group Management tab.

3. Click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

LAG No. 1 to 16 1   l This parameter 

specifies the LAG

number to be set

manually.

l This parameter is valid

only when

Automatically Assign

is not selected.

Automatically Assign Selected

Deselected

Selected   l This parameter 

indicates whether LAG

No. is allocated

automatically.

l When Automatically

Assign is selected,LAG No. cannot be set.

LAG Name - - This parameter specifies

the LAG name.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-180 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 365: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 365/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

LAG Type Static

Manual

Static   l Static: You can create a

LAG. When you add or 

delete a member port to

or from the LAG, the

Link Aggregation

Control Protocol

(LACP) protocol is

required. In a LAG, a

 port can be in the

Selected or Standby

state. The aggregation

information is

exchanged among

different equipment

through the LACP protocol to ensure that

the aggregation

information is the same

among all the nodes.

l Manual: You can

manually create a LAG.

When you add or delete

a member port, the

LACP protocol is not

required. The port can

 be in the up or down

state. According to the physical up or down

state, the port

determines whether to

 perform an

aggregation.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-181

Page 366: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 366/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Revertive Mode Revertive

 Non-Revertive

 Non-Revertive   l This parameter can be

set only when Load

Sharing is set to Non-

Sharing.

l When a LAG is set to

Revertive, the services

are switched back to the

former working

channel after this

channel is restored to

normal.

l When a LAG is set to

Non-Revertive, the

status of the LAG does

not change after the

former working

channel is restored to

normal. That is, the

services are still

transmitted on the

 protection channel.

Load Sharing Sharing

 Non-Sharing

 Non-Sharing   l Sharing: Each member 

link of a LAG

 processes traffic at the

same time and shares

the traffic load. Thesharing mode can

increase a bandwidth

utilization for the link.

When the LAG

members change, or 

certain links fail, the

system automatically

re-allocates the traffic.

l  Non-Sharing: Only one

member link of a LAG

carries traffic, and theother link is in the

standby state. In this

case, a hot backup

mechanism is

 provided. When the

active link of a LAG is

faulty, the system

activates the standby

link, thus preventing

link failure.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-182 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 367: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 367/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Load Sharing Hash

Algorithm

Source MAC

Destination MAC

Source and DestinationMAC

Source IP

Destination IP

Source and Destination IP

Source MAC   l This parameter is valid

only when Load

Sharing of a LAG is set

to Sharing.

l The load sharing

computation methods

include: MAC address

specific allocation

(based on the source

MAC address,

destination MAC

address, and XOR 

 between source MAC

address and source

MAC address), IPaddress specific

allocation (based on the

source IP address,

destination IP address,

and XOR between

source IP address and

source IP address).

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-183

Page 368: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 368/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

System Priority 0 to 65535 32768   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

a LAG. The smaller the

value of System

Priority, the higher the

 priority.

l When a local LAG

negotiates with an

opposite LAG through

LACP packets, both

LAGs can obtain the

system priorities of 

each other. Then, the

LAG of the higher 

system priority isconsidered as the

comparison result of 

 both LAGs so that the

aggregation

information is

consistent at both

LAGs. If the priorities

of both LAGs are the

same, the system MAC

addresses are

compared. Then, the

comparison result based on the LAG with

smaller system MAC

address is considered as

the result of both LAGs

and is used to ensure

that the aggregation

information is

consistent at both

LAGs.

 

Port Settings Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Main Board - -   l This parameter 

specifies the main

 board in a LAG.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-184 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 369: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 369/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Main Port - -   l This parameter 

specifies the main port

in a LAG.

l After a LAG is created,

you can add Ethernet

services to the main

 port only. Services

cannot be added to a

slave port. When Load

Sharing is set to Non-

Sharing, the link 

connected to the main

 port is used to transmit

the services, and the

link connected to theslave port is used for 

 protection.

Board (Available Slave

Ports)

- -   l This parameter 

specifies the slave

 board in a LAG.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Port (Available Slave

Ports)

- -   l This parameter 

specifies the salve portin a LAG.

l The slave ports in a

LAG are fixed. Unless

they are manually

modified, the system

does not automatically

add them to or delete

them from the LAG.

Selected Slave Ports - - This parameter indicates

the selected slave ports.

 

A.9.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Link Aggregation_PortPriority

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the port priority of a LAG.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >InterfaceManagement > Link Aggregation Group Management from the Function Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-185

Page 370: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 370/496

2. Click the Port Priority tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value DescriptionPort - - This parameter indicates

the port whose priority can

 be set.

Port Priority 0 to 65535 32768   l This parameter 

indicates the priorities

of the ports in a LAG as

defined in the LACP

 protocol. The smaller 

the value, the higher the

 priority.

l When ports are added

into a LAG, the port of 

the highest priority is

 preferred for service

transmission.

 

A.9.17 Parameter Description: LPT Management_Creation

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating LPT management.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > LPT

Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click New.

Parameters for Convergence Points

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter specifies the board at the

convergence point.

Port - - This parameter specifies the port on the

 board of the convergence point.

NOTEOne port can be in an LPT only.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-186 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 371: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 371/496

Parameters for Access Points

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter specifies the board at the

access point.

Port - - This parameter specifies the port on the

 board of the access point.

NOTEThe access point supports selection of multiple

 ports on different boards.

 

A.9.18 Parameter Description: Port Mirroring_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port mirroring tasks.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > Port

Mirroring from the Function Tree.

2. Click New. The Port Mirror Management dialog box is displayed.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Mirror Name - -   l This parameter specifies the name of the

mirroring task.

l After the mirroring function of the port is

enabled, you can monitor all the mirrored

 ports by analyzing the packets at the

mirroring port only. As a result, you can

easily manage the ports.

Direction Ingress

Egress

Ingress   l This parameter specifies the direction in

which the service to be monitored.

l Ingress indicates that the Listened Portcopies the received packets to the Mirror

Listener Port and sends the packets out

of the Mirror Listener Port.

l Egress indicates that the Listened Port

copies the transmitted packets to the

Mirror Listener Port and sends the

 packets out of the Mirror Listener

Port.

Mirror Listener

Port

- -   l This parameter specifies the mirroring

listener port and the listened port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-187

Page 372: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 372/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Listened Port - -   l Listened Port indicates the source port

of the mirrored packets.

l

Mirror Listener Port indicates the portfrom which the packets copied from the

Listened Port are sent out.

l Mirror Listener Port: The port where

services are available cannot be selected.

Otherwise, the creation fails.

 

A.10 Parameters for the Ethernet OAM

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Ethernet operation, administration andmaintenance (OAM).

A.10.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Domain

Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance domains.

A.10.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Maintenance Association

Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance associations.

A.10.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MEP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association end

 point (MEP).

A.10.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_Remote MEP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a remote MEP.

A.10.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_MIP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association

intermediate point (MIP).

A.10.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LB Enabling

This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LB.

A.10.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAM Management_LT Enabling

This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LT.

A.10.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Parameter 

This topic describes the OAM parameters that are related to Ethernet ports.

A.10.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAM Management_OAM Error Frame Monitoring

This topic describes the parameters that are used for monitoring the OAM error frames at the

Ethernet port.

A.10.1 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_Maintenance Domain Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance domains.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-188 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 373: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 373/496

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.3. Choose New > New Maintenance Domain.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- -   l This parameter specifies the name of the

maintenance domain.

l The maintenance domain refers to the

network for the Ethernet OAM.

l This parameter can contain a maximumof eight bytes.

Maintenance

Domain Level

0

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

4   l This parameter specifies the level of the

maintenance domain.

l The values 0-2 indicate the carrier level,

the values 3-4 indicate the supplier level,

and the values 5-7 indicates the user level.

l When the value is set to 0, the

maintenance domain is at the lowest

level. The values 1-7 indicate that the

level increases in a sequential order.l The OAM packets whose level is higher 

than the preset value are transparently

transmitted by the MEPs. The OAM

 packets whose level is lower than the

 preset value are directly discarded by the

MEPs. The OAM packets whose level is

the same as the preset value are responded

to or terminated by the MEPs according

to the message type.

 

A.10.2 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_Maintenance Association Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating maintenance associations.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-189

Page 374: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 374/496

3. Select the maintenance domain in which a maintenance association needs to be created.

Choose New > New Maintenance Association.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the created maintenance

association.

Maintenance

Association Name

- -   l This parameter specifies the name of the

maintenance association, which is a

domain related to a service. Through

maintenance association division, the

connectivity check (CC) can be

 performed on the network that transmits

a service instance.

l This parameter can contain a maximum

of eight bytes.

Relevant Service - - This parameter specifies the service

instance that is related to the maintenance

association.

CC Test Transmit

Period

1s

10s

1 min

10 min

1s   l This parameter specifies the interval for 

transmitting packets in the CC.

l The CC is performed to check the

availability of the service.

 

A.10.3 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_MEP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association end

 point (MEP).

Navigation Path1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3. Select the maintenance association in which an MEP needs to be created. Choose New >

New MEP Point.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-190 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 375: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 375/496

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the created MEP.

Maintenance

Association Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

association of the created MEP.

Board - - This parameter specifies the board where

the MEP is located.

Port - - This parameter specifies the port where the

MEP is located.

VLAN - - This parameter indicates the VLAN ID of  

the current service.

MP ID 1 to 2048 1   l This parameter specifies the MEP ID.

l Each MEP needs to be configured with

an MEP ID, which is unique in the

maintenance association. The MEP ID is

required in the OAM operation.

Direction Ingress

Egress

Ingress   l This parameter specifies the direction of 

the MEP.

l Ingress indicates the direction in which

the packets are transmitted to the port,

and Egress indicates the direction in

which the packets are transmitted from

the port.

CC Status Active

Inactive

Active   l This parameter specifies whether to

enable the CC function of the MEP.

l In the case of the tests based on the MP

IDs, CC Status must be set to Active.

 

A.10.4 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_Remote MEP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a remote MEP.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3. Choose OAM > Manage Remote MEP Point. Then, the Manage Remote MEP Point

dialog box is displayed.

4. Click New.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-191

Page 376: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 376/496

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the MEP.

Maintenance

Association Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

association of the created MEP.

Remote

Maintenance Point

ID(_e.g:1,3-6)

1 to 2048 1   l This parameter specifies the ID of the

remote MEP.

l If other MEPs may initiate OAM

operations to an MEP in the same MA,

set the other MEPs to be the remote

MEPs.

 

A.10.5 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_MIP Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating a maintenance association

intermediate point (MIP).

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the MIP Point tab.

3. Select the maintenance domain in which an MIP needs to be created, and then click New.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the maintenance

domain of the MIP.

Board - - This parameter specifies the board where

the MIP is located.

Port - - This parameter specifies the port where the

MIP is located.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-192 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 377: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 377/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MP ID 1 to 2048 1   l This parameter specifies the MIP ID.

l Each MIP needs to be configured with an

MIP ID, which is unique in themaintenance domain. The MIP ID is

required in the OAM operation.

NOTETo create MEPs and MIPs in a service at a

 port, ensure that only one MIP can be created

and the level of the MIP must be higher than

the level of the MEP.

 

A.10.6 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_LB Enabling 

This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LB.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3. Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LB test.

4. Choose OAM > Start LB.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MP ID Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter needs to be selected if the

LB test is performed on the basis of MP IDs.

Sink Maintenance

Point MAC

Address

Selected

Deselected

Selected This parameter needs to be selected if the

LB test is performed on the basis of MAC

addresses.

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the name of the

maintenance domain for the LB test.

Maintenance

Association Name

- - This parameter indicates the name of the

maintenance association for the LB test.

Source

Maintenance Point

ID

- -   l This parameter specifies the source

maintenance point in the LB test.

l Only the MEP can be set to the source

maintenance point.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-193

Page 378: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 378/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Destination

Maintenance Point

ID

- -   l This parameter specifies the destination

maintenance point in the LB test.

l Only the MEP can be set to thedestination maintenance point.

l Destination Maintenance Point ID can

 be set only when MP ID is selected.

Destination

Maintenance Point

MAC Address

- 00-00-00-00-00-00   l This parameter specifies the MAC

address of the port where the destination

maintenance point is located in the LB

test.

l Only the MAC address of the MEP can

 be set to the MAC address of the

destination maintenance point.

l Destination Maintenance Point MAC

Address can be set only when Sink 

Maintenance Point MAC Address.

Transmitted

Packet Count

1 to 255 3   l This parameter specifies the number of 

 packets transmitted each time in the LB

test.

l When the value is greater, the required

duration is longer.

Transmitted

Packet Length

64 to 1400 64   l This parameter specifies the length of a

transmitted LBM packet.l If the packet length is different, the test

result may be different. In normal cases,

it is recommended that you use the

default value.

Transmitted

Packet Priority

0 to 7 7   l This parameter specifies the priority of 

transmitting packets.

l 0 indicates the lowest priority, and 7

indicates the highest priority. In normal

cases, this parameter is set to the highest

 priority.

Detection Result - - This parameter indicates the relevant

information and result of the LB test.

 

A.10.7 Parameter Description: Ethernet Service OAMManagement_LT Enabling 

This topic describes the parameters that are used for enabling the LT.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-194 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 379: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 379/496

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Service OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Maintenance Association tab.

3. Select the maintenance domain and maintenance association for the LT test.

4. Choose OAM > Start LT.

Test Node Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MP ID Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter needs to be selected if the LT

test is performed on the basis of MP IDs.

Sink Maintenance

Point MACAddress

Selected

Deselected

Selected This parameter needs to be selected if the LT

test is performed on the basis of MACaddresses.

Maintenance

Domain Name

- - This parameter indicates the name of the

maintenance domain for the LT test.

Maintenance

Association Name

- - This parameter indicates the name of the

maintenance association for the LT test.

Source

Maintenance Point

ID

- -   l This parameter specifies the source

maintenance point in the LT test.

l Only the MEP can be set to the source

maintenance point.

Destination

Maintenance Point

ID

- -   l This parameter specifies the destination

maintenance point in the LT test.

l Only the MEP can be set to the

destination maintenance point.

l Destination Maintenance Point ID can

 be set only when MP ID is selected.

Destination

Maintenance Point

MAC Address

- 00-00-00-00-00-00   l This parameter specifies the MAC

address of the port where the destination

maintenance point is located in the LT

test.

l Only the MAC address of the MEP can

 be set to the MAC address of the

destination maintenance point.

l Destination Maintenance Point MAC

Address can be set only when Sink 

Maintenance Point MAC Address.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-195

Page 380: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 380/496

Parameters for the Detection Result

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Source

Maintenance PointID

- - This parameter indicates the source

maintenance point in the LT test.

Destination

Maintenance Point

ID/MAC

- - This parameter indicates the MAC address

of the port where the destination

maintenance point is located in the LT test.

Response

Maintenance Point

ID/MAC

- - This parameter indicates the MAC address

of the port where the responding

maintenance point is located in the LT test.

Hop Count 1 to 64 -   l This parameter indicates the number of 

hops from the source maintenance point

to the responding maintenance point or to

the destination maintenance point in the

LT test.

l The number of hops indicates the

adjacent relation between the responding

maintenance point to the source

maintenance point. The number of hops

increases by one when a responding point

occurs on the link from the source

maintenance point to the destination

maintenance point.

Test Result -

-

- This parameter indicates the result of the LT

test.

 

A.10.8 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAMManagement_OAM Parameter

This topic describes the OAM parameters that are related to Ethernet ports.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the OAM Parameter tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

 port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-196 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 381: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 381/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Enable OAM

Protocol

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the OAM protocol.

l After the OAM protocol is enabled, thecurrent Ethernet port starts to use the

 preset mode to create the OAM

connection with the opposite end.

OAM Working

Mode

Active

Passive

Active   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

working mode of the OAM.

l The port whose OAM working mode is

set to Active can initiate the OAM

connection.

l The port whose OAM working mode is

set to Passive can only wait for the

opposite end to send the OAM

connection request.

l The OAM working mode of the

equipment at only one end can be

Passive.

Link Event

Notification

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the local link events can be

notified to the opposite end.

l If the alarms caused by link events can be

reported, that is, if the number of 

 performance events (for example, error frame period, error frame, error frame

second, and error frame signal cycle) at

the local end exceeds the preset

threshold, these performance events are

notified to the port at the opposite end

through the link event notification

function.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-197

Page 382: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 382/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Remote Side

Loopback 

Response

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the port responds to the remote

loopback.

l Remote loopback indicates that the local

OAM entity transmits packets to the

remote OAM entity for loopback. The

local OAM entity can locate the fault and

test the link performance through

loopback data analysis.

l If a port does not support remote

loopback response, this port does not

respond to the loopback request from the

remote port regardless of the OAM port

status.

Loopback Status  Non-Loopback 

Initiate Loopback at

Local

Respond Loopback 

of Remote

- This parameter indicates the loopback status

at the local end.

NOTELoopback Status is valid only after you choose

OAM > Enable Remote Loopback .

OAM Discovery

Status

FAULT

ACTIVE_SEND_L

OCAL

PASSIVE_WAIT

SEND_LOCAL_R 

EMOTE

SEND_LOCAL_R 

EMOTE_OK 

SEND_ANY

- This parameter indicates the OAM

discovery status at the local end.

Port Transmit

Status

FWD

DISCARD

-   l This parameter indicates the status of 

transmitting packets at the local end.

l When a port is in the FWD state, the port

forwards the non-OAM packets. When a

 port is in the DISCARD state, the port

discards the non-OAM packets.

Port Receive Status FWD

DISCARD

LB

-   l This parameter indicates the status of 

receiving packets at the local end.

l In the FWD state, the port forwards the

non-OAM packets. In the LB state, the

 port loopback the non-OAM packets. In

the DISCARD state, the port discards the

non-OAM packets.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-198 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 383: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 383/496

A.10.9 Parameter Description: Ethernet Port OAMManagement_OAM Error Frame Monitoring 

This topic describes the parameters that are used for monitoring the OAM error frames at the

Ethernet port.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Ethernet

OAM Management > Ethernet Port OAM Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the OAM Error Frame Monitor tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

 port.

Error Frame

Monitor Window

(ms)

1000 to 60000, in

step of 100

1000 This parameter specifies the duration of  

monitoring error frames.

Error Frame

Monitor Threshold

(frame)

1 to 4294967295, in

step of 1

1   l This parameter specifies the threshold of 

monitoring error frames.

l Within the specified value of Error

Frame Monitor Window(ms), if the

number of error frames on the link 

exceeds the preset value of Error Frame

Monitor Threshold(frame), an alarm is

reported.

Error Frame

Period Window

(frame)

1488 to 892800000,

in step of 1

892800000 This parameter specifies the window of  

monitoring the error frame period.

Error Frame

Period Threshold

(frame)

1 to 892800000, in

step of 1

1   l This parameter specifies the threshold of 

monitoring the error frame period.

l Within the specified value of Error

Frame Period Window(frame), if the

number of error frames on the link exceeds the preset value of Error Frame

Period Threshold(frame), an alarm is

reported.

Error Frame

Second Window(s)

10 to 900, in step of 

1

60 This parameter specifies the time window of  

monitoring the error frame second.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-199

Page 384: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 384/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Error Frame

Second Threshold

(s)

10 to 900, in step of 

1

1   l This parameter specifies the threshold of 

monitoring error frame seconds.

l If any error frame occurs in one second,this second is called an errored frame

second. Within the specified value of 

Error Frame Second Window(s), if the

number of error frames on the link 

exceeds the preset value of Error Frame

Second Threshold(s), an alar m is

reported.

Error Frame

Signal Periodic

Monitor Window

(Entries)

1 to 60, in step of 1 1 This parameter specifies the window of  

monitoring the error frame signal period.

Error Frame

Signal Periodic

Monitor Threshold

(Entries)

1 to 7500000000, in

step of 1

1   l This parameter specifies the threshold of 

monitoring the error frame signal period.

l Within the specified value of Error

Frame Signal Periodic Monitor

Window(Entries), if the number of error 

signals exceeds the preset value of Error

Frame Signal Periodic Monitor

Threshold(Entries) , an alarm is

reported.

 

A.11 QoS Parameters

This topic describes the parameters that are related to QoS.

A.11.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing DiffServ domains.

A.11.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Management_Create

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating DiffServ (DS) domains.

A.11.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain Applied Port_ModificationThis topic describes the parameters that are used for changing DiffServ (DS) domain applied

 ports.

A.11.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management

This topic describes the parameters that are related to port policies.

A.11.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port policies.

A.11.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic Classification Configuration

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating traffic classification.

A.11.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_CreationThis topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port shaping management tasks.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-200 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 385: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 385/496

A.11.1 Parameter Description: Diffserv Domain Management

This topic describes the parameters that are used for managing DiffServ domains.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Mapping Relation ID 1 to 8 1 This parameter indicates

the ID of the mapping

relation between DiffServ

domains.

Mapping Relation Name - Default Map This parameter indicates

the name of the mapping

relation between DiffServ

domains.

 

NOTE

If one default DiffServ domain exists on the OptiX RTN equipment, Mapping Relation ID is set to 1, and

Mapping Relation Name is set to Default Map. If these parameters are not set, all the ports belong to the domain.The default Diffserv domain cannot be modified and deleted.

Parameters for Ingress Mapping Relation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

the C-VLAN of the

ingress packets.

l

C-VLAN indicates theclient-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

SVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

the S-VLAN of the

ingress packets.

l S-VLAN indicates the

server-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-201

Page 386: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 386/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

IP DSCP 0 to 63 -   l This parameter 

indicates the DSCP

 priority of the IP

addresses of the ingress

 packets.

l The differentiated

services code point

(DSCP) refers to bits

0-5 of the differentiated

services (DS) field in

the packet and indicates

the service class and

discarding priority of 

the packet.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-202 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 387: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 387/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PHB BE

AF1

AF2

AF3

AF4

EF

CS6

CS7

-   l This parameter 

indicates the per-hop

 behavior (PHB) service

class of the DiffServ

domain.

l The PHB service class

refers to the forwarding

 behavior of the

DiffServ node on the

 behavior aggregate

(BA) operation. The

forwarding behavior 

can meet the specific

requirements.

l The PHB service

classes are BE, AF1,

AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,

CS6, and CS7. The

 priorities (C_VLAN

 priority, S_VLAN

 priority, and DSCP

value) contained in the

 packets of the DiffServ

domain and the eight

PDB service classes

meet the requirements

of the specified or 

default mapping

relation.

NOTEThe AF1 is classified into

three sub service classes,

namely, AF11, AF12, and

AF13, only one of which is

valid. It is the same case

with the AF2, AF3, and

AF4.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-203

Page 388: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 388/496

Parameters for Egress Mapping Relation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PHB BE

AF1

AF2

AF3

AF4

EF

CS6

CS7

-   l This parameter 

indicates the PHBservice class of the

DiffServ domain.

l The PHB service class

refers to the forwarding

 behavior of the

DiffServ node on the

 behavior aggregate

(BA) operation. The

forwarding behavior 

can meet the specific

requirements.l The PHB service

classes are BE, AF1,

AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,

CS6, and CS7. The

 priorities (C_VLAN

 priority, S_VLAN

 priority, and DSCP

value) contained in the

 packets of the DiffServ

domain and the eight

PDB service classes

meet the requirementsof the specified or 

default mapping

relation.

NOTEThe AF1 is classified into

three sub service classes,

namely, AF11, AF12, and

AF13, only one of which is

valid. It is the same case

with the AF2, AF3, and

AF4.

CVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter indicates the priority of 

the C-VLAN of the

egress packets.

l C-VLAN indicates the

client-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-204 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 389: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 389/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

SVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

indicates the priority of 

the S-VLAN of the

egress packets.

l S-VLAN indicates the

server-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

IP DSCP 0 to 63 -   l This parameter 

indicates the DSCP

 priority of the IP

addresses of the ingress

 packets.

l The DSCP refers to bits0-5 of the DS field in

the packet and indicates

the service class and

discarding priority of 

the packet.

 

Parameters for Application Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port that uses the

DiffServ domain.

Packet Type CVLAN

SVLAN

IP-DSCP

CVLAN The packets trusted by the

OptiX RTN 950 are the

C_VLAN, S_VLAN and

IP DSCP packets that

contain the C_VLAN

 priority, S_VLAN

 priority, or DSCP value.

By default, the untrusted packets are mapped to the

BE service class for best-

effort forwarding.

NOTEThe E-Line point-to-point

transparent transmission

service supports only the

mapping from DSCP

 packets to the PHB service

class.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-205

Page 390: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 390/496

A.11.2 Parameter Description: DiffServ DomainManagement_Create

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating DiffServ (DS) domains.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click Create.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Mapping Relation ID 2 to 8 2 This parameter specifies

the ID of the mapping

relation of a DS domain.

Mapping Relation Name - - This parameter specifies

the name of the mapping

relation of a DS domain.

Packet Type cvlan

svlan

ip-dscp

cvlan   l This parameter 

specifies the type of the

 packet.

l The packets trusted by

the OptiX RTN 950 arethe C_VLAN,

S_VLAN and IP DSCP

 packets that contain the

C_VLAN priority,

S_VLAN priority, or 

DSCP value. By

default, the untrusted

 packets are mapped to

the BE service class for 

 best-effort forwarding.

NOTEThe E-Line point-to-point

transparent transmission

service supports only the

mapping from DSCP

 packets to the PHB service

class.

 

NOTE

If one default DS domain exists on the OptiX RTN equipment, Mapping Relation ID is set to 1, Mapping

Relation Name is set to Default Map. If these parameters are not set, all the ports belong to the domain. Thedefault DS domain cannot be modified and deleted.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-206 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 391: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 391/496

Parameters for Ingress Mapping Relation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

specifies the C-VLAN priority of the ingress

 packets.

l C-VLAN indicates the

client-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

SVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

specifies the S-VLAN

 priority of the ingress

 packets.

l S-VLAN indicates the

server-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

IP DSCP 0 to 63 -   l This parameter 

specifies the DSCP

 priority of the IP

addresses of the ingress

 packets.

l The differentiated

services code point(DSCP) refers to bits

0-5 of the differentiated

services (DS) field in

the packet and indicates

the service class and

discarding priority of 

the packet.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-207

Page 392: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 392/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PHB BE

AF1

AF2

AF3

AF4

EF

CS6

CS7

-   l This parameter 

indicates the PHB

service class of the DS

domain.

l The PHB service class

refers to the forwarding

 behavior of the DS

node on the behavior 

aggregate (BA)

operation. The

forwarding behavior 

can meet the specific

requirements.

l The PHB service

classes are BE, AF1,

AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,

CS6, and CS7. The

 priorities (C_VLAN

 priority, S_VLAN

 priority, and DSCP

value) contained in the

 packets of the DS

domain and the eight

PDB service classes

meet the requirements

of the specified or 

default mapping

relation.

NOTEThe AF1 is classified into

three sub service classes,

namely, AF11, AF12, and

AF13, only one of which is

valid. It is the same case

with the AF2, AF3, and

AF4.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-208 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 393: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 393/496

Parameters for Egress Mapping Relation

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PHB BE

AF1

AF2

AF3

AF4

EF

CS6

CS7

-   l This parameter 

indicates the PHBservice class of the DS

domain.

l The PHB service class

refers to the forwarding

 behavior of the DS

node on the behavior 

aggregate (BA)

operation. The

forwarding behavior 

can meet the specific

requirements.l The PHB service

classes are BE, AF1,

AF2, AF3, AF4, EF,

CS6, and CS7. The

 priorities (C_VLAN

 priority, S_VLAN

 priority, and DSCP

value) contained in the

 packets of the DS

domain and the eight

PDB service classes

meet the requirementsof the specified or 

default mapping

relation.

NOTEThe AF1 is classified into

three sub service classes,

namely, AF11, AF12, and

AF13, only one of which is

valid. It is the same case

with the AF2, AF3, and

AF4.

CVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter specifies the C-VLAN

 priority of the egress

 packets.

l C-VLAN indicates the

client-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-209

Page 394: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 394/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

SVLAN 0 to 7 -   l This parameter 

specifies the S-VLAN

 priority of the egress

 packets.

l S-VLAN indicates the

server-side VLAN, and

the value 7 indicates the

highest priority.

IP DSCP 0 to 63 -   l This parameter 

specifies the DSCP

 priority of the IP

addresses of the egress

 packets.

l The differentiatedservices code point

(DSCP) refers to bits

0-5 of the differentiated

services (DS) field in

the packet and indicates

the service class and

discarding priority of 

the packet.

 

Parameters for Application Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter specifies

the board that uses the

mapping relations

 between DS domains.

Available Port - - This parameter displays

the available port list from

which you can select the

 port that uses the mappingrelations between DS

domains.

Selected Port - - This parameter displays

the selected port list. The

 ports in the list use the

mapping relations

 between DS domains.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-210 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 395: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 395/496

A.11.3 Parameter Description: DiffServ Domain AppliedPort_Modification

This topic describes the parameters that are used for changing DiffServ (DS) domain applied

 ports.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Diffserv Domain Management from the Function Tree.

2. Select the DS domain to be changed in the main interface.

3. Click the Apply Port tab.

4. Click Modify.

Parameters for Configuring the Applied PortsParameter Value Range Default Value Description

Mapping Relation Name - - This parameter indicates

the name of the mapping

relation of a DS domain.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-211

Page 396: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 396/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Packet Type CVLAN

SVLAN

IP-DSCP

CVLAN   l This parameter 

specifies the type of the

 packet.

l The packets trusted by

the OptiX RTN 950 are

the C-VLAN, S-VLAN

and IP-DSCP packets

that contain the C-

VLAN priority, S-

VLAN priority, or 

DSCP value. By

default, the untrusted

 packets are mapped to

the BE service class for 

 best-effort forwarding.

l When the OptiX RTN

950 receives services

and identifies service

types based on VLAN

 priorities, the trusted

 packets at a UNI ports

carry C-VLAN

 priorities, and the

trusted packets at an

 NNI port carry S-

VLAN priorities.

When the OptiX RTN

950 receives services

and identifies service

types based on DSCP

values, the trusted

 packets at a port carry

IP-DSCP values.

NOTEThe E-Line point-to-point

transparent transmission

service supports only the

mapping from DSCP

 packets to the PHB service

class.

Board - - This parameter specifies

the board where the port is

located.

Available Port - - This parameter indicates

the available port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-212 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 397: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 397/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Selected Port - - This parameter indicates

the selected port.

The selected port isapplied to the DS domain.

 

NOTE

If one default DS domain exists on the OptiX RTN 950,Mapping Relation ID is set to 1, and Mapping Relation

Name is set to Default Map. If these parameters are not set, all the ports belong to the domain. The port applied

to the default DS domain cannot be modified.

A.11.4 Parameter Description: Policy Management

This topic describes the parameters that are related to port policies.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Policy Management from the Function Tree.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Policy ID 1 to 36 -   l This parameter 

indicates the policy ID

of the port.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports a maximum

number of 36 policies.

Policy Name - - This parameter indicates

or specifies the policy

name of the port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-213

Page 398: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 398/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CoS CS7

CS6

EF

AF4

AF3

AF2

AF1

BE

-   l The BE, AF1, AF2,

AF3, AF4, EF, CS6,

and CS7 service classes

respectively map eight

queuing entities. The

OptiX RTN 950

 provides different QoS

 policies for the queues

at different service

classes.

l CS6-CS7: indicates the

highest service grade,

which is mainly

involved in signaling

transmission.

l EF: indicates fast

forwarding. This

service class is

applicable to the traffic

whose delay is small

and packet loss ratio is

low, for example, voice

and video services.

l AF1-AF4: indicates

assured forwarding.

This service class isapplicable to the traffic

that requires rate

guarantee but does not

require delay or jitter 

limit.

l BE: indicates that the

traffic is forwarded in

 best-effort manner 

without special

 processing.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-214 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 399: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 399/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Grooming Police After

Reloading

SP

WRR 

CS7, CS6, EF, BE: SP

AF4, AF3, AF2, AF1:

WRR 

l The strict priority (SP)

scheduling algorithm is

designed for the key

services. One

important

characteristic of the key

services is that higher 

 priorities are required

to minimize the

response delay in the

case of congestion

events.

l The weighted round

robin (WRR)

scheduling algorithmdivides each port into

multiple output sub-

queues. The polling

scheduling is

 performed among the

output sub-queues to

ensure that each sub-

queue has a certain

 period of service time.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports the setting of 

the SP+WRR 

scheduling algorithm

of the CoS queue

according to the

requirement, and

 provides one or more

queues that comply

with the SP algorithm.

Except for the default

value, however, the

value of the WRR 

scheduling algorithmand the value of the SP

scheduling algorithm

cannot be interleaved.

That is, except for the

default value,

Grooming Police

After Reloading can

 be changed from SP to

WRR  according to the

queue priorities in a

descending order 

(CS7-BE).

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-215

Page 400: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 400/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Policy Weight(%) 1 to 100 25   l This parameter 

specifies the weight of 

the policy in the WRR 

queue. The weight

indicates the

 percentage of the

 bandwidth resources

obtained by the WRR 

queue.

l This parameter can be

set only whenGrooming Police

After Reloading is set

to WRR .

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Bandwidth Limit Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

whether traffic shaping

is enabled for an egress

queue corresponding toa PHB service class.

l CIR (kbit/s), PIR 

(kbit/s), CBS (byte),

and PBS (byte) can be

set only when

Bandwidth Limit is

set to Enabled.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

CIR(kbit/s) - - Traffic shaping for an

egress queue uses the

single token bucket two

color marker algorithm.

The value of the CIR must

 be equal to the value of the

PIR. In actual traffic

shaping processing, only

the PIR is valid.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-216 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 401: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 401/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PIR(kbit/s) - -   l When the buffer queue

is empty, the packets

are processed as

follows: If the rate of a

 packet is equal to or 

lower than the PIR, it is

directly forwarded; if 

the rate of a packet is

higher than the PIR, it

enters the buffer queue

and then is forwarded at

a rate equal to the PIR.

l When the buffer queue

is not empty, the

 packets whose rate passes the restriction of 

the PIR directly enter 

the buffer queue and

then are forwarded at a

rate equal to the PIR.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

CBS(byte) - -   l It is recommended that

you set the value of the

CBS equal to the valueof the PIR. In actual

traffic shaping

 processing, only the

PBS is valid.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

PBS(byte) - -   l When the buffer queue

is empty, certain burst

 packets can be

forwarded if the rate of 

the packets is equal to

or lower than the PIR in

a certain period. The

maximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the PBS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-217

Page 402: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 402/496

A.11.5 Parameter Description: Port Policy

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port policies.

Navigation Path1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Policy Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the CoS Queue Configuration tab.

3. Click New. The Create Port Policy dialog box is displayed.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Policy ID 1 to 36 -   l This parameter 

specifies the policy IDof the port.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports a maximum

number of 36 policies.

Automatically Assign Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter specifies

whether to automatically

allocate the policy ID of 

the port policy. After this

 parameter is selected, the

system automatically

allocates the policy ID,

and then the policy ID

cannot be set manually.

Policy Name - - This parameter specifies

the policy name of the

 port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-218 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 403: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 403/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CoS CS7

CS6

EF

AF4

AF3

AF2

AF1

BE

-   l The BE, AF1, AF2,

AF3, AF4, EF, CS6,

and CS7 service classes

respectively map eight

queuing entities. The

OptiX RTN 950

 provides different QoS

 policies for the queues

at different service

class.

l CS6-CS7: indicates the

highest service grade,

which is mainly

involved in signaling

transmission.

l EF: indicates fast

forwarding. This

service class is

applicable to the traffic

whose delay is small

and packet loss ratio is

low, for example, voice

and video services.

l AF1-AF4: indicates

assured forwarding.

This service class isapplicable to the traffic

that requires rate

guarantee but does not

require delay or jitter 

limit.

l BE: indicates that the

traffic is forwarded in

 best-effort manner 

without special

 processing.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-219

Page 404: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 404/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Grooming Police After

Reloading

SP

WRR 

CS7, CS6, EF, BE: SP

AF4, AF3, AF2, AF1:

WRR 

l The strict priority (SP)

scheduling algorithm is

designed for the key

services. One

important

characteristic of the key

services is that higher 

 priorities are required

to minimize the

response delay in the

case of congestion

events.

l The weighted round

robin (WRR)

scheduling algorithmdivides each port into

multiple output sub-

queues. The polling

scheduling is

 performed among the

output sub-queues to

ensure that each sub-

queue has a certain

 period of service time.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports the setting of 

the SP+WRR 

scheduling algorithm

of the CoS queue

according to the

requirement, and

 provides one or more

queues that comply

with the SP algorithm.

Except for the default

value, however, the

value of the WRR 

scheduling algorithmand the value of the SP

scheduling algorithm

cannot be interleaved.

That is, except for the

default value,

Grooming Police

After Reloading can

 be changed from SP to

WRR  according to the

queue priorities in a

descending order 

(CS7-BE).

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-220 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 405: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 405/496

Page 406: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 406/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PIR(kbit/s) - -   l When the buffer queue

is empty, the packets

are processed as

follows: If the rate of a

 packet is equal to or 

lower than the PIR, it is

directly forwarded; if 

the rate of a packet is

higher than the PIR, it

enters the buffer queue

and then is forwarded at

a rate equal to the PIR.

l When the buffer queue

is not empty, the

 packets whose rate passes the restriction of 

the PIR directly enter 

the buffer queue and

then are forwarded at a

rate equal to the PIR.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

CBS(byte) - -   l It is recommended that

you set the value of the

CBS equal to the valueof the PIR. In actual

traffic shaping

 processing, only the

PBS is valid.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

PBS(byte) - -   l When the buffer queue

is empty, certain burst

 packets can be

forwarded if the rate of 

the packets is equal to

or lower than the PIR in

a certain period. The

maximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the PBS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-222 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 407: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 407/496

A.11.6 Parameter Description: Port Policy_Traffic ClassificationConfiguration

This parameter describes the parameters that are used for creating traffic classification.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Policy Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Traffic Classification Configuration tab.

3. Click New. The Create Traffic Classification dialog box is displayed.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Traffic Classification ID 1 to 1024 - This parameter specifies

the ID of the traffic

classification.

ACL Action Permit

Deny

Permit   l The access control list

(ACL) determines

whether to forward or 

discard the packets that

enter the port according

to the specified

matching rules.

l When this parameter isset to Permit, the ACL

on the ingress side

filters the packets that

enter the port. Only the

 packets that match the

specified rules can be

received by the port.

l When this parameter is

set to Deny, ACL

 processing is not

 performed for the

 packets over the ingress

 port.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-223

Page 408: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 408/496

Ingress Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Logical Relation

Between Matched Rules

And And   l This parameter 

specifies the logicalrelationship between

the traffic classification

matching rules.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports the setting of 

the logical AND

 between multiple

matching rules.

Match Type DSCP Value

CVlan IDCVlan priority

SVlan ID

SVlan priority

-   l After you click Add or 

Delete, complex traffic

classification can be

 performed on the traffic

that enters the ingress

 port according to the

 preset matching rules.

l In the case a specific

service, complex traffic

classification can be

divided into basic

traffic types according

to the DSCP value,

C_VLAN ID,C_VLAN priority,

S_VLAN ID, or 

S_VLAN priority.

Traffic type is based on

the associated Ethernet

 packets. Therefore, this

 parameter is set

according to the packet

type and the planning

information.

Match Value DSCP Value: 0 to 63CVlan ID: 1 to 4094

CVlan priority: 0 to 7

SVlan ID: 1 to 4094

SVlan priority: 0 to 7

-  l

If the matching value of the packets is the same

as the preset Match

Value, the packets

match the rules of 

complex traffic

classification.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-224 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 409: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 409/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CoS -

CS7

CS6

EF

AF4

AF3

AF2

AF1

BE

-   l This parameter 

specifies the PHB

service class queue

mapped by the traffic

classification packets.

l If this parameter is set

to empty (-), the traffic

classification packets

map the PHB service

class queue according

the mapping relation

specified in the topic

about Diffserv domain

management.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Bandwidth Limit Disabled

Enabled

Enabled   l This parameter 

indicates or specifies

whether the CAR 

operation is performed

for the flow in the

ingress direction.

l CIR (kbit/s), PIR 

(kbit/s), CBS (byte),and PBS (byte) can be

set only when

Bandwidth Limit is

set to Enabled.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-225

Page 410: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 410/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CIR(kbit/s) - -   l When the rate of the

 packets is not more

than the CIR, the

 packets are marked

 blue and pass the CAR 

 policing. These packets

are first forwarded in

the case of network 

congestion.

l When the rate of the

 packets is more than the

CIR but not more than

the PIR, the packets

whose rate is more than

the CIR can pass therestriction of the CAR 

and are marked yellow.

The processing method

of the packets marked

yellow can be set to

"Pass" or "Remark".

"Remark" indicates

that the packets are

mapped into another 

specified queue of a

higher priority (this is

equal to changing the priority of the packets)

and then forwarded to

the next port. If a

network congestion

event occurs again, the

 packets marked yellow

can be processed

according to the new

 priority.

l This parameter is set

according to the planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-226 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 411: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 411/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PIR(kbit/s) - -   l When the rate of the

 packets is more than the

PIR, the packets that

exceed the rate

restriction are marked

red and directly

discarded.

l When the rate of the

 packets is more than the

CIR but not more than

the PIR, the packets

whose rate is more than

the CIR can pass the

restriction of the CAR 

and are marked yellow.The processing method

of the packets marked

yellow can be set to

"Pass" or "Remark".

"Remark" indicates

that the packets are

mapped into another 

specified queue of a

higher priority (this is

equal to changing the

 priority of the packets)

and then forwarded tothe next port. If a

network congestion

event occurs again, the

 packets marked yellow

can be processed

according to the new

 priority.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-227

Page 412: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 412/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

CBS(byte) - -   l During a certain period,

if the rate of the packets

whose processing

method is marked

"Pass" is not more than

the CIR, certain burst

 packets are allowed and

can be first forwarded

in the case of network 

congestion. The

maximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the

CBS.

l This parameter is setaccording to the

 planning information.

PBS(byte) - -   l During a certain period,

if the rate of the packets

whose processing

method is marked

"Pass" is more than the

CIR but not more than

the PIR, certain burst

 packets are allowed and

marked yellow. Themaximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the PBS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

Coloration Mode Color Blindness Color Blindness   l This parameter 

specifies the CAR 

operation performed by

the equipment on the

 packets. The packetsare dyed according to

the result of the CAR 

operation. The dying

rule is determined by

the comparison

 between the rate of the

 packets and the preset

CAR value.

l The OptiX RTN 950

supports Color

Blindness only.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-228 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 413: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 413/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Packet Color Red

Yellow

Green

- Packets can be dyed in

three colors: red, yellow,

and green. The packets in

red are first discarded.

Handling Mode Discard

Pass

Remark 

-   l This parameter 

specifies the method of 

handling the packets.

l Discard: The packets

are discarded.

l Pass: The packets are

forwarded.

l Remark: The packets

are remarked.

"Remark" indicates

that the packets are

mapped into another 

specified queue of a

higher priority (this is

equal to changing the

 priority of the packets)

and then forwarded to

the next port.

Relabeled CoS CS7

CS6EF

AF4

AF3

AF2

AF1

BE

- If the handling method is

set to "Remark", you can

reset the CoS of the packets.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-229

Page 414: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 414/496

Egress Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Bandwidth Limit Disabled

Enable

Enable   l This parameter 

indicates or specifieswhether the traffic

shaping is performed in

the egress function.

l CIR (kbit/s), PIR 

(kbit/s), CBS (byte),

and PBS (byte) can be

set only when

Bandwidth Limit is

set to Enabled.

l This parameter is set

according to the planning information.

CIR(kbit/s) - -   l In the case that no

 packets exist in the

egress queue: When the

rate of the packets is not

more than the CIR,

these packets directly

enter the egress queue.

l In the case that certain

 packets exist in the

egress queue: The packets whose rate

 passes the restriction of 

the PIR directly enter 

the egress queue, which

forwards the packets to

the next port at the CIR.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-230 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 415: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 415/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PIR(kbit/s) - -   l In the case that no

 packets exist in the

egress queue: If the rate

of the packets is more

than the CIR but is not

more than the PIR, the

 packets whose rate is

more than the CIR enter 

the egress queue, which

forwards the packets to

the next port at the CIR.

If the rate of the packets

is more than the PIR,

the packets are directly

discarded.l In the case that certain

 packets exist in the

egress queue: The

 packets whose rate

 passes the restriction of 

the PIR directly enter 

the egress queue, which

forwards the packets to

the next port at the CIR.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

CBS(byte) - -   l If the rate of the packets

is not more than the

CIR during a certain

 period, the burst

 packets are directly

transmitted. The

maximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the

CBS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-231

Page 416: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 416/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PBS(byte) - -   l If the rate of the packets

is more than the CIR 

 but is not more than the

PIR during a certain

 period, the burst

 packets enter the egress

queue. The maximum

traffic of the burst

 packets is determined

 by the PBS.

l This parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

 

A.11.7 Parameter Description: Port Shaping Management_Creation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for creating port shaping management tasks.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > QoS

Management > Port Shaping Management from the Function Tree.

2. Click New.

Parameters for Port Shaping Management

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Slot No. - - This parameter specifies

the slot ID.

Port - - This parameter specifies

the port.

CIR (kbit/s) - - Traffic shaping for an

egress queue uses thesingle token bucket two

color marker algorithm.

The value of the CIR must

 be equal to the value of the

PIR. In actual traffic

shaping processing, only

the PIR is valid.

If the traffic shaping

function is enabled, OptiX

RTN 950 processes the

 packets in the buffer 

queue through the

CBS (byte) - -

PIR (kbit/s) - -

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-232 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 417: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 417/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

PBS (byte) - - following methods when

no packets are available in

the queue.

l When the buffer queue

is empty, the packets

are processed as

follows: If the rate of a

 packet is equal to or 

lower than the PIR, it is

directly forwarded; if 

the rate of a packet is

higher than the PIR, it

enters the buffer queue

and then is forwarded at

a rate equal to the PIR.l When the buffer queue

is empty, certain burst

 packets can be

forwarded if the rate of 

the packets is equal to

or lower than the PIR in

a certain period. The

maximum traffic of the

 burst packets is

determined by the PBS.

l When the buffer queue

is not empty, the

 packets whose rate

 passes the restriction of 

the PIR directly enter 

the buffer queue and

then are forwarded at a

rate equal to the PIR.

 

A.12 RMON ParametersThis topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON performances.

A.12.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_Statistics Group

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-233

Page 418: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 418/496

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON statistics groups.

A.12.2 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Group

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON history groups.

A.12.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_History Control GroupThis topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON history control groups.

A.12.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON setting.

A.12.1 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_StatisticsGroup

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON statistics groups.

Navigation Path

1. Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Statistics Group tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter specifies the object to be

monitored.

Sampling Period 5 to 150 5 This parameter specifies the duration of themonitoring period.

Display

Accumulated

Value

Selected

Deselected

Deselected   l This parameter specifies the method of 

displaying the performance events.

l If this parameter is not selected, the

displayed value is an increment

compared to the value that is collected in

last sampling period and stored in the

register.

l If this parameter is selected, the displayed

value is an absolute value that is currently

stored in the register.

Display Mode Graphics

List

List   l This parameter specifies the method of 

displaying the performance events.

l If this parameter is set to Graphics, the

number of performance events to be

monitored at each time cannot be more

than 10, and the unit should be the same.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-234 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 419: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 419/496

Page 420: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 420/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Event - -   l This parameter indicates the queried

 performance events.

l This parameter is valid only whenDisplay Mode is set to List.

Statistical Item - - This parameter indicates the performance

items to be monitored.

Statistical Value - - This parameter indicates the statistical value

of the monitored performance items.

Time Flag - - This parameter indicates the time point of  

each performance event.

 

A.12.3 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_HistoryControl Group

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON history control groups.

Navigation Path

Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Performance > RMON History

Control Group.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

30-Second Enabled

Disabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the 30-Second

monitoring function.

30-Minute Enabled

Disabled

Enabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the 30-Minute

monitoring function.

Custom Period 1 EnabledDisabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifieswhether to enable Custom Period 1.

Custom Period 2 Enabled

Disabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable Custom Period 2.

History Register

Count(1-50)

1 to 50 16

6(Custom Period 2)

This parameter indicates or specifies the

quantity of the history registers.

Period Length(300

to 43200 seconds, a

multiple of 30)

300 to 43200 900   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

monitoring period in Custom Period 1.

l The value must be an integer multiple of 

30.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-236 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 421: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 421/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Period Length(300

to 86400 seconds, a

multiple of 30)

300 to 86400 86400   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

monitoring period in Custom Period 2.

l The value must be an integer multiple of 30.

 

A.12.4 Parameter Description: RMON Performance_RMON Setting 

This topic describes the parameters that are related to RMON setting.

Navigation Path

l Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Performance > RMON Performance from the Function Tree.

l Click the RMON Setting tab.

Object Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter indicates the object to be

collected.

30-Second Enabled

Disabled

- This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the 30-Second

monitoring function.

NOTEIn the case of Object, 30-Second cannot be set.

30-Minute Enabled

Disabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the 30-Minute

monitoring function.

l In RMON History Control Group of 

the NE, if 30-Minute is set to Disabled,

Not Supported is displayed for this

 parameter.

Custom Period 1 Enabled

Disabled

-   l This parameter indicates or specifieswhether to enable the monitoring

function based on Custom Period 1.

l In RMON History Control Group of 

the NE, if Custom Period 1 is set to

Disabled, Not Supported is displayed

for this parameter.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-237

Page 422: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 422/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Custom Period 2 Enabled

Disabled

-   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the monitoring

function based on Custom Period 2.

l In RMON History Control Group of 

the NE, if Custom Period 2 is set to

Disabled, Not Supported is displayed

for this parameter.

 

Event Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Event - - This parameter indicates the performanceevent to be monitored.

30-Second Enabled

Disabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the monitoring function

 based on 30-Second.

30-Minute Enabled

Disabled

- This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the 30-Minute

monitoring function.

Custom Period 1 Enabled

Disabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the monitoring function

 based on Custom Period 1Custom Period1 Monitor.

Custom Period 2 Enabled

Disabled

Disabled This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to enable the monitoring function

 based on Custom Period 2Custom Period

2 Monitor.

Threshold Detect Report All

Do Not Detect

Report Only the

Upper Threshold

Report Only the

Lower Threshold

Report All   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

threshold detection method.

l If the number of detected events reaches

the preset threshold, the events are

reported to the NMS. Otherwise, theevents are not reported to the NMS.

l If an event does not support this

 parameter, Not Supported is displayed.

Upper Threshold - - This parameter indicates or specifies the

upper threshold. If the number of 

 performance events exceeds the preset

upper threshold, the corresponding

 performance events are reported.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-238 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 423: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 423/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Lower Threshold - - This parameter indicates or specifies the

lower threshold. If the number of 

 performance events is less than the preset

lower threshold, the corresponding

 performance events are reported.

Threshold Unit - - This parameter indicates the unit of each

threshold of the performance events.

 

A.13 Parameters for the Orderwire and Auxiliary Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the orderwire and auxiliary interfaces.

A.13.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General

This topic describes the parameters that are used for general orderwire features.

A.13.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Advanced

This topic describes the parameters that are used for advanced orderwire features.

A.13.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port

This topic describes the parameters that are used for F1 data ports.

A.13.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port

This topic describes the parameters that are used for broadcast data ports.

A.13.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring InterfaceThis topic describes the parameters that are used for environment monitoring interfaces.

A.13.1 Parameter Description: Orderwire_General

This topic describes the parameters that are used for general orderwire features.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >

Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2. Click the General tab.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-239

Page 424: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 424/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Call Waiting Time

(s)

1 to 9 9   l This parameter indicates the waiting time

after the local station dials the number. If the calling station does not receive the

response message from the called station

within the call waiting time, it

automatically removes the

communication connection.

l If less than 30 nodes exist in the orderwire

subnet, it is recommended that you set

this parameter to five seconds. If more

than 30 nodes exist in the orderwire

subnet, it is recommended that you set

this parameter to nine seconds.l The call waiting time should be set to the

same for all the NEs.

Dialling Mode Pulse

Dual-Tone

Frequency

Dual-Tone

Frequency

This parameter indicates the dialling mode

of the orderwire phone.

Conference Call - 888   l This parameter indicates the telephone

number of the network-wide orderwire

conference call.

l When a OptiX RTN 950 dials the

telephone number 888, the orderwire phones of all the NEs on the orderwire

subnet ring. When a OptiX RTN 950

receives the call, the orderwire phones on

the other NEs do not ring. In this case, the

orderwire point-to-multipoint group call

changes to a point-to-point call between

two NEs.

l The telephone number of the orderwire

conference call should be the same for all

the nodes on the same subnet.

l The telephone number of the orderwireconference call must have the same

length as the telephone number of the

orderwire phone (phone 1) at the local

site.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-240 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 425: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 425/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Phone 1 100 to 99999999 101   l This parameter specifies the orderwire

 phone number of the local station. An

addressing call refers to a point-to-point

call.

l The length of the orderwire phone

number of each NE should be the same.

It is recommended that you set the phone

number to a three-digit number.

l The orderwire phone number of each NE

should be unique. It is recommended that

the phone numbers are allocated from

101 for the NEs in a sequential order 

according to the NE IDs.

l

The orderwire phone number cannot beset to the group call number 888 and

cannot start with 888.

Available

Orderwire Port

- - This parameter indicates the available port

for the orderwire phone.

Selected

Orderwire Port

- - This parameter indicates the selected port

for the orderwire phone.

 

A.13.2 Parameter Description: Orderwire_AdvancedThis topic describes the parameters that are used for advanced orderwire features.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >

Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Advanced tab.

Parameters for Bytes Occupied by Orderwire Phones

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Orderwire

Occupied Bytes

E1

E2

E1   l This parameter specifies the overhead

 byte that is used to transmit the orderwire

signals.

l Regardless the parameter value, the radio

link always uses a customized overhead

 byte to transmit the orderwire signals.

Hence, this parameter should be set

according to the occupied SDH overhead

 bytes in the ordinary SDH.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-241

Page 426: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 426/496

A.13.3 Parameter Description: Orderwire_F1 Data Port

This topic describes the parameters that are used for F1 data ports.

Navigation Path1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >

Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2. Click the F1 Data Port tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Available Data

Channel

- -   l This parameter indicates the available F1

data channel.

l Two data channels should be selected for the configuration.

No. - - This parameter indicates the number of the

F1 data port.

Data Channel 1 - -   l If an SDH optical or electrical line port is

selected, this parameter corresponds to

the F1 byte in the SDH frame at the line

 port.

l If an IF port is selected, this parameter 

corresponds to the customized F1 byte in

the microwave frame at the IF port.l If F1 is selected, this parameter 

corresponds to the F1/S1 interface on the

AUX board. The F1/S1 interface

complies with ITU-T G.703 and operates

at the rate of 64 kbit/s.

Data Channel 2

 

A.13.4 Parameter Description: Orderwire_Broadcast Data Port

This topic describes the parameters that are used for broadcast data ports.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >

Orderwire from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Broadcast Data Port tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-242 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 427: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 427/496

Parameters for Broadcast Data Ports

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Overhead Byte SERIAL1 to

SERIAL4

SERIAL1   l In the case of an SDH optical/electrical

line, the preset overhead byte is used totransmit the asynchronous data services.

l In the case of a radio link, a customized

serial overhead byte in the microwave

frame is used to transmit the

asynchronous data services.

Broadcast Data

Source

- No Data   l When this parameter is set to the

SERIAL1, the F1/S1 interface on the

corresponding AUX board is used.

l When this parameter is set to the SDH

optical/electrical line port, the value of Overhead Byte of this port is used.

l When this parameter is set to the IF port,

the customized Serial byte in the

microwave frame of this port is used.

Available

Broadcast Data

Sink 

- - This parameter indicates the available

 broadcast data sink.

Selected Broadcast

Data Sink 

- -   l When this parameter is set to the

SERIAL1, the F1/S1 interface on the

corresponding AUX board is used.

l When this parameter is set to the SDH

optical/electrical line port, the value of 

Overhead Byte of this port is used.

l When this parameter is set to the IF port,

the customized Serial byte in the

microwave frame of this port is used.

 

A.13.5 Parameter Description: Environment Monitoring Interface

This topic describes the parameters that are used for environment monitoring interfaces.

Navigation Path

Select the AUX board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >

Environment Monitor Configuration > Environment Monitor Interface from the Function

Tree.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-243

Page 428: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 428/496

Parameters for the Basic Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Operation Object - - This parameter indicates the operation

object.

Relay Control

Mode

Auto Control

Manual Control

Auto Control   l Auto Control: If an alarm is reported, the

alarming relay is started up

automatically. Otherwise, the alarming

relay is shut down.

l Manual Control: Relay Status in Major

Alarm(K0) and Relay Status in Critical

Alarm(K1) need to be set.

Relay Status in

Major Alarm(K0)

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates that the status of 

the relay is set manually for major alarms.

l Enable: The relay is set to the "0N" status

for major alarms.

l Disabled: The relay is set to the "OFF"

status for major alarms.

l This parameter is valid only when Relay

Control Mode is set to Manual

Control.

Relay Status in

Critical Alarm(K1)

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates that the status of 

the relay is set manually for critical

alarms.

l Enable: The relay is set to the enabledstatus for critical alarms.

l Disabled: The relay is set to the disabled

status for critical alarms.

l This parameter is valid only when Relay

Control Mode is set to Manual

Control.

 

Parameters for the Input Relay

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Operation Object - - This parameter indicates the operation

object.

Path Name - - This parameter indicates or specifies the

name of the channel.

Using Status Unused

Used

Unused This parameter specifies whether the alarm

interface of the input relay is used.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-244 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 429: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 429/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Alarm Mode Relay Turns Off/

High Level

Relay Turns On/Low Level

Relay Turns Off/

High Level

l If this parameter is set to Relay Turns

Off/High Level, an alarm is generated

when the relay is turned off.

l If this parameter is set to Relay Turns

On/Low Level, an alarm is generated

when the relay is turned on.

l This parameter is valid only when Using

Status is set to Used.

Alarm Severity Critical Alarm

Major Alarm

Minor Alarm

Warning Alarm

Critical Alarm This parameter specifies the severity of the

alarm that is generated at the input relay.

 

Parameters for the Output Relay

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Operation Object - - This parameter indicates the operation

object.

Output Path Name - - This parameter indicates or specifies the

name of the output channel.

Use or Not Unused

Used

Unused This parameter specifies whether the alarm

interface of the output relay is used.

 

Parameters for the Temperature Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Operation Object - - This parameter indicates the operation

object.

Temperature

Upper Threshold

(Deg.C)

-40.0 to 80.0 - This parameter specifies the upper  

temperature threshold of the board. When

the actual temperature is higher than the

 preset value, an alarm is generated.

Temperature

Lower Threshold

(Deg.C)

-40.0 to 80.0 - This parameter specifies the lower  

temperature threshold of the board. When

the actual temperature is lower than the

 preset value, an alarm is generated.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-245

Page 430: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 430/496

Parameters for the Alarm Relay

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Alarm Severity Critical Alarm

Major Alarm

Minor Alarm

Warning Alarm

Critical Alarm

Major Alarm

Minor Alarm

Warning Alarm

This parameter indicates the severity of the

alarm.

Alarm Output

Channel

CSK-1

CSK-2

CSK-3

CSK-4

CSK-1 This parameter specifies the channel of the

output alarm relay.

 

A.14 Parameters for Board Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to board interfaces.

A.14.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF attributes.

A.14.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the ATPC attributes.

A.14.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid/AM Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the Hybrid/AM function.

A.14.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records

This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATPC adjustment records.

A.14.5 Parameter Description: PRBS Test

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the pseudorandom binary sequence (PRBS)

test.

A.14.6 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio Frequency Attribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio frequency attributes of an ODU.

A.14.7 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the power attributes of theODU.

A.14.8 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Equipment Information

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the equipment information of 

the ODU.

A.14.9 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes of the

ODU.

A.14.10 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the SDH interfaces.

A.14.11 Parameter Description: Automatic Laser Shutdown

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-246 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 431: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 431/496

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the automatic laser shutdown (ALS)

function.

A.14.12 Parameter Description: PDH Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the PDH interfaces.

A.14.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of an Ethernet interface.

A.14.14 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control

This topic describes the parameters that are related to flow control.

A.14.15 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 2 attributes.

A.14.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Advanced Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes.

A.14.17 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Basic Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of microwave

interfaces.

A.14.18 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2 Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 2 attributes of microwave

interfaces.

A.14.19 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Advanced Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the advanced attributes of microwave

interfaces.

A.14.1 Parameter Description: IF Interface_IF Attribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to IF attributes.

Navigation Path

l Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the IF Attributes tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF interface.

Radio Link ID 1 to 4094 1   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

ID of a radio link. As the identifier of a

radio link, this parameter is used to

 prevent incorrect connections of radio

links between sites.

l Each radio link of an NE should have a

unique link ID, and the link IDs at both

ends of a radio link should be the same.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-247

Page 432: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 432/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Received Radio

Link ID

1 to 4094 -   l This parameter indicates the received ID

of the radio link.

l If the value of Received Radio Link IDdoes not match the preset value of Radio

Link ID at the local end, the local end

inserts the AIS signal to the downstream

direction of the service. At the same time,

the local end reports an alarm to the NMS,

indicating that the link IDs do not match.

IF Port Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status of the IF interface.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is cancelled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the IF signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.

l Outloop indicates that the received SDH

signals are looped back.

l Generally, this parameter is used to locate

the faults that occur at each IF interface.

The IF loopback is used for diagnosis. If 

this function is enabled, the services at the

related ports are affected. In normal

cases, this parameter is set to Non-

Loopback .

2M Wayside

Enable Statusa

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the radio link transmits the

wayside E1 service.

l The wayside E1 service can be supported

 by the IF1 board in the 7,STM-1,28MHz,

128QAM, 8,E3,28MHz,QPSK , or 

9,E3,14MHz,16QAM mode.

2M Wayside Input

Boarda

- -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

slot in which the 2M wayside service is

accessed.

l This parameter can be set only when 2M

Wayside Enable Status is set to

Enabled.

l The wayside E1 service can be supported

 by the IF1 board in the 7,STM-1,28MHz,

128QAM, 8,E3,28MHz,QPSK , or 

9,E3,14MHz,16QAM mode.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-248 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 433: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 433/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

350 MHz

Consecutive Wave

Status

Stop

Start

Stop   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

status of transmitting the 350 MHz carrier 

signals at the IF interface.

l This parameter can be set to Start in the

commissioning process only. In normal

cases, this parameter is set to Stop.

Otherwise, the services are interrupted.

XPIC Enabled b Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the XPIC function of the IFX2

 board is enabled.

l If the IFX2 board does not perform the

XPIC function, this parameter should be

set to Disabled. In this case, the XPIC

cable is required to perform self-loop for the XPIC port on the IFX2 board.

Enable IEEE-1588

Timeslotc

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled If the OptiX RTN 950 is interconnected with

the packet radio equipment, this parameter 

should be set to Enabled. Otherwise, this

 parameter should be set to Disabled.

 

NOTE

l

a. The IFU2 and IFX2 boards do not support the 2M wayside service.l  b. The IFU2 and IF1 boards do not support the XPIC function.

l c. The IF1 board does not support the IEEE-1588 timeslot function.

A.14.2 Parameter Description: IF Interface_ATPC Attribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the ATPC attributes.

Navigation Path

l Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > IF Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the ATPC Attributes tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF interface.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-249

Page 434: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 434/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Enable

Status

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC function is enabled.

l When this parameter is set to Enabledand if the RSL at the receive end is 2 dB

higher or lower than the central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold at the receive

end, the receiver notifies the transmitter 

to decrease or increase the transmit power 

until the RSL is within the range that is 2

dB higher or lower than the central value

 between the ATPC upper threshold and

the ATPC lower threshold.

l The settings of the ATPC attributes must

 be consistent at both ends of a radio link.

l In the case of areas where fast fading

severely affects the radio transmission, it

is recommended that you set this

 parameter to Disabled.

l During the commissioning process, set

this parameter to Disabled to ensure that

the transmit power is not changed. After 

the commissioning, re-set the ATPC

attributes.

ATPC UpperThreshold(dBm)

-75.0 to -20.0 -45.0   l Set the central value between the ATPCupper threshold and the ATPC lower 

threshold to a value for the expected

receive power.

l It is recommended that you set ATPC

Upper Threshold(dBm) to the sum of 

the planned central value between the

ATPC upper threshold and the ATPC

lower threshold and 10 dB, and ATPC

Lower Threshold(dBm) to the

difference between the planned central

value between the ATPC upper threshold

and the ATPC lower threshold and 10 dB.

l You can set the ATPC upper threshold

only when ATPC Automatic Threshold

(dBm) is set to Disabled.

ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm)

-35.0 to -90.0 -70.0

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-250 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 435: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 435/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

ATPC Automatic

Threshold Enable

Status

Enabled

Disabled

Disabled   l This parameter specifies whether the

ATPC automatic threshold function is

enabled.

l If this parameter is set to Enabled, the

equipment automatically uses the preset

ATPC upper and lower thresholds

according to the work mode of the radio

link.

l If this parameter is set to Disabled, you

need to manually set ATPC Upper

Threshold(dBm) and ATPC Lower

Threshold(dBm).

ATPC Upper

AutomaticThreshold(dBm)

- -   l This parameter indicates that the

equipment automatically uses the presetATPC upper and lower thresholds.

l This parameter is valid only when ATPC

Automatic Threshold Enable Status is

set to Enabled.

ATPC Lower

Automatic

Threshold(dBm)

- -

 

A.14.3 Parameter Description: Hybrid/AM Configuration

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the Hybrid/AM function.

Navigation Path

In the NE Explorer, select a Hybrid IF board from the Object Tree and then choose

Configuration > Hybrid/AM Configuration from the Function Tree.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF port.

IF Channel

Bandwidth

7M

14M

28M

56M

7M IF Channel Bandwidth indicates the

channel spacing of the corresponding radio

link. This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-251

Page 436: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 436/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

AM Enable Status Disable

Enable

Disable   l When this parameter is set to Disable, the

radio link uses only the specified

modulation scheme. In this case, you

need to select Manually Specified

Modulation Mode.

l When this parameter is set to Enable, the

radio link uses the corresponding

modulation scheme according to the

channel conditions.

Hence, the Hybrid radio can ensure the

reliable transmission of the E1 services and

 provide bandwidth adaptively for the

Ethernet services when the AM function is

enabled.

Modulation Mode

of the Guaranteed

AM Capacity

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

QPSK This parameter specifies the lowest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according to

the planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

service transmission bandwidth that the

Hybrid radio must ensure and the

availability of the radio link that

corresponds to this modulation scheme.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Enable.Modulation Mode

of the Full AM

Capacity

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

- This parameter specifies the highest-gain

modulation scheme that the AM function

supports. This parameter is set according to

the planning information. Generally, the

value of this parameter is determined by the

 bandwidth of the services that need to be

transmitted over the Hybrid radio and the

availability of the radio link that

corresponds to this modulation scheme.

NOTEModulation Mode of the Full AM Capacity

must be higher than Modulation Mode of the

Guaranteed AM Capacity.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Enable.

Manually

Specified

Modulation Mode

QPSK 

16QAM

32QAM

64QAM

128QAM

256QAM

QPSK This parameter specifies the modulation

scheme that the radio link uses for signal

transmission.

This parameter is valid only when AM

Enable Status is set to Disable.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-252 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 437: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 437/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Guaranteed E1

Capacity

- -   l When AM Enable Status is set to

Enable, this parameter depends on IF

Channel Bandwidth and Modulation

Mode of the Guaranteed AM

Capacity and is not configurable.

l When AM Enable Status is set to

Disable, this parameter depends on IF

Channel Bandwidth and Manually

Specified Modulation Mode and is not

configurable.

E1 Capacity - - This parameter specifies the number of E1

services that can be transmitted in the

Hybrid work mode. The value of this

 parameter cannot exceed the GuaranteedE1 Capacity.

The E1 Capacity must be set to the same

value at both ends of a radio link.

 

A.14.4 Parameter Description: ATPC Adjustment Records

This topic describes the parameters that are related to ATPC adjustment records.

Navigation Path

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > ATPC Adjustment Records from the Function Tree.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the port for the

ATPC adjustment.

Event NO. - - This parameter indicates the number of theATPC adjustment event.

Adjustment Time - - This parameter indicates the time of the

ATPC adjustment.

Adjustment

Direction

- - This parameter indicates the direction of the

adjustment at the port.

Switchover - - This parameter indicates the switching

operation at the port.

Transmitted

Power(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the transmitted

 power of the port to be switched.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-253

Page 438: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 438/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Received Power

(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the received power  

of the port to be switched.

 

A.14.5 Parameter Description: PRBS Test

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the pseudorandom binary sequence (PRBS)

test.

Navigation Path

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > PRBS Test from the Function Tree.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the port for the

PRBS test.

Direction Cross

Tributary

Cross   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

direction of the PRBS test.

l In the tributary direction, the PRBS test

is performed to check the connectivity of 

the cable from the tributary board to theDDF.

l In the cross-connect direction, the PRBS

test is performed to check the processing

of the service from the tributary board to

the NE at the remote end.

Duration 1 to 255 1 This parameter indicates or specifies the

duration of the PRBS test.

Measured Time s

10min

h

s This parameter indicates or specifies the

time unit used for the PRBS test.

Start Time - - This parameter indicates the start time of the

PRBS test.

Progress - - This parameter indicates the progress

 percentage of the PRBS test.

Total PRBS - - This parameter indicates the number of bit

errors that occur in the PRBS test.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-254 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 439: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 439/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Accumulating

Mode

Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter specifies whether to display

the values in accumulative mode. If 

Accumulating Mode is selected, it

indicates that the values are displayed in

accumulative mode.

 

A.14.6 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Radio FrequencyAttribute

This topic describes the parameters that are related to radio frequency attributes of an ODU.

Navigation Pathl Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU

Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the Radio Frequency Attributes tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

ODU.

Transmit

Frequency(MHz)

- -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit frequency of the ODU, namely,

the central frequency of the channel.

l The value of this parameter must not be

less than the sum of the minimum

transmit frequency supported by the

ODU and a half of the channel spacing,

and must not be more than the difference

 between the maximum transmit

frequency supported by the ODU and a

half of the channel spacing.

l The difference between the transmit

frequencies at both ends of a radio link 

should be one T/R spacing.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-255

Page 440: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 440/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

T/R Spacing(MHz) - -   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

spacing between the transmit frequency

and receive frequency of the ODU to

 prevent mutual interference of the

transmitter and receiver.

l If the ODU is a Tx high station, the

transmit frequency is one T/R spacing

higher than the receive frequency. If the

ODU is a Tx low station, the transmit

frequency is one T/R spacing lower than

the receive frequency.

l If the ODU supports only one T/R 

spacing, this parameter is set to 0,

indicating that the T/R spacing supported

 by the ODU is used.

l A valid T/R spacing value is determined

 by the ODU itself, and the T/R spacing

should be set according to the technical

specifications of the ODU.

l The T/R spacing of the ODU should be

set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

Actual Transmit

Frequency(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual transmit

frequency of the ODU.

Actual Receive

Frequency(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual receive

frequency of the ODU.

Actual T/R 

Spacing(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the actual T/R  

spacing of the ODU.

The Range of 

frequency Point

(MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the working range

of the frequency of the ODU.

 

A.14.7 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Power Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the power attributes of the

ODU.

Navigation Path

l Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU

Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the Power Attributes tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-256 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 441: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 441/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

ODU.

Maximum

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the maximum

transmit power of the ODU. This

 parameter cannot be set to a value that

exceeds the nominal power rang of the

ODU in the guaranteed capacity

modulation module..

l This parameter is set to limit the

maximum transmit power of the ODU

within this preset range.

l

The maximum transmit power adjusted by using the ATPC function should not

exceed this value.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

Transmit Power

(dBm)

- -   l This parameter specifies the transmit

 power of the ODU. This parameter 

cannot be set to a value that exceeds the

nominal power rang of the ODU or a

value that exceeds Maximum Transmit

Power(dBm).

l The transmit power of the ODU should be set to the same value at both ends of a

radio link.

l Consider the receive power of the ODU

at the opposite end when you set this

 parameter. Ensure that the receive power 

of the ODU at the opposite end can ensure

stable radio services.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-257

Page 442: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 442/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Power to Be

Received(dBm)

- -   l This parameter is used to set the expected

receive power of the ODU and is mainly

used in the antenna alignment stage. After 

this parameter is set, the NE

automatically enables the antenna

misalignment indicating function.

l When the antenna misalignment

indicating function is enabled, if the

actual receive power of the ODU exceeds

the range of receive power±3 dB, the

ODU LED of the IF board connected to

the ODU is on (yellow) for 300 ms and

off for 300 ms repeatedly, indicating that

the antenna is not aligned.

l After the antenna alignment, after the

state that the antenna is aligned lasts for 

30 minutes, the NE automatically

disables the antenna misalignment

indicating function.

l This parameter is set according to the

 planning information.

TX High

Threshold(dBm)

- -   l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is greater than the preset

value of TX High Threshold(dBm), the

system separately records the durationwhen the value of the actual transmit

 power of the ODU is greater than the

 preset value of TX High Threshold

(dBm) and the duration when the value

of the actual transmit power of the ODU

is greater than the preset value of TX Low

Threshold(dBm) in the performance

events.

l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is greater than the preset

value of TX Low Threshold(dBm) and

is lower than the preset value of TX HighThreshold(dBm), the system records the

duration when the value of the actual

transmit power of the ODU is greater than

the preset value of TX Low Threshold

(dBm) in the performance events.

l If the value of the actual transmit power 

of the ODU is lower than the preset value

of TX Low Threshold(dBm), the system

does not record it.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-258 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 443: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 443/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

TX Low Threshold

(dBm)

- -   l TX High Threshold(dBm) and TX Low

Threshold(dBm) are valid only when the

ATPC function is enabled.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-259

Page 444: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 444/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

RX High

Threshold(dBm)

- -   l If the value of the actual receive power of 

the ODU is lower than the preset value of 

RX Low Threshold(dBm), the system

records the duration when the value of the

actual receive power of the ODU is lower 

than the preset value of RX Low

Threshold(dBm) and duration when the

value of the actual transmit power of the

ODU is lower than the preset value of RX

High Threshold(dBm)in the

 performance events.

l If the value of the actual receive power of 

the ODU is greater than the preset value

of RX Low Threshold(dBm) and is

lower than the preset value of RX HighThreshold(dBm), the system records the

duration when the value of the actual

receive power of the ODU is Lower than

the preset value of RX High Threshold

(dBm) in the performance events.

l If the value of the actual receive power of 

the ODU is greater than the preset value

of RX High Threshold(dBm), the

system does not record it.

Actual Transmit

Power(dBm)

- -   l This parameter indicates the actual

transmit power of the ODU.

l If the ATPC function is enabled, the

queried actual transmit power may be

different from the preset value.

Actual Received

Power(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the actual receive

 power of the ODU.

Actual range of 

Power(dBm)

- - This parameter indicates the range of the

actual transmit power of the ODU.

 

Equip Information

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Frequency(GHz) - - This parameter indicates the frequency band

where the ODU operates.

Equip Type - -   l This parameter indicates the equipment

type of the ODU.

l PDH and SDH indicate the transmission

capacity only and is irrelevant to the type

of transmitted service.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-260 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 445: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 445/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Station Type Tx Low

Tx High

-   l This parameter indicates whether the

ODU is a Tx high station or a Tx low

station.

l The transmit frequency of a Tx high

station is one T/R spacing higher than the

transmit frequency of a Tx low station.

Produce SN - - This parameter indicates the manufacturing

serial number and the manufacturer code of 

the ODU.

Transmission

Power Type

Standard Power 

Output

High Power Output

- This parameter indicates the level of the

output power of the ODU.

 

A.14.8 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_EquipmentInformation

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the equipment information of 

the ODU.

Navigation Path

l

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. ChooseConfiguration > ODU Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the Equipment Information tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

ODU.

Frequency(GHz) - - This parameter indicates the frequency band

where the ODU operates.

Equipment Type PDH

SDH

-   l This parameter indicates the equipment

type of the ODU.

l PDH and SDH indicate the transmission

capacity only and is irrelevant to the type

of transmitted service.

T/R Spacing(MHz) - - This parameter indicates the T/R spacing of  

the ODU.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-261

Page 446: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 446/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Intermediate

Frequency

Bandwidth (MHz)

- - This parameter indicates the IF frequency

 bandwidth of the ODU.

Station Type - -   l This parameter indicates whether the

ODU is a Tx high station or a Tx low

station.

l The transmit frequency of a Tx high

station is one T/R spacing higher than the

transmit frequency of a Tx low station.

Transmission

Power Type

- - This parameter indicates the level of the

output power of the ODU.

Produce Time - - This parameter indicates the manufacturing

time of the ODU.

Produce SN - - This parameter indicates the manufacturing

serial number and the manufacturer code of 

the ODU.

 

A.14.9 Parameter Description: ODU Interface_Advanced Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes of the

ODU.

Navigation Path

l Select the ODU from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration > ODU

Interface from the Function Tree.

l Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Board - - This parameter indicates the correspondingODU.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-262 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 447: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 447/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

RF Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status of the RF interface of the

ODU.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is canceled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the RF signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.

l This function is used for fault locating for 

the RF interfaces. The RF Loopback 

function is used for diagnosis and may

affect the services that are transmitted

over the interfaces. Hence, exercise

 precaution before starting this function.l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Non-Loopback .

Configure

Transmission

Status

unmute

mute

unmute   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

transmit status of the ODU.

l If this parameter is set to mute, the

transmitter of the ODU does not work but

can normally receive microwave signals.

l If this parameter is set to unmute, the

ODU can normally transmit and receive

microwave signals.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

unmute.

Actual

Transmission

Status

unmute

mute

- This parameter indicates the actual transmit

status of the ODU.

Factory

Information

- - This parameter indicates the manufacturer  

information about the ODU.

 

A.14.10 Parameter Description: SDH Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the SDH interfaces.

Navigation Path

l Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > SDH Interface from the Function Tree.

l Select By Board/Port(Channel), and select Port or VC4 Channel from the list box.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-263

Page 448: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 448/496

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

SDH interface.

Optical Interface

Namea

- - This parameter indicates or specifies the

name of the optical interface.

Laser Switcha Open

Close

Open   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

on/off state of the laser.

l This parameter is set for SDH optical

interfaces only.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Open.

Optical(Electrical)Interface

Loopback a

 Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies theloopback status on the SDH interface.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is canceled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the SDH signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.

l Outloop indicates that the received SDH

signals are looped back.

l This function is used for fault locating for 

the SDH interfaces. The Optical(Electrical) Interface Loopback 

function is used for diagnosis and may

affect the services that are transmitted

over the interfaces. Hence, exercise

 precaution before starting this function.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Non-Loopback .

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-264 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 449: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 449/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VC4 Loopback  b  Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status in the VC-4 path.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that theloopback is canceled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the VC-4 signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.

l Outloop indicates that the received VC-4

signals are looped back.

l This function is used for fault locating for 

the VC-4 paths. The VC4 Loopback 

function is used for diagnosis and may

affect the services that are transmitted

over the interfaces. Hence, exercise precaution before starting this function.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Non-Loopback .

 

NOTE

l a: Indicates the parameters that are supported when Port is selected from the list box.

l  b: Indicates the parameters that are supported when VC4 Channel is selected from the list box.

A.14.11 Parameter Description: Automatic Laser Shutdown

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the automatic laser shutdown (ALS)

function.

Navigation Path

Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > Automatic Laser Shutdown from the Function Tree.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Optical Interface - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

optical interface.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-265

Page 450: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 450/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Automatic

Shutdown

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether the Automatic Laser

Shutdown function is enabled or 

disabled for the laser.

l The ALS function allows the laser to shut

down automatically when an optical port

does not carry services, an optical fiber is

 broken, or no optical signal is received.

l You can set On Period(ms), Off Period

(ms), and Continuously On-test Period

(ms) only when this parameter is set to

Enabled.

On Period(ms) 1000 to 3000 2000 This parameter indicates or specifies the

 period when a shutdown laser automaticallystarts up and tests whether the optical fiber 

is normal.

Off Period(ms) 2000 to 300000 60000 This parameter indicates or specifies the

 period when the laser does not work (with

the ALS function being enabled).

Continuously On-

test Period(ms)

2000 to 300000 90000 This parameter indicates or specifies the

 period when a shutdown laser is manually

started up and tests whether the optical fiber 

is normal.

 

A.14.12 Parameter Description: PDH Interfaces

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the PDH interfaces.

Navigation Path

l Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > PDH Interface from the Function Tree.

l Select By Board/Port(Channel).

l Select Port from the list box.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

 port.

Port Name - - This parameter indicates or specifies the

name of the port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-266 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 451: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 451/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Tributary

Loopback 

 Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status in the associated path of 

the tributary unit.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is canceled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the PDH signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.

l Outloop indicates that the received PDH

signals are looped back.

l This function is used for fault locating for 

the paths of the tributary unit. The

Tributary Loopback  function is used for 

diagnosis and may affect the services thatare transmitted over the interfaces.

Hence, exercise precaution before

starting this function.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Non-Loopback .

Port Impedance - - This parameter indicates the impedance of a

 path, which depends on the tributary unit.

Service Load

Indication

Load

 Non-Loaded

Load   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

service loading status in a specific path.

l When this parameter is set to Load, the board detects whether alarms exist in the

 path.

l When this parameter is set to Non-

Loaded, the board does not detect

whether there are alarms in the path.

l If a path does not carry any services, you

can set this parameter to Non-Loaded for 

the path to mask all the alarms. If a path

carries services, you need to set this

 parameter to Load for the path.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-267

Page 452: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 452/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Retiming Mode  Normal

Retiming Mode of 

Tributary Clock Retiming Mode of 

Cross-Connect

Clock 

 Normal   l This parameter indicates or specifies the

retiming mode of a specific path.

l By using the retiming function, theretiming reference signal from the SDH

network and the service data signal are

combined and then sent to the client

equipment, thus decreasing the output

 jitter in the signal. In this way, the

retiming function ensures that the service

code flow can normally transfer the

retiming reference signal.

l When this parameter is set to Normal, the

retiming function is not used.

l

When this parameter is set to RetimingMode of Tributary Clock , the retiming

function is used with the clock of the

upstream tributary unit traced.

l When this parameter is set to the

retiming function is used with the clock 

of the upstream tributary unit traced.,

the retiming function is used with the

clock of the cross-connect unit traced.

l It is recommended that the external clock,

instead of the retiming function, should

 be used to provide reference clock signals

for the equipment.

l If the retiming function is required, it is

recommended that you set this parameter 

to Retiming Mode of Cross-connect

Clock .

Port Service Type - - This parameter indicates the type of services

that are processed in a path. It depends on

the services that are transmitted in a path.

 

A.14.13 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Basic Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of an Ethernet interface.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the General Attributes tab.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-268 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 453: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 453/496

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port name.

Name - - This parameter specifies

the port name.

Enable Port Enabled

Disabled

Enabled This parameter indicates

the working mode of the

 port.

Encapsulation Type  Null

802.1Q

QinQ

-   l This parameter 

specifies the method of 

the port to process the

received packets.

l If you set this

 parameter to Null, the

 port transparently

transmits the received

 packets.

l If you set this

 parameter to 802.1Q,

the port identifies the

 packets that comply

with the IEEE 802.1q

standard.

l If you set this

 parameter to QinQ, the

 port identifies the

 packets that comply

with the IEEE 802.1ad

QinQ standard.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-269

Page 454: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 454/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Working Mode Auto-Negotiation

10M Half-Duplex

10M Full-Duplex

100M Half-Duplex

100M Full-Duplex

1000M Full-Duplex

Auto-Negotiation   l The Ethernet ports of 

different types support

different working

modes.

l When the equipment on

the opposite side works

in auto-negotiation

mode, set the working

mode of the equipment

on the local side to

Auto-Negotiation.

l When the equipment on

the opposite side works

in full-duplex mode, set

the working mode of 

the equipment on the

local side to 10M Full-

Duplex, 100M Full-

Duplex, or 1000M

Full-Duplex

depending on the port

rate of the equipment

on the opposite side.

l When the equipment on

the opposite side works

in half-duplex mode,set the working mode

of the equipment on the

local side to 10M Half-

Duplex, 100M Half-

Duplex, or Auto-

Negotiation depending

on the port rate of the

equipment on the

opposite side.

l The GE optical

interface supports the

1000M full-duplex

mode only.

Max Frame Length

(byte)

1518 to 9600 1522 The value of this

 parameter should be

greater than the length of 

any frame to be

transported.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-270 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 455: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 455/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Auto-Negotiation

Enable

Auto-Negotiation

10M Half-Duplex

10M Full-Duplex

100M Half-Duplex

100M Full-Duplex

1000M Full-Duplex

100M Full-Duplex   l This parameter 

specifies the auto-

negotiation capability

of the Ethernet port.

l This parameter is valid

only when Working

Mode is set to Auto-

Negotiation.

Logical Port Attribute Optical Port

Electrical Port

Optical Port   l This parameter 

specifies the attribute

of the logical port.

l The SFP on the EM6F,

CSHB and CSHC

 board supports theoptical port and

electrical port.

Physical Port Attribute - - This parameter indicates

the attribute of the

 physical port.

 

A.14.14 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_Flow Control

This topic describes the parameters that are related to flow control.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Flow Control tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port name.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-271

Page 456: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 456/496

Page 457: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 457/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

QinQ Type Domain - -   l This parameter 

specifies the QinQ type

domain.

l When Encapsulation

Type in the General

Attributes tab page is

set to QinQ, you need

to set QinQ Type

Domain. The default

value is 88A8.

l When Encapsulation

Type in the General

Attributes tab page is

set to Null or 802.1Q,

you cannot set QinQ

Type Domain. In this

case, QinQ Type

Domain is displayed as

FFFF and cannot be

changed.

l QinQ Type Domain

should be set to the

same value for all the

 ports on the EM6T/

EM6F board.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-273

Page 458: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 458/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

TAG Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

Tag Aware   l This parameter 

specifies the TAG flag

of a port. For details

about the TAG flags

and associated frame-

 processing methods,

see Table A-1.

l If all the accessed

services are frames

with the VLAN tag

(tagged frames), this

 parameter is set to Tag

Aware.

l If all the accessed

services are frames

without the VLAN tag

(untagged frames), this

 parameter is set to

Access.

l If the accessed services

contain tagged frames

and untagged frames,

this parameter is set to

Hybrid.

Default VLAN ID 1 to 4094 1  l

This parameter is validonly when TAG is set

to Access or Hybrid.

l For details about the

functions of this

 parameter, see Table

A-1.

l This parameter is set

according to the actual

situations.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-274 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 459: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 459/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

VLAN Priority 0 to 7 0   l This parameter is valid

only when TAG is set

to Access or Hybrid.

l For details about the

functions of this

 parameter, see Table

A-1.

l When the VLAN

 priority is required to

divide streams or to be

used for other 

 purposes, this

 parameter is set

according to the

 planning information.

In normal cases, it is

recommended that you

use the default value.

 

Table A-1 Methods used by Ethernet interfaces to process data frames

Port Type of DataFrame

Processing Method

Tag Aware Access Hybrid

Ingress UNI Tagged frame The port receives the

frame.

The port discards

the frame.

The port receives

the frame.

Untagged frame The port discards the

frame.

The ports add the

VLAN tag, to which

Default VLAN ID

and VLAN

Priority

correspond, to the

frame and receives

the frame.

The ports add the

VLAN tag, to which

Default VLAN ID

and VLAN

Priority

correspond, to the

frame and receives

the frame.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-275

Page 460: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 460/496

Port Type of DataFrame

Processing Method

Tag Aware Access Hybrid

Egress UNI Tagged frame The port transmits

the frame.

The port strips the

VLAN tag from theframe and then

transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID

in the frame isDefault VLAN

ID, the port strips

the VLAN tag

from the frame

and then

transmits the

frame.

l If the VLAN ID

in the frame is not

Default VLAN

ID, the portdirectly transmits

the frame.

 

A.14.16 Parameter Description: Ethernet Interface_AdvancedAttributes

This topic describes the parameters that are used for configuring the advanced attributes.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Ethernet Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates

the port name.

Port Physical

Parameters

- - This parameter indicates

the physical parameters of 

the port.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-276 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 461: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 461/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

MAC Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter 

specifies the loopback 

state at the MAC layer.

When this parameter is

set to Inloop, the

Ethernet signals

transmitted to the

opposite end are looped

 back.

l In normal cases, it is

recommended that you

use the default value.

PHY Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter 

specifies the loopback state at the PHY layer.

When this parameter is

set to Inloop, the

Ethernet physical

signals transmitted to

the opposite end are

looped back.

l In normal cases, it is

recommended that you

use the default value.

Loopback Check  - - This parameter specifieswhether to enable loop

detection, which is used to

check whether a loop

exists on the port.

Loopback Port

Shutdown

- - This parameter specifies

whether to enable the loop

 port shutdown function.

Egress PIR Bandwidth

(kbit/s)

- - This parameter specifies

the egress PIR bandwidth.

Enabling BroadcastPacket Suppression

Disabled

Enabled

Disabled This parameter specifieswhether to limit the traffic

rate of the broadcast

 packets according to the

 proportion of the

 broadcast packets in the

total packets. When the

equipment at the opposite

end may encounter a

 broadcast storm, this

 parameter is set to

Enabled.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-277

Page 462: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 462/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Broadcast Packet

Suppression Threshold

0 to 100 30 When the proportion of  

the broadcast packets in

the total packets exceeds

the value of this

 parameter, the received

 broadcast packets are

discarded. The value of 

this parameter should be

more than the proportion

of the broadcast packets in

the total packets before

the broadcast storm

occurs. In normal cases,

this parameter is set to

30% or higher.

 

A.14.17 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_BasicAttributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the basic attributes of microwave

interfaces.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Basic Attributes tab.

Parameters

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF port.

Name - - This parameter indicates or specifies thecustomized port name.

Port Mode Layer 2 Layer 2 This parameter indicates the working mode

of the Ethernet name.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-278 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 463: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 463/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Encapsulation

Type

 Null

802.1Q

QinQ

802.1Q   l This parameter specifies the method of 

the port to process the received packets.

l If this parameter is set to Null, the porttransparently transmits the received

 packets.

l If this parameter is set to 802.1Q, the port

identifies the packets that comply with

the IEEE 802.1Q standard.

l If this parameter is set to QinQ, the port

identifies the packets that comply with

the IEEE 802.1 QinQ standard.

 

A.14.18 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_Layer 2Attributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the Layer 2 attributes of microwave

interfaces.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >Interface

Management > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Layer 2 Attributes tab.

Parameters for Layer 2 Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF port.

QinQ Type

Domain

- -   l This parameter specifies the QinQ type

domain.

l This parameter can be set only when

Encapsulation Type in GeneralAttributes is set to QinQ.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-279

Page 464: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 464/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Tag Tag Aware

Access

Hybrid

Tag Aware   l This parameter specifies the TAG flag of 

a port. For details about the TAG flags

and associated frame-processing

methods, see Table A-2.

l If all the accessed services are frames that

contain the VLAN tag (tagged frames),

set this parameter to "Tag Aware".

l If all the accessed services are frames that

do not contain the VLAN tag (untagged

frames), set this parameter to "Access".

l If the accessed services contain tagged

frames and untagged frames, set this

 parameter to "Hybrid".

Default VLAN ID 1 to 4094 1   l This parameter is valid only when TAG

is set to Access or Hybrid.

l For details about the functions of this

 parameter, see Table A-2.

l This parameter needs to be set according

to the actual situations.

VLAN Priority 0

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

0   l This parameter is valid only when TAG

is set to Access or Hybrid.

l For details about the functions of this

 parameter, see Table A-2.

l When the VLAN priority is required to

divide streams or to be used for other 

 purposes, this parameter needs to be set

according to the planning information. In

normal cases, it is recommended that you

use the default value.

 

Table A-2 Data frame processing

Status Type of DataFrame Processing MethodTag Aware Access Hybrid

Ingress Port Tagged frame The port receives the

frame.

The port discards

the frame.

The port receives

the frame.

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-280 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 465: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 465/496

Status Type of DataFrame

Processing Method

Tag Aware Access Hybrid

Untagged frame The port discards the

frame.

The port receives

the frame after theVLAN tag that

corresponds to

"Default VLAN ID"

and "VLAN

Priority" are added

to the frame.

The port receives

the frame after theVLAN tag that

corresponds to

"Default VLAN ID"

and "VLAN

Priority" are added

to the frame.

Egress Port Tagged frame The port transmits

the frame.

The port strips the

VLAN tag from the

frame and then

transmits the frame.

l If the VLAN ID

in the frame is

"Default VLAN

ID", the port

strips the VLANtag from the

frame and then

transmits the

frame.

l If the VLAN ID

in the frame is not

"Default VLAN

ID", the port

directly transmits

the frame.

 

A.14.19 Parameter Description: Microwave Interface_AdvancedAttributes

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the advanced attributes of microwave

interfaces.

Navigation Path

1. Select the NE from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose Configuration >InterfaceManagement > Microwave Interface from the Function Tree.

2. Click the Advanced Attributes tab.

Parameters for Advanced Attributes

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Port - - This parameter indicates the corresponding

IF port.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-281

Page 466: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 466/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Radio Link ID 1 to 4094 1   l This parameter specifies the ID of the

radio link. As the identifier of a radio link,

this parameter is used to prevent incorrect

connections of radio links between sites.

l The ID of each radio link of an NE must

 be unique, and the link IDs at both ends

of a radio link must be the same.

Received Radio

Link ID

- -   l This parameter indicates the received ID

of the radio link.

l If the value of Received Radio Link ID

does not match with the preset value of 

Radio Link ID at the local end, the local

end inserts the AIS signal to the

downstream direction of the service. Atthe same time, the local end reports an

alarm to the NMS, indicating that the link 

IDs do not match.

IF Port Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status of the IF interface.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is cancelled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the IF signals

transmitted to the opposite end are looped

 back.l Outloop indicates that the received SDH

signals are looped back.

l Generally, this parameter is used to locate

the faults that occur at each IF interface.

The IF loopback is used for diagnosis. If 

this function is enabled, the services at the

related ports are affected. In normal

cases, this parameter is set to Non-

Loopback .

Composite Port

Loopback 

 Non-Loopback 

Inloop

Outloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter indicates or specifies the

loopback status on the compositeinterface.

l Non-Loopback  indicates that the

loopback is cancelled or not performed.

l Inloop indicates that the composite

signals transmitted to the opposite end are

looped back.

l Outloop indicates that the received

composite signals are looped back.

l In normal cases, this parameter is set to

Non-Loopback .

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-282 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 467: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 467/496

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Error Frame

Discard Enabled

Enabled

Disabled

Enabled   l This parameter indicates or specifies

whether to discard the Ethernet frame

when a CRC error occurs in an Ethernet

frame.

l If the Ethernet service transmitted on the

IF_ETH port is a voice service or a video

service, you can set this parameter to

Disabled.

l The IF1 board does not support this

 parameter.

MAC Address - -   l This parameter indicates the MAC

address of the port.

l The IF1 board does not support this

 parameter.

Transmitting Rate

(Kbit/s)

- -   l This parameter indicates the transmit rate

of the local port.

l The IF1 board does not support this

 parameter.

Receiving Rate

(Kbit/s)

- -   l This parameter indicates the receive rate

of the local port.

l The IF1 board does not support this

 parameter.

MAC Loopback   Non-Loopback 

Inloop

 Non-Loopback    l This parameter specifies the loopback 

state at the MAC layer. When this

 parameter is set to Inloop, the Ethernet

signals transmitted to the opposite end are

looped back.

l In normal cases, it is recommended that

you use the default value.

l The IF1 board does not support this

 parameter.

PHY Loopback   Non-Loopback Non-Loopback The IF port on the OptiX RTN 950 does not

support the setting of this parameter.

 

A.15 Parameters for Overhead

This topic describes the parameters that are related to overhead.

A.15.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the regenerator section overheads

(RSOHs).

A.15.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-283

Page 468: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 468/496

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-4 path overheads (POHs).

A.15.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-12 path overheads (POHs).

A.15.1 Parameter Description: Regenerator Section Overhead

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the regenerator section overheads

(RSOHs).

Navigation Path

1. Select an SDH interface board in the NE Explorer Choose Configuration > Overhead

Management > Regenerator Section Overhead from the Function Tree.

2. Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

Parameters for Setting the Display Format

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Display in Text

Format

Selected

Deselected

Selected This parameter specifies the display in the

text format.

Display in

Hexadecimal

Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter specifies the display in the

hexadecimal format.

 

Parameters on the Main Interface

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter indicates the object to be set.

J0 to be Sent

([Mode]Content)

- [16 Bytes]HuaWei

SBS

If the NE at the opposite end reports the

J0_MM alarm, this parameter is set

according to the J0 byte to be received at the

opposite end.

J0 to be Received

([Mode]Content)

- [Disabled]   l This parameter specifies the J0 byte to be

received.

l If this parameter is set to [Disabled], the

 board does not monitor the received J0

 byte.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

 

A.15.2 Parameter Description: VC-4 POHs

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-4 path overheads (POHs).

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-284 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 469: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 469/496

Page 470: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 470/496

Parameters for Overhead Termination

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter indicates the object to be set.

VC4 Overhead

Termination

Termination

Pass-Through

Auto

Auto   l If this parameter is set to Pass-Through,

the NE forwards the original overhead

after monitoring the VC-4 path overhead

regardless of the C2 byte.

l If this parameter is set to Termination,

the NE generates the new VC-4 path

overhead according to the board setting

after monitoring the VC-4 path overhead

regardless of the C2 byte.

l If this parameter is set to Auto, the VC-4

 path overhead in the VC-4 pass-throughservice is passed through, and the VC-4

 path overhead in the VC-12 service is

terminated.

l It is recommended that you use the default

value.

 

A.15.3 Parameter Description: VC-12 POHs

This topic describes the parameters that are related to the VC-12 path overheads (POHs).

Navigation Path

1. Select the corresponding board from the Object Tree in the NE Explorer. Choose

Configuration > Overhead Management > VC12 Path Overhead from the Function

Tree.

2. Choose Display in Text Format or Display in Hexadecimal.

Parameters for Setting the Display Format

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Display in Text

Format

Selected

Deselected

Selected This parameter specifies the display in the

text format.

Display in

Hexadecimal

Selected

Deselected

Deselected This parameter specifies the display in the

hexadecimal format.

 

A Parameters Description

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

A-286 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 471: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 471/496

Parameters for the Trace Byte

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter indicates the object to be set.

J2 to be Sent - [16 Bytes]HuaWei

SBS

If the NE at the opposite end reports the

HP_TIM alarm, this parameter is set

according to the J2 byte to be received by

the NE at the opposite end.

J2 to be Received - [Disabled]   l If this parameter is set to [Disabled], the

 board does not monitor the received J2

 byte.

l It is recommended that you use the

default value.

J2 Received - - This parameter displays the J2 byte that isactually received.

 

Parameters for the Signal Flag 

Parameter Value Range Default Value Description

Object - - This parameter indicates the object to be set.

Signal Label

(L1,L2,L3 of V5) to

be Sent

- - If the NE at the opposite end reports the

LP_SLM or LP_SLM_VC3 alarm, this

 parameter is set according to the V5 byte to

 be received at the opposite end.

Signal Label

(L1,L2,L3 of V5) to

be Received

- - If the NE at the local end reports the

LP_SLM or LP_SLM_VC3 alarm, this

 parameter is set according to the V5 byte to

 be sent at the opposite end.

Signal Label

(L1,L2,L3 of V5)

Received

- - This parameter displays the V5 byte that is

actually received.

 

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description A Parameters Description

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

A-287

Page 472: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 472/496

Page 473: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 473/496

B Board Loopback Types

Different service interface boards support different loopback types.

Table B-1 Loopback types supported by different service interface boards

Board Loopback Type Remarks

SL1D   l Supports the optical

interface inloop

l Supports the optical

interface outloop

l Supports the VC-4 path

inloop

l Supports the VC-4 pathoutloop

-

SP3S and SP3D   l Supports the tributary

inloop

l Supports the tributary

outloop

-

EM6T and EM6F   l Supports the Ethernet port

inloop at the MAC layer 

l Supports the Ethernet port

inloop at the PHY layer 

-

IF1   l Supports the IF port inloop

l Supports the IF port outloop

l Supports the composite port

inloop

l Supports the composite port

outloop

-

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description B Board Loopback Types

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

B-1

Page 474: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 474/496

Board Loopback Type Remarks

IFU2   l Supports the IF port inloop

l Supports the IF port outloop

l Supports the composite port

inloop

l Supports the composite port

outloop

l Supports the MAC inloop at

IFETH ports

-

IFX2   l Supports the IF port inloop

l Supports the IF port outloop

l Supports the composite port

inloopl Supports the composite port

outloop

l Supports the MAC inloop at

IFETH ports

-

B Board Loopback Types

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

B-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 475: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 475/496

C Indicators, Weight, and Power

Consumption of Boards

Indicators of Boards

Table C-1 Description of the indicators on the CST

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board operates normally.

On (red) The hardware of the board is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

PROG On for 100 ms (green) and

off for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the software is being loaded.

On for 300 ms (green) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the board software is in

BIOS boot state.

On (green) The upper layer software is being

initialized.

On for 100 ms (red) and off 

for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

reset, the BOOTROM self-check fails.

On (red) When the board is being powered or  

 being reset, the memory self-check fails

or loading upper layer software fails.

When the board is running, the logic file

or upper layer software is lost.

The pluggable storage card is faulty.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

C-1

Page 476: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 476/496

Indicator State Meaning  

Off The software runs normally.

SYNC On (green) The clock is normal.

On (red) The clock source is lost or is switched.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the

system.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the

system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system

in the unprotected system.

The board is in the standby state in the 1+1 protection system.

ACT On (green) The board is in the active state in the 1+1

 protection system.

The board is already activated in the

unprotected system.

Off The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

The board is not activated in the

unprotected system.

 

Table C-2 Description of the indicators on the CSH

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board operates normally.

On (red) The hardware of the board is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

PROG On for 100 ms (green) and

off for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the software is being loaded.

On for 300 ms (green) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the board software is in

BIOS boot state.

On (green) The upper layer software is being

initialized.

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

C-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 477: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 477/496

Indicator State Meaning  

On for 100 ms (red) and off 

for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

reset, the BOOTROM self-check fails.

On (red) When the board is being powered or   being reset, the memory self-check fails

or loading upper layer software fails.

When the board is running, the logic file

or upper layer software is lost.

The pluggable storage card is faulty.

Off The software runs normally.

SYNC On (green) The clock is normal.

On (red) The clock source is lost or is switched.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the

system.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the

system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system

in the unprotected system.

The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

ACT On (green) The board is in the active state in the 1+1

 protection system.

The board is already activated in the

unprotected system.

Off The board is in the standby state in the 1

+1 protection system.

The board is not activated in the

unprotected system.

 

Table C-3 Description of the indicators on the IF1

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

C-3

Page 478: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 478/496

Indicator State Meaning  

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LINK On (green) The space link is normal.

On (red) The space link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU works normally.

On (red)   l The logical board is not

added on the NMS

l The ODU has critical or 

major alarms.

l  No power is supplied.

On (yellow) The ODU has minor alarms.

On for 300 ms (yellow) and

off for 300 ms repeatedly

The antennas are not aligned.

RMT On (yellow) The equipment at the

opposite end reports an RDI.

Off The equipment at the

opposite end does not report

an RDI.

ACT On (green)   l The board is in the active

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is already

activated in the

unprotected system.

Off    l The board is in the standby

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is not activated

in the unprotected system.

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

C-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 479: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 479/496

 

Table C-4 Description of the indicators on the IFU2

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

LINK On (green) The space link is normal.

On (red) The space link is faulty.

ODU On (green) The ODU works normally.

On (red)   l The logical board is not

added on the NMS

l The ODU has critical or 

major alarms.

l  No power is supplied.

On (yellow) The ODU has minor alarms.

On for 300 ms (yellow) andoff for 300 ms repeatedly

The antennas are not aligned.

RMT On (yellow) The equipment at the

opposite end reports an RDI.

Off The equipment at the

opposite end does not report

an RDI.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

C-5

Page 480: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 480/496

Indicator State Meaning  

ACT On (green)   l The board is in the active

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is already

activated in the

unprotected system.

Off    l The board is in the standby

state in the 1+1 protection

system.

l The board is not activated

in the unprotected system.

 

Table C-5 Description of the indicators on the EM6T/EM6F

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the board.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs in the

system.

On (yellow) A minor alarm occurs in the system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

PROG On for 100 ms (green) and off  

for 100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the software is being loaded to

the flash memory.

On for 300 ms (green) and off 

for 300 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the board software is in BIOS

 boot state.

On (green) The upper layer software is being initialized.

On for 100 ms (red) and off for 

100 ms repeatedly

When the board is being powered on or 

 being reset, the BOOTROM self-check 

fails.

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

C-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 481: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 481/496

Indicator State Meaning  

On (red) When the board is being powered on or  

 being reset, the memory self-check fails or 

loading the upper layer software fails.

When the board is running, the logic file or 

upper layer software is lost.

The pluggable storage card is faulty.

Off The software is running normally.

LINK1a On (green) The GE1 interface is connected correctly

and is not receiving or transmitting data.

Blinking (yellow) The GE1 interface is receiving or  

transmitting data.

Off The GE1 interface is not connected or isconnected incorrectly.

LINK2a On (green) The GE2 interface is connected correctly

and is not receiving or transmitting data.

Flashing (green) The GE2 interface is receiving or  

transmitting data.

Off The GE2 interface is not connected or is

connected incorrectly.

 

NOTE

a: The LINK1 and LINK2 indicators are available only on the EM6F and indicate the states of the

corresponding GE optical interfaces.

Table C-6 Description of the indicators on the SL1D

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working

normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  

major alarm occurs in the

service.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

C-7

Page 482: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 482/496

Indicator State Meaning  

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are notconfigured.

LOS1 On (red) The first optical interface of  

the SL1D reports the R_LOS

alarm.

Off The first optical interface of  

the SL1D does not report the

R_LOS alarm.

LOS2 On (red) The second optical interface

of the SL1D reports the

R_LOS alarm.

Off The second optical interface

of the SL1D does not report

the R_LOS alarm.

 

Table C-7 Description of the indicators on the SP3S/SP3D

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is workingnormally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied

to the board.

SRV On (green) The services are normal.

On (red) Indicates that a critical or  major alarm occurs in the

service.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm

occurs in the services.

Off The services are not

configured.

 

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

C-8 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 483: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 483/496

Table C-8 Description of the indicators on the AUX

Indicator State Meaning  

STAT On (green) The board is working normally.

On (red) The board hardware is faulty.

Off    l The board is not working.

l The board is not created.

l There is no power supplied to the

 board.

SRV On (green) The system is working normally.

On (red) A critical or major alarm occurs on the

 board.

On (yellow) A minor or remote alarm occurs in the

system.

Off There is no power supplied to the system.

 

Table C-9 Description of the power status indicators

Indicator Status Description

PWR On (green) The power supply is connected.

Off There is no power supplied to the PIU or the power  

supply is connected incorrectly.

 

Table C-10 Description of the fan status indicators

Indicator State Meaning  

FAN On (green) The fan is running normally.

On (red) The fan is faulty.

Off The fan is not powered on or is not installed.

 

NOTE

The CRIT, MAJ, or MIN indicator on the front panel of the FAN indicates the current alarm severity of the

subrack.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

C-9

Page 484: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 484/496

 Weight and Power Consumption of Boards

Table C-11 Weight and power consumption of boards

Boards Weight (kg) Power consumption (W)CST 0.72 kg < 20.7 W

CSH 0.74 kg < 25.3 W

IF1 0.72 kg < 12 W

IFU2 0.79 kg < 23 W

IFX2 0.80 kg < 33 W

EM6T 0.37 kg < 10.4 W

EM6F 0.38 kg < 11.3 W

SL1D 0.30 kg < 3.4 W

SP3S 0.54 kg < 5.7 W

SP3D 0.64 kg < 9.6 W

AUX 0.27 kg < 1.3 W

PIU 0.12 kg < 0.5 W

FAN 0.30 kg < 4.0 W (room temperature)

< 29.6 W (high temperature)

 

C Indicators, Weight, and Power Consumption of Boards

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

C-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 485: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 485/496

D Glossary

Terms are listed in an alphabetical order.

Number  

1U The standard electronics industries association (EIA) rack unit (44 mm/

1.75 in.)

1+1 protection A radio link protection system composed of one working channel and one

 protection channel. Two ODUs and two IF boards are used at each end of 

a radio link.

 

A  

Adaptive

modulation

A technology that is used to automatically adjust the modulation mode

 based on the channel quality. When the channel quality is favorable, the

equipment adopts a high-efficiency modulation mode to improve the

transmission efficiency and the spectrum utilization of the system. When

the channel quality is degraded, the equipment adopts the low-efficiency

modulation mode to improve the anti-interference capability of the link 

that carries high-priority services.

Add/Drop

multiplexer

A network element that adds/drops the PDH signal or STM-x (x < N) signal

to/from the STM-N signal on the SDH transport network.

Adjacent

channelalternate

polarization

A channel configuration method, which uses two adjacent channels (a

horizontal polarization wave and a vertical polarization wave) to transmittwo signals.

Automatic

transmit power

control

A method of adjusting the transmit power based on fading of the transmit

signal detected at the receiver.

 

C  

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description D Glossary

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

D-1

Page 486: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 486/496

Co-channel

dual

polarization

A channel configuration method, which uses a horizontal polarization

wave and a vertical polarization wave to transmit two signals. The co-

channel dual polarization is twice the transmission capacity of the single

 polarization.

Cross

polarization

interference

cancellation

A technology used in the case of the co-channel dual polarization (CCDP)

to eliminate the cross-connect interference between two polarization

waves in the CCDP.

 

D  

DC-I A power system, in which the BGND of the DC return conductor is short-

circuited with the PGND on the output side of the power supply cabinet

and is isolated from the PGND on the line between the output of the power supply cabinet and the electric equipment.

Digital

modulation

A digital modulation controls the changes in amplitude, phase, and

frequency of the carrier based on the changes in the baseband digital signal.

In this manner, the information can be transmitted by the carrier.

Dual-polarized

antenna

An antenna intended to radiate or receive simultaneously two independent

radio waves orthogonally polarized.

 

E  

Equalization A method of avoiding selective fading of frequencies. Equalization can

compensate for the changes of amplitude frequency caused by frequency

selective fading.

Bit error A symptom that the quality of the transmitted information is degraded

 because some bits of a data stream are errored after being received,

decided, and regenerated.

 

F  

Forward error

correction

A bit error correction technology that adds the correction information to

the payload at the transmit end. Based on the correction information, the

 bit errors generated during transmission are corrected at the receive end.

Frequency

diversity

A diversity scheme that enables two or more microwave frequencies with

a certain frequency interval are used to transmit/receive the same signal

and selection is then performed between the two signals to ease the impact

of fading.

 

G  

D Glossary

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

D-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 487: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 487/496

Gateway

network 

element

A network element that is used for communication between the NE

application layer and the NM application layer.

 

H  

Hybrid radio The hybrid transmission of Native E1 and Native Ethernet signals. Hybrid

radio supports the AM function.

 

I  

Indoor Unit The indoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements

accessing, multiplexing/demultiplexing, and IF processing for services.

Internet Group

Management

Protocol

The protocol for managing the membership of Internet Protocol multicast

groups among the TCP/IP protocols. It is used by IP hosts and adjacent

multicast routers to establish and maintain multicast group memberships.

Intermediate

frequency

The transitional frequency between the frequencies of a modulated signal

and an RF signal.

IGMP

snooping

A multicast constraint mechanism running on a layer 2 device. This

 protocol manages and controls the multicast group by listening to and

analyze the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packet between

hosts and layer 3 devices. In this manner, the spread of the multicast data

on layer 2 network can be prevented efficiently.

 

L  

Layer 2 switch A data forwarding method. In LAN, a network bridge or 802.3 Ethernet

switch transmits and distributes packet data based on the MAC address.

Since the MAC address is the second layer of the OSI model, this data

forwarding method is called layer 2 switch.

LCT The local maintenance terminal of a transport network, which is located

on the NE management layer of the transport network.

Link 

aggregation

group

An aggregation that allows one or more links to be aggregated together to

form a link aggregation group so that a MAC client can treat the link 

aggregation group as if it were a single link.

Trail A type of transport entity, mainly engaged in transferring signals from the

input of the trail source to the output of the trail sink, and monitoring the

integrality of the transferred signals.

 

M  

Multiplex

section

protection

The function performed to provide capability for switching a signal

 between and including two MST functions, from a "working" to a

"protection" channel.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description D Glossary

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

D-3

Page 488: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 488/496

Multiple

Spanning Tree

Protocol

MSTP is an evolution of the Spanning Tree Protocol and the Rapid

Spanning Tree Protocol, and was introduced in IEEE 802.1s as amendment

to 802.1Q, 1998 edition. Standard IEEE 802.1Q-2003 now includes

MSTP.

 

N  

N+1 protection A microwave link protection system that employs N working channels and

one protection channel.

Network 

element

A network element (NE) contains both the hardware and the software

running on it. One NE is at least equipped with one system control board

which manages and monitors the entire network element. The NE software

runs on the system control Unit.

Network 

managementsystem

The network management system in charge of the operation,

administration, and maintenance of a network.

Non-gateway

network 

element

A network element whose communication with the NM application layer 

must be transferred by the gateway network element application layer.

 

O  

Orderwire A channel that provides voice communication between operation

engineers or maintenance engineers of different stations.

Outdoor unit The outdoor unit of the split-structured radio equipment. It implements

frequency conversion and amplification for RF signals.

 

P  

Plesiochronous

Digital

Hierarchy

A multiplexing scheme of bit stuffing and byte interleaving. It multiplexes

the minimum rate 64 kit/s into the 2 Mbit/s, 34 Mbit/s, 140 Mbit/s, and 565

Mbit/s rates.

Polarization A kind of electromagnetic wave, the direction of whose electric field vector 

is fixed or rotates regularly. Specifically, if the electric field vector of the

electromagnetic wave is perpendicular to the plane of horizon, this

electromagnetic wave is called vertically polarized wave; if the electric

field vector of the electromagnetic wave is parallel to the plane of horizon,

this electromagnetic wave is called horizontal polarized wave; if the tip of 

the electric field vector, at a fixed point in space, describes a circle, this

electromagnetic wave is called circularly polarized wave.

 

Q  

D Glossary

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

D-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 489: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 489/496

QinQ A layer 2 tunnel protocol based on IEEE 802.1Q encapsulation. It

encapsulates the tag of the user's private virtual local area network (VLAN)

into the tag of the public VLAN. The packet carries two layers of tags to

travel through the backbone network of the carrier. In this manner, the layer 

2 virtual private network (VPN) is provided for the user.

 

R   

Rapid

Spanning Tree

Protocol

An evolution of the Spanning Tree Protocol, providing for faster spanning

tree convergence after a topology change. The RSTP protocol is backward

compatible with the STP protocol.

 

S  

Singlepolarized

antenna

An antenna that can transmit only one channel of polarized electromagneticwaves.

Space diversity A diversity scheme that enables two or more antennas separated by a

specific distance to transmit/receive the same signal and selection is then

 performed between the two signals to ease the impact of fading. Currently,

only receive SD is used.

Spanning Tree

Protocol

An algorithm defined in the IEEE 802.1D. It configures the active topology

of a Bridged LAN of arbitrary topology into a single spanning tree.

Subnet A logical entity in the transmission network, which comprises a group of 

network management objects. A subnet can contain NEs and other subnets.

Subnetwork 

connection

protection

A function, which allows a working subnetwork connection to be replaced

 by a protection subnetwork connection if the working subnetwork 

connection fails, or if its performance falls below a required level.

Synchronous

Digital

Hierarchy

A hierarchical set of synchronous digital transport, multiplexing, and

cross-connect structures, which is standardized for the transport of suitably

adapted payloads over physical transmission networks.

 

U  

U2000 A unified network management system developed by Huawei. It can

support all the NE level and network level management functions, and can

manage the transport network, access network, and MAN Ethernet in a

unified manner.

 

V  

Virtual LAN An end-to-end logical network that can travel through several network 

segments or networks by using the network management software based

on the switch LAN. The IEEE 802.1Q is the main standard for the virtual

LAN.

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description D Glossary

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

D-5

Page 490: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 490/496

Page 491: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 491/496

E Acronyms and Abbreviations

Acronyms and abbreviations are listed in alphabetical order.

A  

ADC Analog Digit Converter 

AGC Automatic Gain Control

APS Automatic Protection Switching

ARP Address Resolution Protocol

ASK  Amplitude Shift Keying

ATPC Automatic Transmit Power Control

AU Administrative Unit

 

B  

BER  Bit Error Rate

BIOS Basic Input Output System

BIP Bit-Interleaved Parity

BPDU Bridge Protocol Data Unit

BSC Base Station Controller 

 

C  

CAR  Committed Access Rate

CBS Committed Burst Size

CCDP Co-Channel Dual Polarization

CF Compact Flash card

CGMP Cisco Group Management Protocol

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description E Acronyms and Abbreviations

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

E-1

Page 492: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 492/496

CIR  Committed Information Rate

CIST Common and Internal Spanning Tree

CoS Class of Service

CPU Central Processing Unit

CRC Cyclic Redundancy Check 

CVLAN Customer VLAN

C-VLAN Customer VLAN

 

D  

DC Direct Current

DCC Data Communications Channel

DCN Data Communication Network 

DSCP Differentiated Services Code Point

DVMRP Distance Vector Multicast Routing Protocol

 

E  

ECC Embedded Control Channel

E-LAN Ethernet-LAN

EMC Electromagnetic Compatibility

EMI Electromagnetic Interference

ERPS Ethernet Ring Protection Switching

ES-IS End System to Intermediate System

ETSI European Telecommunications Standards Institute

 

F  

FCS Frame Check Sequence

FD Frequency Diversity

FE Fast Ethernet

FEC Forward Error Correction

FIFO First In First Out

FLP Fast Link Pulse

FPGA Field Programmable Gate Array

E Acronyms and Abbreviations

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

E-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 493: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 493/496

FTP File Transfer Protocol

 

G  

GE Gigabit Ethernet

GFP Generic Framing Procedure

GTS Generic Traffic Shaping

GUI Graphical User Interface

 

H  

HDB3 High Density Bipolar Code 3

HDLC High level Data Link Control procedure

HSB Hot Standby

HSM Hitless Switch Mode

 

I  

ICMP Internet Control Message Protocol

IDU Indoor Unit

IEC International Electrotechnical Commission

IEEE Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers

IETF The Internet Engineering Task Force

IF Intermediate Frequency

IGMP Internet Group Management Protocol

IP Internet Protocol

IPv6 Internet Protocol version 6

IS-IS Intermediate System to Intermediate System

ISO International Standard Organization

ITU-T International Telecommunication Union - Telecommunication

Standardization Sector 

IVL Independence VLAN learning

 

L  

LAN Local Area Network 

LAPD Link Access Procedure on the D channel

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description E Acronyms and Abbreviations

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

E-3

Page 494: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 494/496

LAG Link Aggregation Group

LAPS Link Access Procedure-SDH

LB LoopBack 

LCT Generation-Local Craft Terminal

LDPC Low-Density Parity Check code

LMSP Linear Multiplex Section Protection

LPT Link State Pass Through

 

M  

MA Maintenance Association

MAC Medium Access Control

MADM Multi Add-Drop Multiplexer 

MBS Maximum Burst Size

MD Maintenance Domain

MDI Medium Dependent Interface

MEP Maintenance End Point

MIB Management Information Base

MP Maintenance Point

MSP Multiplex Section Protection

MSTP Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol

MTBF Mean Time Between Failure

MTTR  Mean Time To Repair 

MTU Maximum Transmission Unit

 

N  

NE  Network Element

NLP  Normal Link Pulse

NMS  Network Management System

NNI  Network-to-Network Interface or Network Node Interface

NSAP  Network Service Access Point

 

O  

E Acronyms and Abbreviations

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description

E-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 03 (2010-01-30)

Page 495: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 495/496

OAM Operations, Administration and Maintenance

ODU Outdoor Unit

OSI Open Systems Interconnection

OSPF Open Shortest Path First

 

P  

PDH Plesiochronous Digital Hierarchy

PIM-DM Protocol Independent Multicast-Dense Mode

PIM-SM Protocol Independent Multicast-Sparse Mode

PIR  Peak Information Rate

PPP Point-to-Point Protocol

PRBS Pseudo-Random Binary Sequence

 

Q  

QinQ 802.1Q in 802.1Q

QoS Quality of Service

QPSK  Quadrature Phase Shift Keying

 

R   

RF Radio Frequency

RFC Request For Comment

RIP Routing Information Protocol

RMON Remote Monitoring

RNC Radio Network Controller 

RS Reed-Solomon encoding

RSL Received Signal Level

RSSI Received Signal Strength Indicator 

RSTP Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol

RTN Radio Transmission Node

 

S  

SD Space Diversity

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description E Acronyms and Abbreviations

Issue 03 (2010-01-30) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential

Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

E-5

Page 496: IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

8/10/2019 IDU Hardware Description(V100R002C00_03).pdf

http://slidepdf.com/reader/full/idu-hardware-descriptionv100r002c0003pdf 496/496

SDH Synchronous Digital Hierarchy

SFP Small Form-Factor Pluggable

SNC SubNetwork Connection

SNCP Sub-Network Connection Protection

SNMP Simple Network Management Protocol

SNR  Signal-to-Noise Ratio

SP Strict Priority

SSM Synchronization Status Message

STM Synchronous Transport Module

STM-1 SDH Transport Module -1

STM-1e STM-1 Electrical Interface

STM-1o STM-1 Optical Interface

STM-N SDH Transport Module -N

STP Spanning Tree Protocol

SVL Shared VLAN Learning

E Acronyms and Abbreviations

OptiX RTN 950

IDU Hardware Description